Use these links to rapidly review the document
TABLE OF CONTENTS
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

Table of Contents


UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-K

(Mark one)    

ý

 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED SEPTEMBER 30, 2014

OR

o

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the transition period from                    to                  

Commission file number 0-52423

AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  61-1088522
(I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)

1999 Avenue of the Stars, Suite 2600
Los Angeles, California 90067

(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)

(213) 593-8000
(Registrant's telephone number, including area code)

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

Title of Each Class   Name of Exchange on Which Registered
Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share   New York Stock Exchange

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

         Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.  ý  Yes     o  No

         Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act.  o  Yes     ý  No

         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.  ý  Yes     o  No

         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).  ý  Yes     o  No

         Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained to the best of registrant's knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  o

         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer" and "smaller reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large accelerated filer  ý   Accelerated filer  o   Non-accelerated filer  o
(Do not check if a
smaller reporting company)
  Smaller reporting company o

         Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  o  Yes     ý  No

         The aggregate market value of registrant's common stock held by non-affiliates on March 28, 2014 (the last business day of the registrant's most recently completed second fiscal quarter), based upon the closing price of a share of the registrant's common stock on such date as reported on the New York Stock Exchange was approximately $1.8 billion.

         Number of shares of the registrant's common stock outstanding as of November 5, 2014: 153,821,746

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

         Part III incorporates information by reference from the registrant's definitive proxy statement for the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of the registrant's fiscal 2014 year end.

   


Table of Contents


TABLE OF CONTENTS

 
   
  Page  

ITEM 1.

 

BUSINESS

    2  

ITEM 1A.

 

RISK FACTORS

    14  

ITEM 1B.

 

UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

    32  

ITEM 2.

 

PROPERTIES

    32  

ITEM 3.

 

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

    32  

ITEM 4.

 

MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE

    32  

ITEM 5.

 

MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

    33  

ITEM 6.

 

SELECTED FINANCIAL EQUITY DATA

    36  

ITEM 7.

 

MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

    37  

ITEM 7A.

 

QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

    62  

ITEM 8.

 

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

    63  

ITEM 9.

 

CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

    119  

ITEM 9A.

 

CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

    119  

ITEM 9B.

 

OTHER INFORMATION

    120  

ITEM 10.

 

DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

    120  

ITEM 11.

 

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

    120  

ITEM 12.

 

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

    120  

ITEM 13.

 

CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

    120  

ITEM 14.

 

PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

    120  

ITEM 15.

 

EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

    121  

1


Table of Contents


PART I

ITEM 1.    BUSINESS

         In this report, we use the terms "AECOM," "the Company," "we," "us" and "our" to refer to AECOM Technology Corporation and its consolidated subsidiaries. Because this report relates to a period ending prior to the consummation of our acquisition of URS Corporation, except as expressly noted, this report, including the discussion of our business below, does not give effect to the URS acquisition. Unless otherwise noted, references to years are for fiscal years. Our fiscal year consists of 52 or 53 weeks, ending on the Friday closest to September 30. For clarity of presentation, we present all periods as if the year ended on September 30. We refer to the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013, as "fiscal 2013" and the fiscal year ended September 30, 2014, as "fiscal 2014."

Overview

        We are a leading provider of professional technical and management support services for public and private clients around the world. We provide planning, consulting, architectural and engineering design, and program and construction management services for a broad range of projects, including highways, airports, bridges, mass transit systems, government and commercial buildings, water and wastewater facilities and power transmission and distribution. We also provide program and facilities management and maintenance, training, logistics, security and other support services, primarily for agencies of the U.S. government.

        Through our network of approximately 43,300 employees (as of September 30, 2014), we provide our services in a broad range of end markets, including the transportation, facilities, environmental, energy, water and government markets. According to Engineering News-Record 's (ENR's) 2014 Design Survey, we are the largest general architectural and engineering design firm in the world, ranked by 2013 design revenue. In addition, we are ranked by ENR as the leading firm in a number of design end markets, including transportation and general building.

        We were formed in 1980 as Ashland Technology Company, a Delaware corporation and a wholly owned subsidiary of Ashland, Inc., an oil and gas refining and distribution company. Since becoming independent of Ashland Inc., we have grown by a combination of organic growth and strategic mergers and acquisitions from approximately 3,300 employees and $387 million in revenue in fiscal 1991, the first full fiscal year of independent operations, to approximately 43,300 employees at September 30, 2014, and $8.4 billion in revenue for fiscal 2014. We completed the initial public offering of our common stock in May 2007, and these shares are traded on the New York Stock Exchange.

        As mentioned above, we have grown in part by strategic mergers and acquisitions. These acquisitions have included: URS Corporation, a leading provider of engineering, construction, and technical services for public agencies and private sector companies around the world, in October 2014; McNeil Technologies, Inc., a leading government national security and intelligence services firm, in August 2010; and Tishman Construction Corporation, a leading provider of construction management services in the United States and the United Arab Emirates, in July 2010.

        We offer our services through two business segments: Professional Technical Services and Management Support Services.

        Professional Technical Services (PTS).     Our PTS segment delivers planning, consulting, architectural and engineering design, and program and construction management services to commercial and government clients worldwide in major end markets such as transportation, facilities, environmental, energy, water and government. For example, we are providing investigation, design and construction supervision services for the relocation of the Shatin Sewage Treatment Works to caverns in Shatin, Hong Kong and advanced conceptual engineering and environmental reviews for the Azusa-to-Montclair segment of California's Foothill Gold Line light-rail system and engineering and environmental

2


Table of Contents

management services to support global energy infrastructure development for a number of large petroleum and mining companies. Our PTS segment contributed $7.6 billion, or 91%, of our fiscal 2014 revenue.

        Management Support Services (MSS).     Our MSS segment provides program and facilities management and maintenance, training, logistics, consulting, technical assistance and systems integration services, primarily for agencies of the U.S. government. For example, we oversee remote field experiments, multiple laboratory operations, waste management systems, and the design and fabrication of electronic, mechanical and structural systems at the U.S. Department of Energy's Nevada Test Site. Our MSS segment contributed $0.7 billion, or 9%, of our fiscal 2014 revenue.

Our Business Strategy

        Our business strategy focuses on leveraging our competitive strengths, leadership positions in our core markets, and client relationships to opportunistically enter new and emerging markets and geographies. We have created an integrated delivery platform with superior capabilities to design, build, finance and operate infrastructure assets around the world. Key elements of our strategy include:

        We have long-standing relationships with a number of large corporations, public and private institutions and government agencies worldwide. We will continue to focus on client satisfaction along with opportunities to sell a greater range of services to clients and deliver full-service solutions for their needs. For example, as our environmental business has grown, we have provided environmental services for transportation and other infrastructure projects where such services have in the past been subcontracted to third parties.

        By integrating and providing a broad range of services, we believe we deliver maximum value to our clients at competitive costs. Also, by coordinating and consolidating our knowledge base, we believe we have the ability to export our leading edge technical skills to any region in the world in which our clients may need them.

        We also have formed AECOM Global Fund I, L.P. (AECOM Capital), an investment fund to invest in public-private partnership (P3) and private-sector real estate projects for which we provide a fully integrated solution that includes equity capital, design, engineering and construction services. In addition, we leverage our practical knowledge of P3s and other forms of alternative delivery to enable clients to fund their projects without direct investment by AECOM.

        We intend to leverage our leading positions in the transportation, facilities, environmental, energy, water and government markets to continue to expand our services and revenue. We believe that the need for infrastructure upgrades, environmental management and government outsourcing of support services, among other things, will result in continued opportunities in our core markets. With our track record and our global resources, we believe we are well positioned to compete for projects in these markets.

        We intend to pursue a balanced capital allocation strategy that includes acquisitions. This approach has served us well as we have strengthened and diversified our leadership positions geographically, technically and across end markets. We believe that the trend towards consolidation in our industry will continue to produce candidates that align with our acquisition strategy. Also, as previously mentioned in our description of services, we have formed AECOM Capital, an investment fund to invest in public-private partnership and private-sector real estate projects for which we can potentially provide a fully integrated solution that includes equity capital, design, engineering and construction services.

3


Table of Contents

        Our experienced employees and management team are our most valuable resources. Attracting and retaining key personnel has been, and will remain, critical to our success. We will continue to focus on providing our personnel with training and other personal and professional growth opportunities, performance-based incentives, opportunities for stock ownership and other competitive benefits in order to strengthen and support our human capital base. We believe that our employee stock ownership and other programs align the interests of our personnel with those of our clients and stockholders.

Our Business Segments

        The following table sets forth the revenue attributable to our business segments for the periods indicated(1):

 
  Year-Ended September 30,
(in millions)
 
 
  2014   2013   2012  

Professional Technical Services (PTS)

  $ 7,609.9   $ 7,242.9   $ 7,276.9  

Management Support Services (MSS)

    746.9     910.6     941.3  
               

Total

  $ 8,356.8   $ 8,153.5   $ 8,218.2  
               
               

        Our PTS segment comprises a broad array of services, generally provided on a fee-for-service basis. These services include planning, consulting, architectural and engineering design, program management and construction management for industrial, commercial, institutional and government clients worldwide. For each of these services, our technical expertise includes civil, structural, process, mechanical, geotechnical systems and electrical engineering, architectural, landscape and interior design, urban and regional planning, project economics, cost consulting and environmental, health and safety work.

        With our technical and management expertise, we are able to provide our clients a broad spectrum of services. For example, within our environmental management service offerings, we provide remediation, regulatory compliance planning and management, environmental modeling, environmental impact assessment and environmental permitting for major capital/infrastructure projects.

        Our services may be sequenced over multiple phases. For example, in the area of program management and construction management services, our work for a client may begin with a small consulting or planning contract, and may later develop into an overall management role for the project or a series of projects, which we refer to as a program. Program and construction management contracts typically employ a staff of 10 to more than 100 and, in many cases, operate as an outsourcing arrangement with our staff located at the project site. For example, since 1990, we have been managing renovation work at the Pentagon for the U.S. Department of Defense. Other examples include our construction management services for One World Trade Center, the tallest building in the Western Hemisphere, and program management services for Crossrail, the largest addition to the transit system in London and southeast England in half a century.

   


(1)
For additional financial information by segment, see Note 21 in the notes to our consolidated financial statements.

4


Table of Contents

        We provide the services in our PTS segment both directly and through joint ventures or similar partner arrangements to the following key end markets:

5


Table of Contents

6


Table of Contents

        Through our MSS segment, we offer program and facilities management and maintenance, training, logistics, consulting, technical assistance and systems integration services, primarily for agencies of the U.S. government.

        We provide a wide array of services in our MSS segment, both directly and through joint ventures or similar partner arrangements, including:

        Installation, Operations and Maintenance.     Projects include Department of Defense and Department of Energy installations where we provide comprehensive services for the operation and maintenance of complex government installations, including military bases, test ranges and equipment. We have undertaken assignments in this category in the Middle East and the United States. We also provide services for the operations and maintenance of the Department of Energy's Nevada Test Site.

        Logistics.     Projects include logistics support services for a number of Department of Defense agencies and defense prime contractors focused on developing and managing integrated supply and distribution networks. We oversee warehousing, packaging, delivery and traffic management for the distribution of government equipment and materials.

        Training.     Projects include training applications in live, virtual and simulation training environments. We have conducted training at the U.S. Army's Center for Security Training in Maryland for law enforcement and military personnel. We have also supported the training of international police officers and peacekeepers for deployment in various locations around the world in the areas of maintaining electronics and communications equipment.

        Systems Support.     Projects cover a diverse set of operational and support systems for the maintenance, operation and modernization of Department of Defense and Department of Energy installations. Our services in this area range from information technology and communications to life cycle optimization and engineering, including environmental management services. Through projects such as our joint venture operation at the Nevada Test Site, our team is responsible for facility and infrastructure support for critical missions of the U.S. government in its nonproliferation efforts, emergency response readiness, and force support and sustainment. Enterprise network operations and information systems support, including remote location engineering and operation in classified environments, are also specialized services we provide.

7


Table of Contents

        Technical Personnel Placement.     Projects include the placement of personnel in key functional areas of military and other government agencies, as these entities continue to outsource critical services to commercial entities. We provide systems, processes and personnel in support of the Department of Justice's management of forfeited assets recovered by law enforcement agencies. We also support the Department of State in its enforcement programs by recruiting, training and supporting police officers for international and homeland security missions.

        Field Services.     Projects include maintaining, modifying and overhauling ground vehicles, armored carriers and associated support equipment both within and outside of the United States under contracts with the Department of Defense. We also maintain and repair telecommunications systems for military and civilian entities.

Our Clients

        Our clients consist primarily of national, state, regional and local governments, public and private institutions and major corporations. The following table sets forth our total revenue attributable to these categories of clients for each of the periods indicated:

 
  Year Ended September 30,
($ in millions)
 
 
  2014   2013   2012  

U.S. Federal Government

                                     

PTS

  $ 514.4     6 % $ 550.0     7 % $ 548.7     7 %

MSS

    734.9     9     903.2     11     931.3     11  

U.S. State and Local Governments

    1,390.2     17     1,485.4     18     1,454.4     18  

Non-U.S. Governments

    2,030.2     24     1,911.5     23     2,006.4     24  
                           

Subtotal Governments

    4,669.7     56     4,850.1     59     4,940.8     60  

Private Entities (worldwide)

    3,687.1     44     3,303.4     41     3,277.4     40  
                           

Total

  $ 8,356.8     100 % $ 8,153.5     100 % $ 8,218.2     100 %
                           
                           

        Other than the U.S. federal government, no single client accounted for 10% or more of our revenue in any of the past five fiscal years. Approximately 15%, 18% and 18% of our revenue was derived through direct contracts with agencies of the U.S. federal government in the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. One of these contracts accounted for approximately 3%, 4% and 4% of our revenue in the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The work attributed to the U.S. federal government includes our work for the Department of Defense, Department of Energy, Department of Justice and the Department of Homeland Security.

Contracts

        The price provisions of the contracts we undertake can be grouped into two broad categories: cost-reimbursable contracts and fixed-price contracts. The majority of our contracts fall under the category of cost-reimbursable contracts, which we believe are generally less subject to loss than fixed-price contracts. As detailed below, our fixed-price contracts relate primarily to design and construction management contracts where we do not self-perform or take the risk of construction.

        Cost-reimbursable contracts consist of two similar contract types: cost-plus and time and material.

8


Table of Contents

        Cost-Plus.     We enter into two major types of cost-plus contracts:

        Cost-Plus Fixed Fee.     Under cost-plus fixed fee contracts, we charge clients for our costs, including both direct and indirect costs, plus a fixed negotiated fee. The total estimated cost plus the fixed negotiated fee represents the total contract value. We recognize revenue based on the actual labor and other direct costs incurred, plus the portion of the fixed fee earned to date.

        Cost-Plus Fixed Rate.     Under cost-plus fixed rate contracts, we charge clients for our direct and indirect costs based upon a negotiated rate. We recognize revenue based on the actual total costs expended and the applicable fixed rate.

        Certain cost-plus contracts provide for award fees or a penalty based on performance criteria in lieu of a fixed fee or fixed rate. Other contracts include a base fee component plus a performance-based award fee. In addition, we may share award fees with subcontractors. We record accruals for fee-sharing as fees are earned. We generally recognize revenue to the extent of costs actually incurred plus a proportionate amount of the fee expected to be earned. We take the award fee or penalty on contracts into consideration when estimating revenue and profit rates, and record revenue related to the award fees when there is sufficient information to assess anticipated contract performance. On contracts that represent higher than normal risk or technical difficulty, we may defer all award fees until an award fee letter is received. Once an award fee letter is received, the estimated or accrued fees are adjusted to the actual award amount.

        Certain cost-plus contracts provide for incentive fees based on performance against contractual milestones. The amount of the incentive fees varies, depending on whether we achieve above, at, or below target results. We originally recognize revenue on these contracts based upon expected results. These estimates are revised when necessary based upon additional information that becomes available as the contract progresses.

        Time and Material.     Time and material contracts are common for smaller scale engineering and consulting services. Under these types of contracts, we negotiate hourly billing rates and charge our clients based upon actual hours expended on a project. Unlike cost-plus contracts, however, there is no predetermined fee. In addition, any direct project expenditures are passed through to the client and are reimbursed. These contracts may have a fixed-price element in the form of not-to-exceed or guaranteed maximum price provisions.

        For fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, cost-reimbursable contracts represented approximately 52%, 58% and 53%, respectively, of our total revenue, consisting of cost-plus contracts and time and material contracts as follows:

 
  Year Ended
September 30,
 
 
  2014   2013   2012  

Cost-plus contracts

    15 %   17 %   18 %

Time and materials contracts

    37     41     35  
               

Total

    52 %   58 %   53 %
               
               

        There are typically two types of fixed-price contracts. The first and more common type, lump-sum, involves performing all of the work under the contract for a specified lump-sum fee. Lump-sum contracts are typically subject to price adjustments if the scope of the project changes or unforeseen conditions arise. In such cases, we will submit formal requests for adjustment of the lump sum via formal change orders or contract amendments. The second type, fixed-unit price, involves performing an estimated number of units

9


Table of Contents

of work at an agreed price per unit, with the total payment under the contract determined by the actual number of units delivered.

        Many of our fixed-price contracts are negotiated and arise in the design of projects with a specified scope. Fixed-price contracts often arise in the areas of construction management and design-build services. Construction management services are typically in the form of general administrative oversight (in which we do not assume responsibility for construction means and methods and which is on a cost-reimbursable basis). Under our design-build projects, we are typically responsible for the design of a facility with the fixed contract price negotiated after we have had the opportunity to secure specific bids from various subcontractors (including the contractor that will be primarily responsible for all construction risks) and add a contingency fee.

        We typically attempt to mitigate the risks of fixed-price design-build contracts by contracting to complete the projects based on our design as opposed to a third party's design, by not self-performing construction (except for limited environmental tasks), by not guaranteeing new or untested processes or technologies and by working only with experienced subcontractors with sufficient bonding capacity.

        Some of our fixed-price contracts require us to provide performance bonds or parent company guarantees to assure our clients that their project will be completed in accordance with the terms of the contracts. In such cases, we typically require our primary subcontractors to provide similar bonds and guarantees and to be adequately insured, and we flow down the terms and conditions set forth in our agreement on to our subcontractors.

        For fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, fixed-price contracts represented approximately 48%, 42% and 47%, respectively, of our total revenue. There may be risks associated with completing these projects profitably if we are not able to perform our professional services for the amount of the fixed fee. However, we attempt to mitigate these risks as described above.

        Some of our larger contracts may operate under joint ventures or other arrangements under which we team with other reputable companies, typically companies with which we have worked for many years. This is often done where the scale of the project dictates such an arrangement or when we want to strengthen either our market position or our technical skills.

Backlog

        Backlog is expressed in terms of gross revenue and therefore may include significant estimated amounts of third party, or pass-through costs to subcontractors and other parties. Our total backlog comprises contracted backlog and awarded backlog. Our contracted backlog includes revenue we expect to record in the future from signed contracts, and in the case of a public client, where the project has been funded. Our awarded backlog includes revenue we expect to record in the future where we have been awarded the work, but the contractual agreement has not yet been signed. For non-government contracts, our backlog includes future revenue at contract rates, excluding contract renewals or extensions that are at the discretion of the client. For contracts with a not-to-exceed maximum amount, we include revenue from such contracts in backlog to the extent of the remaining estimated amount. We calculate backlog without regard to possible project reductions or expansions or potential cancellations until such changes or cancellations occur. No assurance can be given that we will ultimately realize our full backlog. Backlog fluctuates due to the timing of when contracts are awarded and contracted and when contract revenue is recognized. Many of our contracts require us to provide services over more than one year. Our backlog for the year ended September 30, 2014, increased $8.5 billion, or 52%, to $25.1 billion as compared to $16.6 billion for the corresponding period last year.

10


Table of Contents

        The following summarizes contracted and awarded backlog (in billions):

 
  September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012  

Contracted backlog:

                   

PTS segment

  $ 10.7   $ 8.4   $ 7.7  

MSS segment

    0.7     0.4     0.8  
               

Total contracted backlog

  $ 11.4   $ 8.8   $ 8.5  
               
               

Awarded backlog:

                   

PTS segment

  $ 12.4   $ 6.9   $ 6.3  

MSS segment

    1.3     0.9     1.2  
               

Total awarded backlog

  $ 13.7   $ 7.8   $ 7.5  
               
               

Total backlog:

                   

PTS segment

  $ 23.1   $ 15.3   $ 14.0  

MSS segment

    2.0     1.3     2.0  
               

Total backlog

  $ 25.1   $ 16.6   $ 16.0  
               
               

Competition

        The professional technical and management support services markets we serve are highly fragmented, and we compete with a large number of regional, national and international companies. Certain of these competitors have greater financial and other resources than we do. Others are smaller and more specialized, and concentrate their resources in particular areas of expertise. The extent of our competition varies according to the particular markets and geographic area. The degree and type of competition we face is also influenced by the type and scope of a particular project. Our clients make competitive determinations based upon qualifications, experience, performance, reputation, price, technology, customer relationships and ability to provide the relevant services in a timely, safe and cost-efficient manner.

Seasonality

        We experience seasonal trends in our business. Our revenue is typically higher in the last half of the fiscal year. The fourth quarter of our fiscal year (July 1 to September 30) is typically our strongest quarter. We find that the U.S. federal government tends to authorize more work during the period preceding the end of our fiscal year, September 30. In addition, many U.S. state governments with fiscal years ending on June 30 tend to accelerate spending during their first quarter, when new funding becomes available. Further, our construction management revenue typically increases during the high construction season of the summer months. Within the United States, as well as other parts of the world, our business generally benefits from milder weather conditions in our fiscal fourth quarter, which allows for more productivity from our on-site civil services. Our construction and project management services also typically expand during the high construction season of the summer months. The first quarter of our fiscal year (October 1 to December 31) is typically our weakest quarter. The harsher weather conditions impact our ability to complete work in parts of North America and the holiday season schedule affects our productivity during this period. For these reasons, coupled with the number and significance of client contracts commenced and completed during a particular period, as well as the timing of expenses incurred for corporate initiatives, it is not unusual for us to experience seasonal changes or fluctuations in our quarterly operating results.

11


Table of Contents

Insurance and Risk Management

        We maintain insurance covering professional liability and claims involving bodily injury and property damage. We consider our present limits of coverage, deductibles, and reserves to be adequate. Wherever possible, we endeavor to eliminate or reduce the risk of loss on a project through the use of quality assurance/control, risk management, workplace safety and similar methods. A majority of our active operating subsidiaries are quality certified under ISO 9001:2000 or an equivalent standard, and we plan to continue to obtain certification where applicable. ISO 9001:2000 refers to international quality standards developed by the International Organization for Standardization, or ISO.

        Risk management is an integral part of our project management approach and our project execution process. We have an Office of Risk Management that reviews and oversees the risk profile of our operations. Also, pursuant to our internal delegations of authority, we have a formal process whereby a group of senior members of our risk management team evaluate risk through internal risk analyses of higher-risk projects, contracts or other business decisions.

Regulation

        We are regulated in a number of fields in which we operate. In the United States, we deal with numerous U.S. government agencies and entities, including branches of the Department of Defense, the Department of Energy, intelligence agencies and the Nuclear Regulatory Commission. When working with these and other U.S. government agencies and entities, we must comply with laws and regulations relating to the formation, administration and performance of contracts. These laws and regulations, among other things:

        Internationally, we are subject to various government laws and regulations (including the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act, Arms Export Control Act, Department of Commerce Export and Anti Boycott Regulations, Proceeds of Crime Act, Office of Foreign Assets Control regulations, U.K. Bribery Act and other similar non-U.S. laws and regulations), local government regulations and procurement policies and practices and varying currency, political and economic risks.

        To help ensure compliance with these laws and regulations, all of our employees are required to complete tailored ethics and other compliance training relevant to their position and our operations.

        Compliance with federal, state, local and foreign laws enacted for the protection of the environment has to date had no significant effect on our capital expenditures, earnings, or competitive position. In the future, compliance with environmental laws could materially adversely affect us. We will continue to monitor the impact of such laws on our business and will develop appropriate compliance programs.

Personnel

        Our principal asset is our employees. A large percentage of our employees have technical and professional backgrounds and undergraduate and/or advanced degrees. We believe that we attract and retain talented employees by offering them the opportunity to work on highly visible and technically challenging projects in a stable work environment. The tables below identify our personnel by segment and geographic region.

12


Table of Contents

 
  As of September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012  

Professional Technical Services

    38,600     38,600     37,100  

Management Support Services

    4,200     6,500     9,300  

Corporate

    500     400     400  
               

Total

    43,300     45,500     46,800  
               
               

 
  As of September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012  

Americas

    15,400     17,400     19,000  

Europe

    6,200     5,500     5,200  

Middle East

    9,200     10,300     10,500  

Asia/Pacific

    12,500     12,300     12,100  
               

Total

    43,300     45,500     46,800  
               
               

 
  As of September 30, 2014  
 
  PTS   MSS   Corporate   Total  

Americas

    13,400     1,500     500 *   15,400  

Europe

    6,200             6,200  

Middle East

    6,700     2,500         9,200  

Asia/Pacific

    12,300     200         12,500  
                   

Total

    38,600     4,200     500 *   43,300  
                   
                   

*
Includes individuals employed by foreign subsidiaries.

        A portion of our employees are employed on a project-by-project basis to meet our contractual obligations, generally in connection with government projects in our MSS segment. We believe our employee relations are good.

Geographic Information

        For financial geographic information, please refer to Note 21 to the notes to our consolidated financial statements found elsewhere in this Form 10-K.

Additional Information

        Following the end of our fiscal 2014, on October 17, 2014, we completed the previously announced acquisition of URS Corporation (URS). URS is a leading provider of engineering, construction, and technical services for public agencies and private sector companies around the world. It offers a full range of program management; planning, design and engineering; systems engineering and technical assistance; construction and construction management; operations and maintenance; management and operations; information technology; and decommissioning and closure services. In particular, URS, with more than 50,000 employees in a network of offices in nearly 50 countries, provides services for federal, oil and gas, infrastructure, power, and industrial projects and programs. With the acquisition, we added additional capabilities in the energy, oil & gas, government services and construction sectors, enhancing our ability to provide integrated services to our clients.

13


Table of Contents

        The acquisition was completed pursuant to the terms of the Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of July 11, 2014, by and among AECOM, ACM Mountain I, LLC, a direct wholly-owned subsidiary of AECOM, AECOM Global II, LLC (formerly ACM Mountain II, LLC), a direct wholly-owned subsidiary of AECOM, and URS.

        We paid a total consideration of approximately $2.3 billion in cash and issued approximately $1.6 billion of AECOM common stock to the former stockholders and certain equity award holders of URS. In connection with the acquisition, we also assumed URS senior notes totaling $1.0 billion, and subsequently repaid in URS's $0.6 billion 2011 term loan and $0.1 billion revolving line of credit.

        In connection with the acquisition, we entered into a new credit agreement consisting of (i) a term loan A facility in an aggregate principal amount of $1.925 billion, (ii) a term loan B facility in an aggregate principal amount of $0.76 billion, (iii) a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of $1.05 billion, and (iv) an incremental performance letter of credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of $500 million.

        Because this report relates to a period prior to the consummation of the acquisition of URS, except as expressly otherwise noted, this report, including the discussion of our business above, does not give effect to the URS acquisition.

Available Information

        The reports we file with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and proxy materials, including any amendments, are available free of charge on our website at www.aecom.com . You may read and copy any materials filed with the SEC at the SEC's Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information about the public reference room. The SEC also maintains a web site ( www.sec.gov ) containing reports, proxy, and other information that we file with the SEC. Our Corporate Governance Guidelines and our Code of Ethics are available on our website at www.aecom.com under the "Investors" section. Copies of the information identified above may be obtained without charge from us by writing to AECOM Technology Corporation, 1999 Avenue of the Stars, Suite 2600, Los Angeles, California 90067, Attention: Corporate Secretary.

ITEM 1A.    RISK FACTORS

         We operate in a changing environment that involves numerous known and unknown risks and uncertainties that could materially adversely affect our operations. The risks described below highlight some of the factors that have affected, and in the future could affect our operations. Additional risks we do not yet know of or that we currently think are immaterial may also affect our business operations. If any of the events or circumstances described in the following risks actually occur, our business, financial condition or results of operations could be materially adversely affected. The recent acquisition of URS exposes us to numerous additional risks and uncertainties that we have noted and described below.

We depend on long-term government contracts, some of which are only funded on an annual basis. If appropriations for funding are not made in subsequent years of a multiple-year contract, we may not be able to realize all of our anticipated revenue and profits from that project.

        A substantial majority of our revenue is derived from contracts with agencies and departments of national, state and local governments. During fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012, approximately 56%, 59% and 60%, respectively, of our revenue was derived from contracts with government entities.

        Most government contracts are subject to the government's budgetary approval process. Legislatures typically appropriate funds for a given program on a year-by-year basis, even though contract performance may take more than one year. In addition, public-supported financing such as state and local municipal

14


Table of Contents

bonds may be only partially raised to support existing infrastructure projects. As a result, at the beginning of a program, the related contract is only partially funded, and additional funding is normally committed only as appropriations are made in each subsequent fiscal year. These appropriations, and the timing of payment of appropriated amounts, may be influenced by, among other things, the state of the economy, competing priorities for appropriation, changes in administration or control of legislatures and the timing and amount of tax receipts and the overall level of government expenditures. Similarly, the impact of the economic downturn on state and local governments may make it more difficult for them to fund infrastructure projects. If appropriations are not made in subsequent years on our government contracts, then we will not realize all of our potential revenue and profit from that contract.

The Budget Control Act of 2011 could significantly reduce U.S. government spending for the services we provide.

        Under the Budget Control Act of 2011, an automatic sequestration process, or across-the-board budget cuts (a large portion of which was defense-related), was triggered when the Joint Select Committee on Deficit Reduction, a committee of twelve members of Congress, failed to agree on a deficit reduction plan for the U.S. federal budget. The sequestration began on March 1, 2013. Although the Bipartisan Budget Act of 2013 provided some sequester relief, absent additional legislative or other remedial action, the sequestration requires reduced U.S. federal government spending over a ten-year period. A significant reduction in federal government spending or a change in budgetary priorities could reduce demand for our services, cancel or delay federal projects, and result in the closure of federal facilities and significant personnel reductions, which could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

Our inability to win or renew government contracts during regulated procurement processes could harm our operations and reduce our profits and revenues.

        Government contracts are awarded through a regulated procurement process. The federal government has relied upon multi-year contracts with pre-established terms and conditions, such as indefinite delivery contracts, that generally require those contractors that have previously been awarded the indefinite delivery contract to engage in an additional competitive bidding process before a task order is issued. In addition, we believe that there has been an increase in the award of federal contracts based on a low-price, technically acceptable criteria emphasizing price over qualitative factors, such as past performance. As a result, pricing pressure may reduce our profit margins on future federal contracts. The increased competition and pricing pressure, in turn, may require us to make sustained efforts to reduce costs in order to realize revenues and profits under government contracts. If we are not successful in reducing the amount of costs we incur, our profitability on government contracts will be negatively impacted. In addition, we may not be awarded government contracts because of existing government policies designed to protect small businesses and under-represented minority contractors. Our inability to win or renew government contracts during regulated procurement processes could harm our operations and reduce our profits and revenues.

Governmental agencies may modify, curtail or terminate our contracts at any time prior to their completion and, if we do not replace them, we may suffer a decline in revenue.

        Most government contracts may be modified, curtailed or terminated by the government either at its discretion or upon the default of the contractor. If the government terminates a contract at its discretion, then we typically are able to recover only costs incurred or committed, settlement expenses and profit on work completed prior to termination, which could prevent us from recognizing all of our potential revenue and profits from that contract. In addition, the U.S. government has announced its intention to scale back outsourcing of services in favor of "insourcing" jobs to its employees, which could reduce the number of contracts awarded to us. The adoption of similar practices by other government entities could also

15


Table of Contents

adversely affect our revenues. If a government terminates a contract due to our default, we could be liable for excess costs incurred by the government in obtaining services from another source.

Demand for our services is cyclical and may be vulnerable to sudden economic downturns and reductions in government and private industry spending. If economic conditions remain weak and decline further, our revenue and profitability could be adversely affected.

        Demand for our services is cyclical and may be vulnerable to sudden economic downturns and reductions in government and private industry spending, such as, for example, changes in oil and natural gas prices, and limited pipeline capacity for oil produced in the Canadian oil sands, which may result in clients delaying, curtailing or canceling proposed and existing projects. Economic conditions in the U.S. and a number of other countries and regions, including the United Kingdom and Australia, have been weak and may remain difficult for the foreseeable future. If global economic and financial market conditions remain weak and/or decline further, some of our clients may face considerable budget shortfalls that may limit their overall demand for our services. In addition, our clients may find it more difficult to raise capital in the future to fund their projects due to uncertainty in the municipal and general credit markets.

        Where economies are weakening, our clients may demand more favorable pricing or other terms while their ability to pay our invoices or to pay them in a timely manner may be adversely affected. Our government clients may face budget deficits that prohibit them from funding proposed and existing projects. If economic conditions remain uncertain and/or weaken and/or government spending is reduced, our revenue and profitability could be adversely affected.

Our contracts with governmental agencies are subject to audit, which could result in adjustments to reimbursable contract costs or, if we are charged with wrongdoing, possible temporary or permanent suspension from participating in government programs.

        Our books and records are subject to audit by the various governmental agencies we serve and their representatives. These audits can result in adjustments to the amount of contract costs we believe are reimbursable by the agencies and the amount of our overhead costs allocated to the agencies. If such matters are not resolved in our favor, they could have a material adverse effect on our business. In addition, if one of our subsidiaries is charged with wrongdoing as a result of an audit, that subsidiary, and possibly our company as a whole, could be temporarily suspended or could be prohibited from bidding on and receiving future government contracts for a period of time. Furthermore, as a government contractor, we are subject to an increased risk of investigations, criminal prosecution, civil fraud actions, whistleblower lawsuits and other legal actions and liabilities to which purely private sector companies are not, the results of which could materially adversely impact our business.

An impairment charge of goodwill could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations.

        Because we have grown in part through acquisitions, goodwill and intangible assets-net represent a substantial portion of our assets. Goodwill and intangible assets-net were $2.0 billion as of September 30, 2014. Under GAAP, we are required to test goodwill carried in our Consolidated Balance Sheets for possible impairment on an annual basis based upon a fair value approach and whenever events occur that indicate impairment could exist. These events or circumstances could include a significant change in the business climate, including a significant sustained decline in a reporting unit's market value, legal factors, operating performance indicators, competition, sale or disposition of a significant portion of our business, a significant sustained decline in our market capitalization and other factors.

        In connection with our annual goodwill impairment testing for fiscal 2012, we recorded an impairment charge of $336 million due to market conditions and business trends within the Europe, Middle East, and

16


Table of Contents

Africa ("EMEA") and MSS reporting units. We cannot accurately predict the amount and timing of any future impairment. In addition to the goodwill impairment charge we recorded in fiscal 2012, we may be required to take additional goodwill impairment charges relating to certain of our reporting units if the fair value of our reporting units is less than their carrying value. Similarly, certain Company transactions, such as merger and acquisition transactions, could result in additional goodwill impairment charges being recorded.

        In addition, if we experience a decrease in our stock price and market capitalization over a sustained period, we would have to record an impairment charge in the future. The amount of any impairment could be significant and could have a material adverse impact on our financial condition and results of operations for the period in which the charge is taken.

Our operations worldwide expose us to legal, political and economic risks in different countries as well as currency exchange rate fluctuations that could harm our business and financial results.

        During fiscal 2014, revenue attributable to our services provided outside of the United States to non-U.S. clients was approximately 41% of our total revenue. There are risks inherent in doing business internationally, including:

        Any of these factors could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition.

Political, economic and military conditions in the Middle East, Africa and other regions could negatively impact our business.

        In recent years, there has been a substantial amount of hostilities, civil unrest and other political uncertainty in certain areas in the Middle East, North Africa and beyond. If civil unrest were to disrupt our business in any of these regions, and particularly if political activities were to result in prolonged hostilities, unrest or civil war, it could result in operating losses and asset write downs and our financial condition could be adversely affected.

We operate in many different jurisdictions and we could be adversely affected by violations of the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and similar worldwide anti-corruption laws.

        The U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act ("FCPA") and similar worldwide anti-corruption laws, including the U.K. Bribery Act of 2010, generally prohibit companies and their intermediaries from making improper payments to non-U.S. officials for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. Our internal policies mandate compliance with these anti-corruption laws, including the requirements to maintain accurate information and internal controls which may fall within the purview of the FCPA, its books and

17


Table of Contents

records provisions or its anti-bribery provisions. We operate in many parts of the world that have experienced governmental corruption to some degree and, in certain circumstances, strict compliance with anti-corruption laws may conflict with local customs and practices. Despite our training and compliance programs, we cannot assure that our internal control policies and procedures always will protect us from reckless or criminal acts committed by our employees or agents. Our continued expansion outside the U.S., including in developing countries, could increase the risk of such violations in the future. In addition, from time to time, government investigations of corruption in construction-related industries affect us and our peers. Violations of these laws, or allegations of such violations, could disrupt our business and result in a material adverse effect on our results of operations or financial condition.

Many of our project sites are inherently dangerous workplaces. Failure to maintain safe work sites and equipment could result in environmental disasters, employee deaths or injuries, reduced profitability, the loss of projects or clients and possible exposure to litigation.

        Our project sites often put our employees and others in close proximity with mechanized equipment, moving vehicles, chemical and manufacturing processes, and highly regulated materials. On some project sites, we may be responsible for safety and, accordingly, we have an obligation to implement effective safety procedures. If we fail to implement these procedures or if the procedures we implement are ineffective, we may suffer the loss of or injury to our employees, as well as expose ourselves to possible litigation. As a result, our failure to maintain adequate safety standards and equipment could result in reduced profitability or the loss of projects or clients, and could have a material adverse impact on our business, financial condition, and results of operations.

We work in international locations where there are high security risks, which could result in harm to our employees and contractors or material costs to us.

        Some of our services are performed in high-risk locations, such as Afghanistan, the Middle East, Iraq and Libya until relatively recently, and Southwest Asia, where the country or location is suffering from political, social or economic problems, or war or civil unrest. In those locations where we have employees or operations, we may incur material costs to maintain the safety of our personnel. Despite these precautions, the safety of our personnel in these locations may continue to be at risk. Acts of terrorism and threats of armed conflicts in or around various areas in which we operate could limit or disrupt markets and our operations, including disruptions resulting from the evacuation of personnel, cancellation of contracts, or the loss of key employees, contractors or assets.

Cyber security breaches of our systems and information technology could adversely impact our ability to operate.

        We develop, install and maintain information technology systems for ourselves, as well as for customers. Client contracts for the performance of information technology services, as well as various privacy and securities laws, require us to manage and protect sensitive and confidential information from disclosure. We also need to protect our own internal trade secrets and other business confidential information from disclosure. We face the threat to our computer systems of unauthorized access, computer hackers, computer viruses, malicious code, organized cyber attacks and other security problems and system disruptions, including possible unauthorized access to our and our clients' proprietary or classified information. We rely on industry-accepted security measures and technology to securely maintain all confidential and proprietary information on our information systems. We have devoted and will continue to devote significant resources to the security of our computer systems, but they may still be vulnerable to these threats. A user who circumvents security measures could misappropriate confidential or proprietary information, including information regarding us, our personnel and/or our clients, or cause interruptions or malfunctions in operations. As a result, we may be required to expend significant resources to protect against the threat of these system disruptions and security breaches or to alleviate problems caused by

18


Table of Contents

these disruptions and breaches. Any of these events could damage our reputation and have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

Our business and operating results could be adversely affected by losses under fixed-price contracts.

        Fixed-price contracts require us to either perform all work under the contract for a specified lump-sum or to perform an estimated number of units of work at an agreed price per unit, with the total payment determined by the actual number of units performed. In fiscal 2014, approximately 48% of our revenue was recognized under fixed-price contracts. Fixed-price contracts expose us to a number of risks not inherent in cost-plus and time and material contracts, including underestimation of costs, ambiguities in specifications, unforeseen costs or difficulties, problems with new technologies, delays beyond our control, failures of subcontractors to perform and economic or other changes that may occur during the contract period. In addition, our exposure to construction cost overruns may increase over time as we increase our construction services. Losses under fixed-price contracts could be substantial and adversely impact our results of operations.

Our failure to meet contractual schedule or performance requirements that we have guaranteed could adversely affect our operating results.

        In certain circumstances, we can incur liquidated or other damages if we do not achieve project completion by a scheduled date. If we or an entity for which we have provided a guarantee subsequently fails to complete the project as scheduled and the matter cannot be satisfactorily resolved with the client, we may be responsible for cost impacts to the client resulting from any delay or the cost to complete the project. Our costs generally increase from schedule delays and/or could exceed our projections for a particular project. In addition, performance of projects can be affected by a number of factors beyond our control, including unavoidable delays from governmental inaction, public opposition, inability to obtain financing, weather conditions, unavailability of vendor materials, changes in the project scope of services requested by our clients, industrial accidents, environmental hazards, labor disruptions and other factors. Although we have not suffered material impacts to our results of operations due to any schedule or performance issues for the periods presented in this report, material performance problems for existing and future contracts could cause actual results of operations to differ from those anticipated by us and also could cause us to suffer damage to our reputation within our industry and client base.

We participate in certain joint ventures where we provide guarantees and may be adversely impacted by the failure of the joint venture or its participants to fulfill their obligations.

        We have investments in and commitments to certain joint ventures with unrelated parties, including in connection with the investment activities of AECOM Capital. These joint ventures from time to time borrow money to help finance their activities and in certain circumstances, we are required to provide guarantees of certain obligations of our affiliated entities, including guarantees for completion of projects, repayment of debt, environmental indemnity obligations and acts of willful misconduct. If these entities are not able to honor their obligations, under the guarantees, we may be required to expend additional resources or suffer losses, which could be significant.

We conduct a portion of our operations through joint venture entities, over which we may have limited control.

        Approximately 11% of our fiscal 2014 revenue was derived from our operations through joint ventures or similar partnership arrangements, where control may be shared with unaffiliated third parties. As with most joint venture arrangements, differences in views among the joint venture participants may result in delayed decisions or disputes. We also cannot control the actions of our joint venture partners, and we typically have joint and several liability with our joint venture partners under the applicable contracts for joint venture projects. These factors could potentially adversely impact the business and operations of a joint venture and, in turn, our business and operations.

19


Table of Contents

        Operating through joint ventures in which we are minority holders results in us having limited control over many decisions made with respect to projects and internal controls relating to projects. Sales of our services provided to our unconsolidated joint ventures were approximately 4% of our fiscal 2014 revenue. We generally do not have control of these unconsolidated joint ventures. These joint ventures may not be subject to the same requirements regarding internal controls and internal control over financial reporting that we follow. As a result, internal control problems may arise with respect to these joint ventures, which could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations and could also affect our reputation in the industries we serve.

Systems and information technology interruption and unexpected data or vendor loss could adversely impact our ability to operate.

        We rely heavily on computer, information and communications technology and related systems in order to properly operate. From time to time, we experience occasional system interruptions and delays. If we are unable to continually add software and hardware, effectively upgrade our systems and network infrastructure and take other steps to improve the efficiency of and protect our systems, the operation of our systems could be interrupted or delayed. Our computer and communications systems and operations could be damaged or interrupted by natural disasters, telecommunications failures, acts of war or terrorism and similar events or disruptions. Any of these or other events could cause system interruption, delays and loss of critical data, or delay or prevent operations, and adversely affect our operating results.

        We also rely in part on third-party internal and outsourced software to run our critical accounting, project management and financial information systems. We depend on our software vendors to provide long-term software maintenance support for our information systems. Software vendors may decide to discontinue further development, integration or long-term software maintenance support for our information systems, in which case we may need to abandon one or more of our current information systems and migrate some or all of our accounting, project management and financial information to other systems, thus increasing our operational expense, as well as disrupting the management of our business operations..

Misconduct by our employees, partners or consultants or our failure to comply with laws or regulations applicable to our business could cause us to lose customers or lose our ability to contract with government agencies.

        As a government contractor, misconduct, fraud or other improper activities caused by our employees', partners' or consultants' failure to comply with laws or regulations could have a significant negative impact on our business and reputation. Such misconduct could include the failure to comply with federal procurement regulations, environmental regulations, regulations regarding the protection of sensitive government information, legislation regarding the pricing of labor and other costs in government contracts, regulations on lobbying or similar activities, and anti-corruption, export control and other applicable laws or regulations. Our failure to comply with applicable laws or regulations, misconduct by any of our employees or consultants or our failure to make timely and accurate certifications to government agencies regarding misconduct or potential misconduct could subject us to fines and penalties, loss of government granted eligibility, cancellation of contracts and suspension or debarment from contracting with government agencies, any of which may adversely affect our business.

We may be required to contribute additional cash to meet our significant underfunded benefit obligations associated with retirement and post-retirement benefit plans we manage or multiemployer pension plans in which we participate.

        We have defined benefit pension plans for employees in the United States, United Kingdom, Australia, and Ireland. At September 30, 2014, our defined benefit pension plans had an aggregate deficit (the excess of projected benefit obligations over the fair value of plan assets) of approximately $221.3 million. In the future, our pension deficits may increase or decrease depending on changes in the

20


Table of Contents

levels of interest rates, pension plan performance and other factors. Because the current economic environment has resulted in declining investment returns and interest rates, we may be required to make additional cash contributions to our pension plans and recognize further increases in our net pension cost to satisfy our funding requirements. If we are forced or elect to make up all or a portion of the deficit for unfunded benefit plans, our results of operations could be materially and adversely affected.

        A multiemployer pension plan is typically established under a collective bargaining agreement with a union to cover the union-represented workers of various unrelated companies. Our collective bargaining agreements with unions will require us to contribute to various multiemployer pension plans; however, we do not control or manage these plans. Prior to the URS acquisition, for the year ended January 3, 2014, URS contributed $49.7 million to multiemployer pension plans. Under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act, an employer who contributes to a multiemployer pension plan, absent an applicable exemption, may also be liable, upon termination or withdrawal from the plan, for its proportionate share of the multiemployer pension plan's unfunded vested benefit. If we terminate or withdraw from a multiemployer plan, absent an applicable exemption (such as for some plans in the building and construction industry), we could be required to contribute a significant amount of cash to fund the multiemployer plan's unfunded vested benefit, which could materially and adversely affect our financial results; however, since we do not control the multiemployer plans, we are unable to estimate any potential contributions that could be required.

New legal requirements could adversely affect our operating results.

        Our business and results of operations could be adversely affected by the passage of U.S. health care reform, climate change, defense, environmental and infrastructure industry specific and other legislation and regulations. We are continually assessing the impact that health care reform could have on our employer-sponsored medical plans. Growing concerns about climate change may result in the imposition of additional environmental regulations. For example, legislation, international protocols, regulation or other restrictions on emissions could increase the costs of projects for our clients or, in some cases, prevent a project from going forward, thereby potentially reducing the need for our services. In addition, relaxation or repeal of laws and regulations, or changes in governmental policies regarding environmental, defense, infrastructure or other industries we serve, could result in a decline in demand for our services, which could in turn negatively impact our revenues.

        However, these changes could also increase the pace of development of other projects, which could have a positive impact on our business. We cannot predict when or whether any of these various proposals may be enacted or what their effect will be on us or on our customers.

We may be subject to substantial liabilities under environmental laws and regulations.

        Our services are subject to numerous environmental protection laws and regulations that are complex and stringent. Our business involves in part the planning, design, program management, construction and construction management, and operations and maintenance at various sites, including but not limited to pollution control systems, nuclear facilities, hazardous waste and Superfund sites, contract mining sites, hydrocarbon production, distribution and transport sites, military bases and other infrastructure-related facilities. We also regularly perform work, including oil field and pipeline construction services in and around sensitive environmental areas, such as rivers, lakes and wetlands. In addition, we have contracts with U.S. federal government entities to destroy hazardous materials, including chemical agents and weapons stockpiles, as well as to decontaminate and decommission nuclear facilities. These activities may require us to manage, handle, remove, treat, transport and dispose of toxic or hazardous substances. We also own and operate several properties in the U.S. and Canada that have been used for the storage and maintenance of equipment and upon which hydrocarbons or other wastes may have been disposed or released. Past business practices at companies that we have acquired may also expose us to future unknown environmental liabilities.

21


Table of Contents

        Significant fines, penalties and other sanctions may be imposed for non-compliance with environmental laws and regulations, and some environmental laws provide for joint and several strict liabilities for remediation of releases of hazardous substances, rendering a person liable for environmental damage, without regard to negligence or fault on the part of such person. These laws and regulations may expose us to liability arising out of the conduct of operations or conditions caused by others, or for our acts that were in compliance with all applicable laws at the time these acts were performed. For example, there are a number of governmental laws that strictly regulate the handling, removal, treatment, transportation and disposal of toxic and hazardous substances, such as Comprehensive Environmental Response Compensation and Liability Act of 1980, and comparable state laws, that impose strict, joint and several liabilities for the entire cost of cleanup, without regard to whether a company knew of or caused the release of hazardous substances. In addition, some environmental regulations can impose liability for the entire cleanup upon owners, operators, generators, transporters and other persons arranging for the treatment or disposal of such hazardous substances related to contaminated facilities or project sites. Other federal environmental, health and safety laws affecting us include, but are not limited to, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, the National Environmental Policy Act, the Clean Air Act, the Clean Air Mercury Rule, the Occupational Safety and Health Act, the Toxic Substances Control Act and the Superfund Amendments and Reauthorization Act and the Energy Reorganization Act of 1974, as well as other comparable national and state laws. Liabilities related to environmental contamination or human exposure to hazardous substances, or a failure to comply with applicable regulations could result in substantial costs to us, including cleanup costs, fines and civil or criminal sanctions, third-party claims for property damage or personal injury or cessation of remediation activities. Our continuing work in the areas governed by these laws and regulations exposes us to the risk of substantial liability.

Demand for our oil and gas services fluctuates.

        Our acquisition of URS significantly increased our oil and gas services in North America, particularly to the unconventional segments of this market. Demand for our oil and gas services fluctuates, and we depend on our customers' willingness to make future expenditures to explore for, develop and produce oil and natural gas in the U.S. and Canada. Our customers' willingness to undertake these activities depends largely upon prevailing industry conditions that are influenced by numerous factors over which we have no control, including:

        Anticipated future prices for natural gas and crude oil are a primary factor affecting spending and drilling activity by our customers. Lower prices or volatility in prices for oil and natural gas typically decrease spending and drilling activity, which can cause rapid and material declines in demand for our services and in the prices we are able to charge for our services. In addition, should the proposed Canada-U.S. Keystone XL pipeline or other similar proposed pipeline project applications be denied or further delayed by the federal government, then there may be a slowing of spending in the development of

22


Table of Contents

the Canadian oil sands. Worldwide political, economic, military and terrorist events, as well as natural disasters and other factors beyond our control contribute to oil and natural gas price levels and volatility and are likely to continue to do so in the future.

Failure to successfully execute our acquisition strategy may inhibit our growth.

        We have grown in part as a result of our acquisitions over the last several years, and we expect continued growth in the form of additional acquisitions and expansion into new markets. If we are unable to pursue suitable acquisition opportunities, as a result of global economic uncertainty or other factors, our growth may be inhibited. We cannot assure that suitable acquisitions or investment opportunities will continue to be identified or that any of these transactions can be consummated on favorable terms or at all. Any future acquisitions will involve various inherent risks, such as:

        Furthermore, during the acquisition process and thereafter, our management may need to assume significant transaction-related responsibilities, which may cause them to divert their attention from our existing operations. If our management is unable to successfully integrate acquired companies or implement our growth strategy, our operating results could be harmed. In addition, even if the operations of an acquisition are integrated successfully, we may not realize the full benefits of the acquisition, including the synergies, cost savings, or sales or growth opportunities that we expect. These benefits may not be achieved within the anticipated time frame, or at all. Moreover, we cannot assure that we will continue to successfully expand or that growth or expansion will result in profitability.

Uncertainties associated with the URS acquisition may cause a loss of management personnel and other key employees which could adversely affect our future business, operations and financial results following the URS acquisition.

        We and our subsidiaries are dependent on the experience and industry knowledge of our senior management and other key employees to execute our business plans. Our success following the URS acquisition will continue to depend in part upon our ability to retain key management personnel and other key employees. Our current and prospective employees may experience uncertainty about their roles within our company, which may have an adverse effect on the ability of each of us to attract or retain key management and other key personnel.

        Accordingly, no assurance can be given that we will be able to attract or retain our key management personnel and other key employees to the same extent that our companies have previously been able to attract or retain employees prior to the URS acquisition. In addition, we might not be able to locate suitable replacements for any such key employees who leave us or offer employment to potential replacements on reasonable terms.

23


Table of Contents

Although we expect to realize certain benefits as a result of the URS acquisition, there is the possibility that we may be unable to successfully integrate our and URS's businesses in order to realize the anticipated benefits of the URS acquisition or do so within the intended timeframe.

        As a result of the URS acquisition, we have been, and will continue to be, required to devote significant management attention and resources to integrating the business practices and operations of URS with our business. Difficulties we may encounter as part of the integration process include the following:

        Any of these factors could adversely affect each company's ability to maintain relationships with customers, suppliers, employees and other constituencies or our ability to achieve the anticipated benefits of the URS acquisition or could reduce each company's earnings or otherwise adversely affect our business and financial results.

Our substantial leverage and significant debt service obligations could adversely affect our financial condition and our ability to fulfill our obligations and operate our business.

        After giving pro forma effect to the URS acquisition and the financing transactions in connection with the URS acquisition, we and our subsidiaries would have had approximately $5.2 billion of indebtedness (excluding intercompany indebtedness) outstanding as of September 30, 2014, of which $3.2 billion was secured obligations (exclusive of $104 million of outstanding undrawn letters of credit) and we had an additional $601 million of availability under our new credit facility entered into on October 17, 2014 as described in Note 24. "Subsequent Events," of this report (the "New Credit Facility") (after giving effect to outstanding letters of credit), all of which would be secured debt if drawn. Our financial performance could be adversely affected by our substantial leverage. We may also incur significant additional indebtedness in the future, subject to certain conditions.

24


Table of Contents

        This high level of indebtedness could have important negative consequences to us, including, but not limited to:

        Our high level of indebtedness requires that we use a substantial portion of our cash flow from operations to pay principal of, and interest on, our indebtedness, which will reduce the availability of cash to fund working capital requirements, future acquisitions, capital expenditures or other general corporate or business activities.

        In addition, a substantial portion of our indebtedness bears interest at variable rates, including borrowings under our New Credit Facility. If market interest rates increase, debt service on our variable-rate debt will rise, which could adversely affect our cash flow, results of operations and financial position. Although we may employ hedging strategies such that a portion of the aggregate principal amount of our term loans carries a fixed rate of interest, any hedging arrangement put in place may not offer complete protection from this risk. Additionally, the remaining portion of borrowings under our New Credit Facility that is not hedged will be subject to changes in interest rates.

The agreements governing our debt contain a number of restrictive covenants which will limit our ability to finance future operations, acquisitions or capital needs or engage in other business activities that may be in our interest.

        The credit agreement that governs the New Credit Facility and the indenture governing the senior unsecured notes in the principal amount of $1.6 billion offered by us through a private offering on October 6, 2014 contain a number of significant covenants that impose operating and other restrictions on

25


Table of Contents

us and our subsidiaries. Such restrictions affect or will affect, and in many respects limit or prohibit, among other things, our ability and the ability of certain of our subsidiaries to:

        In addition, our New Credit Facility will also require us to comply with an interest coverage ratio and consolidated leverage ratio. Our ability to comply with these ratios may be affected by events beyond our control.

        These restrictions could limit our ability to plan for or react to market or economic conditions or meet capital needs or otherwise restrict our activities or business plans, and could adversely affect our ability to finance our operations, acquisitions, investments or strategic alliances or other capital needs or to engage in other business activities that would be in our interest.

        A breach of any of these covenants or our inability to comply with the required financial ratios could result in a default under all or certain of our debt instruments. If an event of default occurs, our creditors could elect to:

        If we were unable to repay or otherwise refinance these borrowings when due, the applicable creditors could sell the collateral securing certain of our debt instruments, which constitutes substantially all of our domestic and foreign, wholly owned subsidiaries' assets.

Our variable rate indebtedness subjects us to interest rate risk, which could cause our debt service obligations to increase significantly.

        Borrowings under our New Credit Facility are at variable rates of interest and expose us to interest rate risk. If interest rates increase, our debt service obligations on the variable rate indebtedness will increase even though the amount borrowed remains the same, and our net income and cash flows, including cash available for servicing our indebtedness, will correspondingly decrease. A 0.125% increase in such interest rates would increase total interest expense under our New Credit Facility for the twelve months ended September 30, 2014 on a pro forma basis by $2 million, and a 0.125% decrease in such interest rates would decrease total interest expense for the term loan under our New Credit Facility for the same period on a pro forma basis by $2 million, without giving effect to any interest rate swaps that we may enter into. We may, from time to time, enter into interest rate swaps that involve the exchange of floating for fixed rate interest payments in order to reduce interest rate volatility. However, we may not maintain

26


Table of Contents

interest rate swaps with respect to all of our variable rate indebtedness, and any swaps we enter into may not fully mitigate our interest rate risk and could be subject to credit risk themselves.

If we are unable to continue to access credit on acceptable terms, our business may be adversely affected.

        The state of the global credit markets could make it more difficult for us to access funds, refinance our existing indebtedness, enter into agreements for uncommitted bond facilities and new indebtedness, replace our existing revolving and term credit agreements or obtain funding through the issuance of our securities. We use credit facilities to support our working capital and acquisition needs. There is no guarantee that we can continue to renew our credit facility on terms as favorable as those in our existing credit facility and, if we are unable to do so, our costs of borrowing and our business may be adversely affected.

Our ability to grow and to compete in our industry will be harmed if we do not retain the continued services of our key technical and management personnel and identify, hire, and retain additional qualified personnel.

        There is strong competition for qualified technical and management personnel in the sectors in which we compete. We may not be able to continue to attract and retain qualified technical and management personnel, such as engineers, architects and project managers, who are necessary for the development of our business or to replace qualified personnel in the timeframe demanded by our clients. Our planned growth may place increased demands on our resources and will likely require the addition of technical and management personnel and the development of additional expertise by existing personnel. In addition, we may occasionally enter into contracts before we have hired or retained appropriate staffing for that project. Also, some of our personnel hold government granted eligibility that may be required to obtain certain government projects. If we were to lose some or all of these personnel, they would be difficult to replace. In addition, we rely heavily upon the expertise and leadership of our senior management. If we are unable to retain executives and other key personnel, the roles and responsibilities of those employees will need to be filled, which may require that we devote time and resources to identify, hire and integrate new employees. Loss of the services of, or failure to recruit, key technical and management personnel could limit our ability to successfully complete existing projects and compete for new projects.

Our revenue and growth prospects may be harmed if we or our employees are unable to obtain government granted eligibility or other qualifications we and they need to perform services for our customers.

        A number of government programs require contractors to have certain kinds of government granted eligibility, such as security clearance credentials. Depending on the project, eligibility can be difficult and time-consuming to obtain. If we or our employees are unable to obtain or retain the necessary eligibility, including local ownership requirements, we may not be able to win new business, and our existing customers could terminate their contracts with us or decide not to renew them. To the extent we cannot obtain or maintain the required security clearances for our employees working on a particular contract, we may not derive the revenue or profit anticipated from such contract.

Our industry is highly competitive and we may be unable to compete effectively, which could result in reduced revenue, profitability and market share.

        We are engaged in a highly competitive business. The professional technical and management support services markets we serve are highly fragmented and we compete with a large number of regional, national and international companies. Certain of these competitors have greater financial and other resources than we do. Others are smaller and more specialized, and concentrate their resources in particular areas of expertise. The extent of our competition varies according to the particular markets and geographic area. In addition, the technical and professional aspects of some of our services generally do not require large upfront capital expenditures and provide limited barriers against new competitors.

27


Table of Contents

        The degree and type of competition we face is also influenced by the type and scope of a particular project. Our clients make competitive determinations based upon qualifications, experience, performance, reputation, technology, customer relationships and ability to provide the relevant services in a timely, safe and cost-efficient manner. Increased competition may result in our inability to win bids for future projects and loss of revenue, profitability and market share.

If we extend a significant portion of our credit to clients in a specific geographic area or industry, we may experience disproportionately high levels of collection risk and nonpayment if those clients are adversely affected by factors particular to their geographic area or industry.

        Our clients include public and private entities that have been, and may continue to be, negatively impacted by the changing landscape in the global economy. While outside of the U.S. federal government no one client accounted for over 10% of our revenue for fiscal 2014, we face collection risk as a normal part of our business where we perform services and subsequently bill our clients for such services, or when we make equity investments in majority or minority controlled large-scale client projects and other long-term capital projects before the project completes operational status or completes its project financing. In the event that we have concentrated credit risk from clients in a specific geographic area or industry, continuing negative trends or a worsening in the financial condition of that specific geographic area or industry could make us susceptible to disproportionately high levels of default by those clients. Such defaults could materially adversely impact our revenues and our results of operations.

Our services expose us to significant risks of liability and our insurance policies may not provide adequate coverage.

        Our services involve significant risks of professional and other liabilities that may substantially exceed the fees that we derive from our services. In addition, we sometimes contractually assume liability to clients on projects under indemnification agreements. We cannot predict the magnitude of potential liabilities from the operation of our business. In addition, in the ordinary course of our business, we frequently make professional judgments and recommendations about environmental and engineering conditions of project sites for our clients. We may be deemed to be responsible for these judgments and recommendations if such judgments and recommendations are later determined to be inaccurate. Any unfavorable legal ruling against us could result in substantial monetary damages or even criminal violations.

        Our professional liability policies cover only claims made during the term of the policy. Additionally, our insurance policies may not protect us against potential liability due to various exclusions in the policies and self-insured retention amounts. Partially or completely uninsured claims, if successful and of significant magnitude, could have a material adverse effect on our business.

Unavailability or cancellation of third-party insurance coverage would increase our overall risk exposure as well as disrupt the management of our business operations.

        We maintain insurance coverage from third-party insurers as part of our overall risk management strategy and because some of our contracts require us to maintain specific insurance coverage limits. If any of our third-party insurers fail, suddenly cancel our coverage or otherwise are unable to provide us with adequate insurance coverage then our overall risk exposure and our operational expenses would increase and the management of our business operations would be disrupted. In addition, there can be no assurance that any of our existing insurance coverage will be renewable upon the expiration of the coverage period or that future coverage will be affordable at the required limits.

If we do not have adequate indemnification for our services related to nuclear materials, it could adversely affect our business and financial condition.

        We provide services to the Department of Energy relating to our nuclear weapons facilities and the nuclear energy industry in the ongoing maintenance and modification, as well as the decontamination and

28


Table of Contents

decommissioning, of our nuclear energy plants. Indemnification provisions under the Price-Anderson Act available to nuclear energy plant operators and Department of Energy contractors do not apply to all liabilities that we might incur while performing services as a radioactive materials cleanup contractor for the Department of Energy and the nuclear energy industry. If the Price-Anderson Act's indemnification protection does not apply to our services or if our exposure occurs outside the U.S., our business and financial condition could be adversely affected either by our client's refusal to retain us, by our inability to obtain commercially adequate insurance and indemnification, or by potentially significant monetary damages we may incur.

        We also provide services to the United Kingdom's Nuclear Decommissioning Authority (NDA) relating to clean-up and decommissioning of the United Kingdom's public sector nuclear sites. Indemnification provisions under the Nuclear Installations Act 1965 available to nuclear site licensees, the Atomic Energy Authority, and the Crown, and contractual indemnification from the NDA do not apply to all liabilities that we might incur while performing services as a clean-up and decommissioning contractor for the NDA. If the Nuclear Installations Act 1965 and contractual indemnification protection does not apply to our services or if our exposure occurs outside the United Kingdom, our business and financial condition could be adversely affected either by our client's refusal to retain us, by our inability to obtain commercially adequate insurance and indemnification, or by potentially significant monetary damages we may incur.

Our backlog of uncompleted projects under contract is subject to unexpected adjustments and cancellations and, thus, may not accurately reflect future revenue and profits.

        At September 30, 2014, our contracted backlog was approximately $11.4 billion and our awarded backlog was approximately $13.7 billion for a total backlog of $25.1 billion. Our contracted backlog includes revenue we expect to record in the future from signed contracts and, in the case of a public sector client, where the project has been funded. Our awarded backlog includes revenue we expect to record in the future where we have been awarded the work, but the contractual agreement has not yet been signed. We cannot guarantee that future revenue will be realized from either category of backlog or, if realized, will result in profits. Many projects may remain in our backlog for an extended period of time because of the size or long-term nature of the contract. In addition, from time to time, projects are delayed, scaled back or canceled. These types of backlog reductions adversely affect the revenue and profits that we ultimately receive from contracts reflected in our backlog.

We have submitted claims to clients for work we performed beyond the initial scope of some of our contracts. If these clients do not approve these claims, our results of operations could be adversely impacted.

        We typically have pending claims submitted under some of our contracts for payment of work performed beyond the initial contractual requirements for which we have already recorded revenue. In general, we cannot guarantee that such claims will be approved in whole, in part, or at all. Often, these claims can be the subject of lengthy arbitration or litigation proceedings, and it is difficult to accurately predict when these claims will be fully resolved. When these types of events occur and unresolved claims are pending, we have used working capital in projects to cover cost overruns pending the resolution of the relevant claims. If these claims are not approved, our revenue may be reduced in future periods.

In conducting our business, we depend on other contractors, subcontractors and equipment and material providers. If these parties fail to satisfy their obligations to us or other parties or if we are unable to maintain these relationships, our revenue, profitability and growth prospects could be adversely affected.

        We depend on contractors, subcontractors and equipment and material providers in conducting our business. There is a risk that we may have disputes with our subcontractors arising from, among other things, the quality and timeliness of work performed by the subcontractor, customer concerns about the subcontractor, or our failure to extend existing task orders or issue new task orders under a subcontract.

29


Table of Contents

Also, to the extent that we cannot acquire equipment and materials at reasonable costs, or if the amount we are required to pay exceeds our estimates, our ability to complete a project in a timely fashion or at a profit may be impaired. In addition, if any of our subcontractors fail to deliver on a timely basis the agreed-upon supplies and/or perform the agreed-upon services, our ability to fulfill our obligations as a prime contractor may be jeopardized, we could be held responsible for such failures and/or we may be required to purchase the supplies or services from another source at a higher price. This may reduce the profit to be realized or result in a loss on a project for which the supplies or services are needed.

        We also rely on relationships with other contractors when we act as their subcontractor or joint venture partner. Our future revenue and growth prospects could be adversely affected if other contractors eliminate or reduce their subcontracts or joint venture relationships with us, or if a government agency terminates or reduces these other contractors' programs, does not award them new contracts or refuses to pay under a contract. In addition, due to "pay when paid" provisions that are common in subcontracts in certain countries, including the U.S., we could experience delays in receiving payment if the prime contractor experiences payment delays.

If clients use our reports or other work product without appropriate disclaimers or in a misleading or incomplete manner, or if our reports or other work product are not in compliance with professional standards and other regulations, our business could be adversely affected.

        The reports and other work product we produce for clients sometimes include projections, forecasts and other forward-looking statements. Such information by its nature is subject to numerous risks and uncertainties, any of which could cause the information produced by us to ultimately prove inaccurate. While we include appropriate disclaimers in the reports that we prepare for our clients, once we produce such written work product, we do not always have the ability to control the manner in which our clients use such information. As a result, if our clients reproduce such information to solicit funds from investors for projects without appropriate disclaimers and the information proves to be incorrect, or if our clients reproduce such information for potential investors in a misleading or incomplete manner, our clients or such investors may threaten to or file suit against us for, among other things, securities law violations. If we were found to be liable for any claims related to our client work product, our business could be adversely affected.

        In addition, our reports and other work product may need to comply with professional standards, licensing requirements, securities regulations and other laws and rules governing the performance of professional services in the jurisdiction where the services are performed. We could be liable to third parties who use or rely upon our reports and other work product even if we are not contractually bound to those third parties. These events could in turn result in monetary damages and penalties.

Our quarterly operating results may fluctuate significantly.

        We experience seasonal trends in our business with our revenue typically being higher in the last half of the fiscal year. Our fourth quarter (July 1 to September 30) typically is our strongest quarter, and our first quarter is typically our weakest quarter. Our quarterly revenue, expenses and operating results may fluctuate significantly because of a number of factors, including:

30


Table of Contents

        Variations in any of these factors could cause significant fluctuations in our operating results from quarter to quarter.

Failure to adequately protect, maintain, or enforce our rights in our intellectual property may adversely limit our competitive position.

        Our success depends, in part, upon our ability to protect our intellectual property. We rely on a combination of intellectual property policies and other contractual arrangements to protect much of our intellectual property where we do not believe that trademark, patent or copyright protection is appropriate or obtainable. Trade secrets are generally difficult to protect. Although our employees are subject to confidentiality obligations, this protection may be inadequate to deter or prevent misappropriation of our confidential information and/or the infringement of our patents and copyrights. Further, we may be unable to detect unauthorized use of our intellectual property or otherwise take appropriate steps to enforce our rights. Failure to adequately protect, maintain, or enforce our intellectual property rights may adversely limit our competitive position.

Negotiations with labor unions and possible work actions could divert management attention and disrupt operations. In addition, new collective bargaining agreements or amendments to agreements could increase our labor costs and operating expenses.

        We regularly negotiate with labor unions and enter into collective bargaining agreements. The outcome of any future negotiations relating to union representation or collective bargaining agreements may not be favorable to us. We may reach agreements in collective bargaining that increase our operating expenses and lower our net income as a result of higher wages or benefit expenses. In addition, negotiations with unions could divert management attention and disrupt operations, which may adversely affect our results of operations. If we are unable to negotiate acceptable collective bargaining agreements, we may have to address the threat of union-initiated work actions, including strikes. Depending on the nature of the threat or the type and duration of any work action, these actions could disrupt our operations and adversely affect our operating results.

Our charter documents contain provisions that may delay, defer or prevent a change of control.

        Provisions of our certificate of incorporation and bylaws could make it more difficult for a third party to acquire control of us, even if the change in control would be beneficial to stockholders. These provisions include the following:

31


Table of Contents

ITEM 1B.    UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

        None.

ITEM 2.    PROPERTIES

        Our corporate offices are located in approximately 22,000 square feet of space at 1999 Avenue of the Stars, Los Angeles, California. Our other offices consist of an aggregate of approximately 6.7 million square feet worldwide. We also maintain smaller administrative or project offices. Virtually all of our offices are leased. See Note 13 in the notes to our consolidated financial statements for information regarding our lease obligations. We believe our current properties are adequate for our business operations and are not currently underutilized. We may add additional facilities from time to time in the future as the need arises.

ITEM 3.    LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

        As a government contractor, we are subject to various laws and regulations that are more restrictive than those applicable to non-government contractors. Intense government scrutiny of contractors' compliance with those laws and regulations through audits and investigations is inherent in government contracting and, from time to time, we receive inquiries, subpoenas, and similar demands related to our ongoing business with government entities. Violations can result in civil or criminal liability as well as suspension or debarment from eligibility for awards of new government contracts or option renewals.

        We are involved in various investigations, claims and lawsuits in the normal conduct of our business. Although the outcome of our legal proceedings cannot be predicted with certainty and no assurances can be provided, in the opinion of our management, based upon current information and discussions with counsel, with the exception of the matters noted below, none of the investigations, claims and lawsuits in which we are involved is expected to have a material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position, results of operations, cash flows or our ability to conduct business in Note 20, "Commitments and Contingencies," of this report, the information set forth in such note is incorporated by reference into this Item 3. The resolution of these matters is subject to inherent uncertainty, and it is reasonably possible that resolution of any of these outstanding matters could have a material adverse effect on us. From time to time, we establish reserves for litigation when we consider it probable that a loss will occur.

ITEM 4.    MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

        Not applicable.

32


Table of Contents


PART II

ITEM 5.    MARKET FOR REGISTRANT'S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

        Our common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (NYSE). According to the records of our transfer agent, there were 2,141 stockholders of record as of November 5, 2014. The following table sets forth the low and high closing sales prices of a share of our common stock during each of the fiscal quarters presented, based upon quotations on the NYSE consolidated reporting system:

 
  Low Sales
Price ($)
  High Sales
Price ($)
 

Fiscal 2014:

             

First quarter

    27.47     32.69  

Second quarter

    27.69     32.48  

Third quarter

    30.46     33.57  

Fourth quarter

    31.66     38.13  

 

 
  Low Sales
Price ($)
  High Sales
Price ($)
 

Fiscal 2013:

             

First quarter

    18.87     24.37  

Second quarter

    23.80     32.95  

Third quarter

    28.22     32.01  

Fourth quarter

    28.63     35.20  

        Our policy is to use cash flow from operations to fund future growth and pay down debt. Accordingly, we have not paid a cash dividend since our inception and we currently have no plans to pay cash dividends in the foreseeable future. Additionally, our term credit agreement and revolving credit facility restrict our ability to pay cash dividends. Our debt agreements do not permit us to pay cash dividends unless at the time of and immediately after giving effect to the dividend, (a) there is no default or event of default and (b) the leverage ratio (as defined in the debt agreements) is less than 3.00 to 1.00.

33


Table of Contents

    Equity Compensation Plans

        The following table presents certain information about our equity compensation plans as of September 30, 2014:

 
  Column A   Column B   Column C  
Plan Category
  Number of securities
to be issued upon
exercise of
outstanding options,
warrants, and rights
  Weighted-average
exercise price of
outstanding
options, warrants,
and rights
  Number of securities
remaining available for
future issuance under
equity compensation
plans (excluding
securities reflected in
Column A)
 

Equity compensation plans not approved by stockholders:

    N/A     N/A     N/A  

Equity compensation plans approved by stockholders:

                   

AECOM Technology Corporation 2006 Stock Incentive Plan

    1,634,051   $ 27.69     19,841,452  

AECOM Technology Corporation Equity Incentive Plan

    N/A     N/A     4,189,556  

AECOM Technology Corporation Employee Stock Purchase Plan

    N/A     N/A     5,803,736  

AECOM Technology Corporation Global Stock Program(a)

    N/A     N/A     22,716,027  
               

Total

    1,634,051   $ 27.69     52,550,771  
               
               

(a)
The AECOM Technology Corporation Global Stock Program consists of our plans in Australia, Hong Kong, New Zealand, Singapore, United Arab Emirates/Qatar, and United Kingdom; and for North America, the Retirement & Savings Plan and Equity Investment Plan.

    Performance Measurement Comparison(1)

        The following chart compares the percentage change of AECOM stock (ACM) with that of the S&P MidCap 400 and the S&P 1500 SuperComposite Engineering and Construction indices from October 1, 2009 to September 30, 2014. We believe the S&P MidCap 400, on which we are listed, is an appropriate independent broad market index, since it measures the performance of similar mid-sized companies in numerous sectors. In addition, we believe the S&P 1500 SuperComposite Engineering and Construction Index is an appropriate published industry index since it measures the performance of engineering and construction companies.

   


(1)
This section is not "soliciting material," is not deemed "filed" with the SEC and is not incorporated by reference in any of our filings under the Securities Act or Exchange Act whether made before or after the date hereof and irrespective of any general incorporation language in any such filing.

34


Table of Contents


Comparison of Percentage Change
October 1, 2009—September 30, 2014

GRAPHIC

End-of-Month Prices by Quarter

 
  Dec 31,
2009
  Mar 31,
2010
  Jun 30,
2010
  Sep 30,
2010
  Dec 31,
2010
  Mar 31,
2011
  Jun 30,
2011
  Sep 30,
2011
  Dec 31,
2011
  Mar 31,
2012
 

AECOM

    27.50     28.37     23.06     24.26     27.97     27.73     27.34     17.67     20.57     22.37  

S&P MidCap 400

    726.67     789.90     711.73     802.10     907.25     989.05     978.64     781.26     879.16     994.30  

S&P 1500 Super Composite Engineering and Construction

    129.42     138.10     123.09     131.29     155.98     172.46     156.12     112.61     132.27     150.66  

 

 
  Jun 30,
2012
  Sep 30,
2012
  Dec 31,
2012
  Mar 31,
2013
  Jun 30,
2013
  Sep 30,
2013
  Dec 31,
2013
  Mar 31,
2014
  Jun 30,
2014
  Sep 30,
2014
 

AECOM

    16.45     21.16     23.80     32.80     31.79     31.27     29.43     32.17     32.20     33.75  

S&P MidCap 400

    941.64     989.02     1,020.43     1,153.68     1,160.82     1,243.85     1,342.53     1,378.50     1,432.94     1,370.97  

S&P 1500 Super Composite Engineering and Construction

    129.37     145.58     157.35     181.57     173.79     187.28     200.63     202.53     190.00     180.34  

    Stock Repurchase Program

        The Company's Board of Directors has authorized the repurchase of up to $1.0 billion in Company stock. Share repurchases can be made through open market purchases or other methods, including pursuant to a Rule 10b5-1 plan. From the inception of the stock repurchase program, the Company has purchased a total of 27.4 million shares at an average price of $24.10 per share, for a total cost of $660.1 million as of September 30, 2014.

35


Table of Contents

ITEM 6.    SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

SELECTED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL DATA

        You should read the following selected consolidated financial data along with "Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations" and our consolidated financial statements and the accompanying notes, which are included in this Form 10-K. We derived the selected consolidated financial data from our audited consolidated financial statements.

 
  Year Ended September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (in millions, except per share data)
 

Consolidated Statement of Operations Data:

                               

Revenue

  $ 8,357   $ 8,153   $ 8,218   $ 8,037   $ 6,546  

Cost of revenue

    7,954     7,703     7,796     7,570     6,116  
                       

Gross profit

    403     450     422     467     430  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    58     24     49     45     21  

General and administrative expenses

    (81 )   (97 )   (81 )   (91 )   (110 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

    (27 )                

Goodwill impairment

            (336 )        
                       

Income from operations

    353     377     54     421     341  

Other income

    3     4     11     5     11  

Interest expense

    (41 )   (45 )   (47 )   (42 )   (11 )
                       

Income from continuing operations before income tax expense

    315     336     18     384     341  

Income tax expense

    82     93     75     100     92  
                       

Income (loss) from continuing operations

    233     243     (57 )   284     249  

Noncontrolling interests in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (3 )   (4 )   (2 )   (8 )   (12 )
                       

Net income (loss) attributable to AECOM

  $ 230   $ 239   $ (59 ) $ 276   $ 237  
                       
                       

Net income (loss) attributable to AECOM per share:

                               

Basic

  $ 2.36   $ 2.38   $ (0.52 ) $ 2.35   $ 2.07  

Diluted

  $ 2.33   $ 2.35   $ (0.52 ) $ 2.33   $ 2.05  
                       
                       

Weighted average shares outstanding:

                               

Basic

    97     101     112     117     114  

Diluted

    99     102     112     118     115  

 

 
  Year Ended September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (in millions, except employee data)
 

Other Data:

                               

Depreciation and amortization(1)

  $ 95   $ 94   $ 103   $ 110   $ 79  

Amortization expense of acquired intangible assets(2)

    24     21     24     36     19  

Capital expenditures

    63     52     63     78     68  

Contracted backlog

  $ 11,349   $ 8,753   $ 8,499   $ 8,881   $ 6,802  

Number of full-time and part-time employees

    43,300     45,500     46,800     45,000     48,100  

(1)
Includes amortization of deferred debt issuance costs.

(2)
Included in depreciation and amortization above.

36


Table of Contents

 
  As of September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (in millions)
 

Consolidated Balance Sheet Data:

                               

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 574   $ 601   $ 594   $ 457   $ 613  

Working capital

    978     1,078     1,069     1,176     1,094  

Total assets

    6,123     5,666     5,665     5,789     5,243  

Long-term debt excluding current portion

    940     1,089     907     1,145     915  

AECOM Stockholders' equity

    2,187     2,021     2,169     2,340     2,090  

ITEM 7.    MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

         You should read the following discussion in conjunction with our consolidated financial statements and the related notes included in this report. In addition to historical consolidated financial information, the following discussion contains forward-looking statements that reflect our plans, estimates and beliefs. You should not place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements. Our actual results could differ materially. Factors that could cause or contribute to these differences include those discussed below and elsewhere in this report, particularly in "Risk Factors."

Overview

        We are a leading provider of professional technical and management support services for public and private clients around the world. We provide our services in a broad range of end markets through a network of approximately 43,300 employees.

        Our business focuses primarily on providing fee-based professional technical and support services and therefore our business is labor and not capital intensive. We derive income from our ability to generate revenue and collect cash from our clients through the billing of our employees' time spent on client projects and our ability to manage our costs. We report our business through two segments: Professional Technical Services (PTS) and Management Support Services (MSS).

        Our PTS segment delivers planning, consulting, architectural and engineering design, and program and construction management services to commercial and government clients worldwide in major end markets such as transportation, facilities, environmental, energy, water and government. PTS revenue is primarily derived from fees from services that we provide, as opposed to pass-through fees from subcontractors and other direct costs. Our PTS segment contributed $7,609.9 million, or 91%, of our fiscal 2014 revenue.

        Our MSS segment provides program and facilities management and maintenance, training, logistics, consulting, technical assistance and systems integration services, primarily for agencies of the U.S. government. MSS revenue typically includes a significant amount of pass-through fees from subcontractors and other direct costs. Our MSS segment contributed $746.9 million, or 9%, of our fiscal 2014 revenue.

        Our revenue is dependent on our ability to attract and retain qualified and productive employees, identify business opportunities, integrate and maximize the value of our recent acquisitions, allocate our labor resources to profitable and high growth markets, secure new contracts and renew existing client agreements. Demand for our services is cyclical and may be vulnerable to sudden economic downturns and reductions in government and private industry spending, which may result in clients delaying, curtailing or canceling proposed and existing projects. Moreover, as a professional services company, maintaining the high quality of the work generated by our employees is integral to our revenue generation and profitability.

37


Table of Contents

        Our costs consist primarily of the compensation we pay to our employees, including salaries, fringe benefits, the costs of hiring subcontractors and other project-related expenses, and sales, general and administrative costs.

        We define revenue provided by acquired companies as revenue included in the current period up to twelve months subsequent to their acquisition date. Throughout this section, we refer to companies we acquired in the last twelve months as "acquired companies."

Acquisitions

        The aggregate value of all consideration for our acquisitions consummated during the year ended September 30, 2014, 2013, and 2012 was $88.5 million, $82.0 million, and $15.4 million, respectively.

        All of our acquisitions have been accounted for as business combinations and the results of operations of the acquired companies have been included in our consolidated results since the dates of the acquisitions.

Components of Income and Expense

        Our management analyzes the results of our operations using several financial measures not in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles (GAAP). A significant portion of our revenue relates to services provided by subcontractors and other non-employees that we categorize as other direct costs. Those costs are typically paid to service providers upon our receipt of payment from the client. We segregate other direct costs from revenue resulting in a measurement that we refer to as "revenue, net of other direct costs," which is a measure of work performed by AECOM employees. A large portion of our fees are derived through work performed by AECOM employees rather than other parties. We have included information on revenue, net of other direct costs, as we believe that it is useful to view our revenue exclusive of costs associated with external service providers, and the related gross margins, as discussed in "Results of Operations" below. Because of the importance of maintaining the high quality of work generated by our employees, gross margin is an important metric that we review in evaluating our operating performance.

38


Table of Contents

        The following table presents, for the periods indicated, a presentation of the non-GAAP financial measures reconciled to the closest GAAP measure:

 
  Year Ended September 30,  
 
  2014   2013   2012   2011   2010  
 
  (in millions)
 

Other Financial Data:

                               

Revenue

  $ 8,357   $ 8,153   $ 8,218   $ 8,037   $ 6,546  

Other direct costs(1)

    3,501     3,176     3,034     2,856     2,340  
                       

Revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    4,856     4,977     5,184     5,181     4,206  

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    4,453     4,527     4,762     4,714     3,776  
                       

Gross profit

    403     450     422     467     430  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    58     24     49     45     21  

General and administrative expenses

    (81 )   (97 )   (81 )   (91 )   (110 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

    (27 )                

Goodwill impairment

            (336 )        
                       

Income from operations

  $ 353   $ 377   $ 54   $ 421   $ 341  
                       
                       

Reconciliation of Cost of Revenue:

                               

Other direct costs

  $ 3,501   $ 3,176   $ 3,034   $ 2,856   $ 2,340  

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,453     4,527     4,762     4,714     3,776  
                       

Cost of revenue

  $ 7,954   $ 7,703   $ 7,796   $ 7,570   $ 6,116  
                       
                       

(1)
Non-GAAP measure

    Revenue

        We generate revenue primarily by providing professional technical and management support services for commercial and government clients around the world. Our revenue consists of both services provided by our employees and pass-through fees from subcontractors and other direct costs. We generally utilize a cost-to-cost approach in applying the percentage-of-completion method of revenue recognition. Under this approach, revenue is earned in proportion to total costs incurred, divided by total costs expected to be incurred.

    Other Direct Costs

        In the course of providing our services, we routinely subcontract for services and incur other direct costs on behalf of our clients. These costs are passed through to our clients and, in accordance with industry practice and GAAP, are included in our revenue and cost of revenue. Since subcontractor services and other direct costs can change significantly from project to project and period to period, changes in revenue may not accurately reflect business trends.

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Our discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations uses revenue, net of other direct costs as a point of reference. Revenue, net of other direct costs is a non-GAAP measure and may not be comparable to similarly titled items reported by other companies.

    Cost of Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs reflects the cost of our own personnel (including fringe benefits and overhead expense) associated with revenue, net of other direct costs.

39


Table of Contents

    Amortization Expense of Acquired Intangible Assets

        Included in our cost of revenue, net of other direct costs is amortization of acquired intangible assets. We have ascribed value to identifiable intangible assets other than goodwill in our purchase price allocations for companies we have acquired. These assets include, but are not limited, to backlog and customer relationships. To the extent we ascribe value to identifiable intangible assets that have finite lives, we amortize those values over the estimated useful lives of the assets. Such amortization expense, although non-cash in the period expensed, directly impacts our results of operations. It is difficult to predict with any precision the amount of expense we may record relating to acquired intangible assets.

    Equity in Earnings of Joint Ventures

        Equity in earnings of joint ventures includes our portion of fees charged by our unconsolidated joint ventures to clients for services performed by us and other joint venture partners along with earnings we receive from investments in unconsolidated joint ventures.

    General and Administrative Expenses

        General and administrative expenses include corporate overhead expenses, including personnel, occupancy, and administrative expenses.

    Acquisition and Integration Expenses

        Acquisition and integration expenses are comprised of transaction costs, professional fees, and personnel costs, including due diligence and integration activities, primarily related to the acquisition of URS Corporation.

    Goodwill Impairment

        See Critical Accounting Policies and Consolidated Results below.

    Income Tax Expense

        Income tax expense varies as a function of income before income tax expense and permanent non-tax deductible expenses. As a global enterprise, our effective tax rates can be affected by many factors, including changes in our worldwide mix of pre-tax earnings, the extent to which those earnings are indefinitely reinvested outside of the United States, our acquisition strategy, changes in judgment regarding the realizability of our deferred tax assets, and changes to existing tax legislation. Our tax returns are routinely audited and settlements of issues raised in these audits can also sometimes affect our tax provisions.

Critical Accounting Policies

        Our financial statements are presented in accordance with GAAP. Highlighted below are the accounting policies that management considers significant to understanding the operations of our business.

    Revenue Recognition

        We generally utilize a cost-to-cost approach in applying the percentage-of-completion method of revenue recognition, under which revenue is earned in proportion to total costs incurred, divided by total costs expected to be incurred. Recognition of revenue and profit under this method is dependent upon a number of factors, including the accuracy of a variety of estimates, including engineering progress, material quantities, the achievement of milestones, penalty provisions, labor productivity and cost estimates. Due to uncertainties inherent in the estimation process, it is possible that actual completion costs may vary from

40


Table of Contents

estimates. If estimated total costs on contracts indicate a loss, we recognize that estimated loss in the period the estimated loss first becomes known.

    Claims Recognition

        Claims are amounts in excess of the agreed contract price (or amounts not included in the original contract price) that we seek to collect from customers or others for delays, errors in specifications and designs, contract terminations, change orders in dispute or unapproved contracts as to both scope and price or other causes of unanticipated additional costs. We record contract revenue related to claims only if it is probable that the claim will result in additional contract revenue and if the amount can be reliably estimated. In such cases, we record revenue only to the extent that contract costs relating to the claim have been incurred. The amounts recorded, if material, are disclosed in the notes to the financial statements. Costs attributable to claims are treated as costs of contract performance as incurred.

    Government Contract Matters

        Our federal government and certain state and local agency contracts are subject to, among other regulations, regulations issued under the Federal Acquisition Regulations (FAR). These regulations can limit the recovery of certain specified indirect costs on contracts and subject us to ongoing multiple audits by government agencies such as the Defense Contract Audit Agency (DCAA). In addition, most of our federal and state and local contracts are subject to termination at the discretion of the client.

        Audits by the DCAA and other agencies consist of reviews of our overhead rates, operating systems and cost proposals to ensure that we account for such costs in accordance with the Cost Accounting Standards of the FAR (CAS). If the DCAA determines we have not accounted for such costs consistent with CAS, the DCAA may disallow these costs. There can be no assurance that audits by the DCAA or other governmental agencies will not result in material cost disallowances in the future.

    Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

        We record accounts receivable net of an allowance for doubtful accounts. This allowance for doubtful accounts is estimated based on management's evaluation of the contracts involved and the financial condition of its clients. The factors we consider in our contract evaluations include, but are not limited to:

    Client type—federal or state and local government or commercial client;

    Historical contract performance;

    Historical collection and delinquency trends;

    Client credit worthiness; and

    General economic conditions.

    Unbilled Accounts Receivable and Billings in Excess of Costs on Uncompleted Contracts

        Unbilled accounts receivable represents the contract revenue recognized but not yet billed pursuant to contract terms or accounts billed after the period end.

        Billings in excess of costs on uncompleted contracts represent the billings to date, as allowed under the terms of a contract, but not yet recognized as contract revenue using the percentage-of-completion accounting method.

    Investments in Unconsolidated Joint Ventures

        We have noncontrolling interests in joint ventures accounted for under the equity method. Fees received for and the associated costs of services performed by us and billed to joint ventures with respect to

41


Table of Contents

work done by us for third-party customers are recorded as our revenues and costs in the period in which such services are rendered. In certain joint ventures, a fee is added to the respective billings from both ourselves and the other joint venture partners on the amounts billed to the third-party customers. These fees result in earnings to the joint venture and are split with each of the joint venture partners and paid to the joint venture partners upon collection from the third-party customer. We record our allocated share of these fees as equity in earnings of joint ventures.

    Income Taxes

        We provide for income taxes in accordance with principles contained in ASC Topic 740, Income Taxes. Under these principles, we recognize the amount of income tax payable or refundable for the current year and deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in our financial statements or tax returns.

        Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which those temporary differences are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in earnings in the period when the new rate is enacted. Deferred tax assets are evaluated for future realization and reduced by a valuation allowance if it is more likely than not that a portion will not be realized.

        We measure and recognize the amount of tax benefit that should be recorded for financial statement purposes for uncertain tax positions taken or expected to be taken in a tax return. With respect to uncertain tax positions, we evaluate the recognized tax benefits for derecognition, classification, interest and penalties, interim period accounting and disclosure requirements. Judgment is required in assessing the future tax consequences of events that have been recognized in our financial statements or tax returns.

        Valuation Allowance.     Deferred income taxes are provided on the liability method whereby deferred tax assets and liabilities are established for the difference between the financial reporting and income tax basis of assets and liabilities, as well as operating loss and tax credit carry forwards. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax laws and rates on the date of enactment of such changes to laws and rates.

        Deferred tax assets are reduced by a valuation allowance when, in our opinion, it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets may not be realized. The evaluation of the recoverability of the deferred tax asset requires the Company to weigh all positive and negative evidence to reach a conclusion that it is more likely than not that all or some portion of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The weight given to the evidence is commensurate with the extent to which it can be objectively verified. Whether a deferred tax asset may be realized requires considerable judgment by us. In considering the need for a valuation allowance, we consider a number of factors including the nature, frequency, and severity of cumulative financial reporting losses in recent years, the future reversal of existing temporary differences, predictability of future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences of the character necessary to realize the asset, relevant carry forward periods, taxable income in carry-back years if carry-back is permitted under tax law, and prudent and feasible tax planning strategies that would be implemented, if necessary, to protect against the loss of the deferred tax asset. Whether a deferred tax asset will ultimately be realized is also dependent on varying factors, including, but not limited to, changes in tax laws and audits by tax jurisdictions in which we operate.

        If changes in judgment regarding the realizability of our deferred tax assets lead us to determine that it is more likely than not that we will not realize all or part of our deferred tax asset in the future, we will record an additional valuation allowance. Conversely, if a valuation allowance exists and we determine that the ultimate realizability of all or part of the net deferred tax asset is more likely than not to be realized, then the amount of the valuation allowance will be reduced. This adjustment will increase or decrease income tax expense in the period of such determination.

42


Table of Contents

        Undistributed Non-U.S. Earnings.     The results of our operations outside of the United States are consolidated for financial reporting; however, earnings from investments in non-U.S. operations are included in domestic U.S. taxable income only when actually or constructively received. No deferred taxes have been provided on the undistributed pre-tax earnings of non-U.S. operations of approximately $976.7 million because we have the ability to and intend to permanently reinvest these earnings overseas. If we were to repatriate these earnings, additional taxes would be due at that time.

        The Company continually explores initiatives to better align our tax and legal entity structure with the footprint of our non-U.S. operations and recognizes the tax impact of these initiatives, including changes in assessment of its uncertain tax positions, indefinite reinvestment exception assertions and realizability of deferred tax assets earliest in the period when management believes all necessary internal and external approvals associated with such initiatives have been obtained, or when the initiatives are materially complete. It is possible that the completion of one or more of these initiatives may occur within the next 12 months.

    Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets

        Goodwill represents the excess of amounts paid over the fair value of net assets acquired from an acquisition. In order to determine the amount of goodwill resulting from an acquisition, we perform an assessment to determine the value of the acquired company's tangible and identifiable intangible assets and liabilities. In our assessment, we determine whether identifiable intangible assets exist, which typically include backlog and customer relationships.

        We test goodwill for impairment annually for each reporting unit in the fourth quarter of the fiscal year, and between annual tests if events occur or circumstances change which suggest that goodwill should be evaluated. Such events or circumstances include significant changes in legal factors and business climate, recent losses at a reporting unit, and industry trends, among other factors. A reporting unit is defined as an operating segment or one level below an operating segment. Our impairment tests are performed at the operating segment level as they represent our reporting units.

        The impairment test is a two-step process. During the first step, we estimate the fair value of the reporting unit using income and market approaches, and compare that amount to the carrying value of that reporting unit. In the event the fair value of the reporting unit is determined to be less than the carrying value, a second step is required. The second step requires us to perform a hypothetical purchase allocation for that reporting unit and to compare the resulting current implied fair value of the goodwill to the current carrying value of the goodwill for that reporting unit. In the event that the current implied fair value of the goodwill is less than the carrying value, an impairment charge is recognized.

        During the fourth quarter, we conduct our annual goodwill impairment test. The impairment evaluation process includes, among other things, making assumptions about variables such as revenue growth rates, profitability, discount rates, and industry market multiples, which are subject to a high degree of judgment.

        As a result of the first step of the fiscal 2012 impairment analysis, we identified adverse market conditions and business trends within the Europe, Middle East, and Africa (EMEA) and MSS reporting units, which led us to determine that goodwill was impaired. The second step of the analysis was performed to measure the impairment as the excess of the goodwill carrying value over its implied fair value. This analysis resulted in an impairment of $336.0 million, or $317.2 million, net of tax.

        Material assumptions used in the impairment analysis included the weighted average cost of capital (WACC) percent and terminal growth rates. For example, a 1% increase in the WACC rate represents a $500 million decrease to the fair value of our reporting units. A 1% decrease in the terminal growth rate represents a $400 million decrease to the fair value of our reporting units.

43


Table of Contents

    Pension Plans

        A number of assumptions are necessary to determine our pension liabilities and net periodic costs. These liabilities and net periodic costs are sensitive to changes in those assumptions. The assumptions include discount rates, long- term rates of return on plan assets and inflation levels limited to the United Kingdom and are generally determined based on the current economic environment in each host country at the end of each respective annual reporting period. We evaluate the funded status of each of our retirement plans using these current assumptions and determine the appropriate funding level considering applicable regulatory requirements, tax deductibility, reporting considerations and other factors. Based upon current assumptions, we expect to contribute $17.0 million to our international plans in fiscal 2015. We do not have a required minimum contribution for our U.S. plans; however, we may make additional discretionary contributions. We currently expect to contribute $5.4 million to our U.S. plans in fiscal 2015. If the discount rate was reduced by 25 basis points, plan liabilities would increase by approximately $37.2 million. If the discount rate and return on plan assets were reduced by 25 basis points, plan expense would increase by approximately $0.5 million and $1.6 million, respectively. If inflation increased by 25 basis points, plan liabilities in the United Kingdom would increase by approximately $15.4 million and plan expense would increase by approximately $1.1 million.

        At each measurement date, all assumptions are reviewed and adjusted as appropriate. With respect to establishing the return on assets assumption, we consider the long term capital market expectations for each asset class held as an investment by the various pension plans. In addition to expected returns for each asset class, we take into account standard deviation of returns and correlation between asset classes. This is necessary in order to generate a distribution of possible returns which reflects diversification of assets. Based on this information, a distribution of possible returns is generated based on the plan's target asset allocation.

        Capital market expectations for determining the long term rate of return on assets are based on forward-looking assumptions which reflect a 20-year view of the capital markets. In establishing those capital market assumptions and expectations, we rely on the assistance of our actuary and our investment consultant. We and the plan trustees review whether changes to the various plans' target asset allocations are appropriate. A change in the plans' target asset allocations would likely result in a change in the expected return on asset assumptions. In assessing a plan's asset allocation strategy, we and the plan trustees consider factors such as the structure of the plan's liabilities, the plan's funded status, and the impact of the asset allocation to the volatility of the plan's funded status, so that the overall risk level resulting from our defined benefit plans is appropriate within our risk management strategy.

        Between September 30, 2013 and September 30, 2014, the aggregate worldwide pension deficit increased from $192.7 million to an estimated $221.3 million. The increase in the aggregate worldwide pension deficit is primarily driven by decreases in U.S. and international discount rates. Although funding rules are subject to local laws and regulations and vary by location, we expect to reduce this deficit over a period of 7 to 10 years. If the various plans do not experience future investment gains to reduce this shortfall, the deficit will be reduced by additional contributions.

    Accrued Professional Liability Costs

        We carry professional liability insurance policies or self-insure for our initial layer of professional liability claims under our professional liability insurance policies and for a deductible for each claim even after exceeding the self-insured retention. We accrue for our portion of the estimated ultimate liability for the estimated potential incurred losses. We establish our estimate of loss for each potential claim in consultation with legal counsel handling the specific matters and based on historic trends taking into account recent events. We also use an outside actuarial firm to assist us in estimating our future claims exposure. It is possible that our estimate of loss may be revised based on the actual or revised estimate of liability of the claims.

44


Table of Contents

    Foreign Currency Translation

        Our functional currency is the U.S. dollar. Results of operations for foreign entities are translated to U.S. dollars using the average exchange rates during the period. Assets and liabilities for foreign entities are translated using the exchange rates in effect as of the date of the balance sheet. Resulting translation adjustments are recorded as a foreign currency translation adjustment into other accumulated comprehensive income/(loss) in stockholders' equity.

        We limit exposure to foreign currency fluctuations in most of our contracts through provisions that require client payments in currencies corresponding to the currency in which costs are incurred. As a result of this natural hedge, we generally do not need to hedge foreign currency cash flows for contract work performed. However, we will use foreign exchange derivative financial instruments from time to time to mitigate foreign currency risk. The functional currency of all significant foreign operations is the respective local currency.


Fiscal year ended September 30, 2014 compared to the fiscal year ended September 30, 2013

    Consolidated Results

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
   
 
 
  Change  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  $   %  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenue

  $ 8,356.8   $ 8,153.5   $ 203.3     2.5 %

Other direct costs

    3,501.2     3,176.5     324.7     10.2  
                     

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,855.6     4,977.0     (121.4 )   (2.4 )

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,452.4     4,527.0     (74.6 )   (1.6 )
                     

Gross profit

    403.2     450.0     (46.8 )   (10.4 )

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    57.9     24.3     33.6     138.3  

General and administrative expenses

    (80.9 )   (97.3 )   16.4     (16.9 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

    (27.3 )       (27.3 )   *  
                     

Income from operations

    352.9     377.0     (24.1 )   (6.4 )

Other income

    2.7     3.5     (0.8 )   (22.9 )

Interest expense

    (40.8 )   (44.7 )   3.9     (8.7 )
                     

Income before income tax expense

    314.8     335.8     (21.0 )   (6.3 )

Income tax expense

    82.0     92.6     (10.6 )   (11.4 )
                     

Net income

    232.8     243.2     (10.4 )   (4.3 )

Noncontrolling interests in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (2.9 )   (4.0 )   1.1     (27.5 )
                     

Net income attributable to AECOM

  $ 229.9   $ 239.2   $ (9.3 )   (3.9 )%
                     
                     

*
Not meaningful

45


Table of Contents

        The following table presents the percentage relationship of certain items to revenue, net of other direct costs:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    100.0 %   100.0 %

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    91.7     91.0  
           

Gross margin

    8.3     9.0  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    1.2     0.5  

General and administrative expenses

    (1.6 )   (1.9 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

    (0.6 )    
           

Income from operations

    7.3     7.6  

Other income

    0.1     0.1  

Interest expense

    (0.9 )   (1.0 )
           

Income before income tax expense

    6.5     6.7  

Income tax expense

    1.7     1.8  
           

Net income

    4.8     4.9  

Noncontrolling interests in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (0.1 )   (0.1 )
           

Net income attributable to AECOM

    4.7 %   4.8 %
           
           

    Revenue

        Our revenue for the year ended September 30, 2014 increased $203.3 million, or 2.5%, to $8,356.8 million as compared to $8,153.5 million for the corresponding period last year. Revenue provided by acquired companies was $189.1 million for the year ended September 30, 2014. Excluding the revenue provided by acquired companies, revenue increased $14.2 million, or 0.2%, from the year ended September 30, 2013.

        The increase in revenue, excluding acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily attributable to an increase in the Europe, Middle East, and Africa region of $340 million, including $150 million provided by newly consolidated AECOM Arabia, an increase in Americas construction services of approximately $290 million and an increase in Asia of $60 million. These increases were partially offset by decreases in the Americas of approximately $310 million substantially from engineering and program management services, in Australia of approximately $150 million, and in our MSS segment of $164 million, as noted below coupled with a negative foreign exchange impact of $70 million.

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Our revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $121.4 million, or 2.4%, to $4,855.6 million as compared to $4,977.0 million for the corresponding period last year. Revenue, net of other direct costs, of $38.6 million was provided by acquired companies. Excluding revenue, net of other direct costs, provided by acquired companies, revenue, net of other direct costs, decreased $160.0 million, or 3.2%, over the year ended September 30, 2013.

        The decrease in revenue, net of other direct costs, excluding revenue, net of other direct costs provided by acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to decreases in our MSS segment of $168 million, as noted below, and in the Americas of approximately $120 million substantially from a decline in engineering and program management services, and in Australia of approximately $120 million, coupled with a negative foreign exchange impact of $50 million. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in the Europe, Middle East, and Africa region of $230 million, including revenue, net of other direct costs provided by newly consolidated AECOM Arabia of $90 million, an increase in Asia of $50 million and an increase in the Americas construction services of approximately $20 million.

46


Table of Contents

    Gross Profit

        Our gross profit for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $46.8 million, or 10.4%, to $403.2 million as compared to $450.0 million for the corresponding period last year. Gross profit provided by acquired companies was $2.7 million. Excluding gross profit provided by acquired companies, gross profit decreased $49.5 million, or 11.0%, from the year ended September 30, 2013. For the year ended September 30, 2014, gross profit, as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, decreased to 8.3% from 9.0% in the year ended September 30, 2013.

        The decreases in gross profit and gross profit as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2014 were primarily due to the reasons discussed within the reportable segments below.

    Equity in Earnings of Joint Ventures

        Our equity in earnings of joint ventures for the year ended September 30, 2014 was $57.9 million as compared to $24.3 million in the corresponding period last year.

        The increase in earnings of joint ventures for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to a $37.4 million gain on change in control of an unconsolidated joint venture that performs engineering and program management services in the Middle East and is included in our PTS segment. The gain relates to the excess of fair value over the carrying value of the previously held equity interest in the unconsolidated joint venture. See further discussion in Note 7 to the accompanying financial statements. The gain on change in control was partially offset by an impairment of an unrelated joint venture investment.

    General and Administrative Expenses

        Our general and administrative expenses for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $16.4 million, or 16.9%, to $80.9 million as compared to $97.3 million for the corresponding period last year. As a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, general and administrative expenses decreased to 1.6% for the year ended September 30, 2014 from 1.9% for the year ended September 30, 2013.

        The decrease in general and administrative expenses was primarily due to decreased personnel costs.

    Acquisition and Integration Expenses

        Our acquisition and integration expenses for the year ended September 30, 2014 were $27.3 million, which included $15.2 million of external transaction costs and professional fees, and $12.1 million of personnel costs associated with the acquisition and integration of URS.

    Other Income

        Our other income for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $0.8 million to $2.7 million as compared to $3.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2013.

    Interest Expense

        Our interest expense for the year ended September 30, 2014 was $40.8 million as compared to $44.7 million of interest expense for the year ended September 30, 2013.

    Income Tax Expense

        Our income tax expense for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $10.6 million, or 11.4%, to $82.0 million as compared to $92.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2013. The effective tax rate was 26.1% and 27.6% for the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

47


Table of Contents

        The decrease in income tax expense for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to lower overall pretax income, a change in the geographical mix of earnings, and an incremental tax benefit related to a US manufacturing deduction claimed on prior year U.S. corporate income tax returns.

    Net Income Attributable to AECOM

        The factors described above resulted in the net income attributable to AECOM of $229.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2014, as compared to the net income attributable to AECOM of $239.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2013.

Results of Operations by Reportable Segment

Professional Technical Services

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
   
 
 
  Change  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  $   %  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenue

  $ 7,609.9   $ 7,242.9   $ 367.0     5.1 %

Other direct costs

    3,147.2     2,826.5     320.7     11.3  
                     

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,462.7     4,416.4     46.3     1.0  

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,097.5     3,999.5     98.0     2.5  
                     

Gross profit

  $ 365.2   $ 416.9   $ (51.7 )   (12.4 )%
                     
                     

        The following table presents the percentage relationship of certain items to revenue, net of other direct costs:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    100.0 %   100.0 %

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    91.8     90.6  
           

Gross profit

    8.2 %   9.4 %
           
           

    Revenue

        Revenue for our PTS segment for the year ended September 30, 2014 increased $367.0 million, or 5.1%, to $7,609.9 million as compared to $7,242.9 million for the corresponding period last year. Revenue provided by acquired companies was $189.1 million. Excluding revenue provided by acquired companies, revenue increased $177.9 million, or 2.5%, over the year ended September 30, 2013.

        The increase in revenue, excluding acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily attributable to an increase in the Europe, Middle East, and Africa region of $340 million, including $150 million provided by newly consolidated AECOM Arabia, an increase in Americas construction services of approximately $290 million, and an increase in Asia of $60 million. These increases were partially offset by decreases in the Americas of approximately $310 million substantially from engineering and program management services, in Australia of approximately $150 million, coupled with a negative foreign exchange impact of $70 million.

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Revenue, net of other direct costs, for our PTS segment for the year ended September 30, 2014 increased $46.3 million, or 1.0%, to $4,462.7 million as compared to $4,416.4 million for the corresponding

48


Table of Contents

period last year. Revenue, net of other direct costs provided by acquired companies was $38.6 million. Excluding revenue, net of other direct costs, provided by acquired companies, revenue, net of other direct costs, increased $7.7 million, or 0.2%, over the year ended September 30, 2013.

        The increase in revenue, net of other direct costs, excluding revenue, net of other direct costs provided by acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to an increase in the Europe, Middle East, and Africa region of $230 million, including revenue, net of other direct costs provided by newly consolidated AECOM Arabia of $90 million, an increase in Asia of $50 million and an increase in the Americas construction services of approximately $20 million. These increases were partially offset by a decrease in the Americas of approximately $120 million substantially from a decline in engineering and program management services, and in Australia of approximately $120 million, coupled with a negative foreign exchange impact of $50 million.

    Gross Profit

        Gross profit for our PTS segment for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $51.7 million, or 12.4%, to $365.2 million as compared to $416.9 million for the corresponding period last year. Gross profit provided by acquired companies was $2.7 million. Excluding gross profit provided by acquired companies, gross profit decreased $54.4 million, or 13.0%, from the year ended September 30, 2013. As a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, gross profit decreased to 8.2% of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2014, from 9.4% in the corresponding period last year.

        The decrease in gross profit and gross profit as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily attributable to a decline in revenue in engineering and program management services in the Americas, as discussed above, partially offset by the collection of a previously reserved receivable.

Management Support Services

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
   
 
 
  Change  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  $   %  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenue

  $ 746.9   $ 910.6   $ (163.7 )   (18.0 )%

Other direct costs

    354.0     350.0     4.0     1.1  
                     

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    392.9     560.6     (167.7 )   (29.9 )

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    354.9     527.5     (172.6 )   (32.7 )
                     

Gross profit

  $ 38.0   $ 33.1   $ 4.9     14.8 %
                     
                     

        The following table presents the percentage relationship of certain items to revenue, net of other direct costs:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    100.0 %   100.0 %

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    90.3     94.1  
           

Gross profit (loss)

    9.7 %   5.9 %
           
           

    Revenue

        Revenue for our MSS segment for the year ended September 30, 2014, decreased $163.7 million, or 18.0%, to $746.9 million as compared to $910.6 million for the corresponding period last year.

        The decrease in revenue for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to decreased services provided to the U.S. government in the Middle East.

49


Table of Contents

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Revenue, net of other direct costs, for our MSS segment for the year ended September 30, 2014 decreased $167.7 million, or 29.9%, to $392.9 million as compared to $560.6 million for the corresponding period last year.

        The decrease in revenue, net of other direct costs for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to decreased services provided to the U.S. government in the Middle East.

    Gross Profit

        Gross profit for our MSS segment for the year ended September 30, 2014 was $38.0 million as compared to $33.1 million for the corresponding period last year. As a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, gross profit increased to 9.7% of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2014 from 5.9% in the corresponding period last year.

        The increase in gross profit and gross profit, as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2014 was primarily due to the collection of a previously reserved Libya-related project receivable, partially offset by decreased services provided to the U.S. government in the Middle East.


Fiscal year ended September 30, 2013 compared to the fiscal year ended September 30, 2012

    Consolidated Results

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
   
 
 
  Change  
 
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  $   %  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenue

  $ 8,153.5   $ 8,218.2   $ (64.7 )   (0.8 )%

Other direct costs

    3,176.5     3,034.3     142.2     4.7  
                     

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,977.0     5,183.9     (206.9 )   (4.0 )

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,527.0     4,762.0     (235.0 )   (4.9 )
                     

Gross profit

    450.0     421.9     28.1     6.7  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    24.3     48.6     (24.3 )   (50.0 )

General and administrative expenses

    (97.3 )   (80.9 )   (16.4 )   20.3  

Goodwill impairment

        (336.0 )   336.0     (100.0 )
                     

Income from operations

    377.0     53.6     323.4     *  

Other income

    3.5     10.6     (7.1 )   (67.0 )

Interest expense

    (44.7 )   (46.7 )   2.0     (4.3 )
                     

Income from continuing operations before income tax expense

    335.8     17.5     318.3     *  

Income tax expense

    92.6     74.4     18.2     24.5  
                     

Net income (loss)

    243.2     (56.9 )   300.1     *  

Noncontrolling interests in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (4.0 )   (1.7 )   (2.3 )   135.3  
                     

Net income (loss) attributable to AECOM

  $ 239.2   $ (58.6 ) $ 297.8     * %
                     
                     

*
Not meaningful

50


Table of Contents

        The following table presents the percentage relationship of certain items to revenue, net of other direct costs:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    100.0 %   100.0 %

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    91.0     91.9  
           

Gross margin

    9.0     8.1  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    0.5     0.9  

General and administrative expenses

    (1.9 )   (1.5 )

Goodwill impairment

        (6.5 )
           

Income from operations

    7.6     1.0  

Other income

    0.1     0.2  

Interest expense

    (1.0 )   (0.9 )
           

Income from continuing operations before income tax expense

    6.7     0.3  

Income tax expense

    1.8     1.4  
           

Net income (loss)

    4.9     (1.1 )

Noncontrolling interests in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (0.1 )   0.0  
           

Net income (loss) attributable to AECOM

    4.8 %   (1.1 )%
           
           

    Revenue

        Our revenue for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $64.7 million, or 0.8%, to $8,153.5 million as compared to $8,218.2 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. Revenue provided by acquired companies was $166.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2013. Excluding the revenue provided by acquired companies, revenue decreased $231.6 million, or 2.8%, from the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The decrease in revenue, excluding acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily attributable to a decrease in Australia of approximately $300 million substantially from decreased mining related services. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in Asia of approximately $60 million primarily from engineering and program management services on infrastructure projects.

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Our revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $206.9 million, or 4.0%, to $4,977.0 million as compared to $5,183.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. Revenue, net of other direct costs, of $128.3 million was provided by acquired companies. Excluding revenue, net of other direct costs, provided by acquired companies, revenue, net of other direct costs, decreased $335.2 million, or 6.5%, over the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The decrease in revenue, net of other direct costs, excluding revenue, net of other direct costs provided by acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily due to a decrease in Australia of approximately $190 million substantially from decreased mining related services and a reduction in engineering and program management services in the Americas of approximately $180 million, partially offset by an increase in Asia of approximately $70 million primarily from engineering and program management services on infrastructure projects.

51


Table of Contents

    Gross Profit

        Our gross profit for the year ended September 30, 2013 increased $28.1 million, or 6.7%, to $450.0 million as compared to $421.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. Gross profit provided by acquired companies was $10.5 million. Excluding gross profit provided by acquired companies, gross profit increased $17.6 million, or 4.2%, from the year ended September 30, 2012. For the year ended September 30, 2013, gross profit, as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, increased to 9.0% from 8.1% in the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The increases in gross profit and gross profit as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2013 were primarily due to improved project performance in our MSS reportable segment.

    Equity in Earnings of Joint Ventures

        Our equity in earnings of joint ventures for the year ended September 30, 2013 was $24.3 million compared to $48.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The decrease in equity in earnings of joint ventures for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily due to reduced earnings on MSS joint ventures that support the United States Army in the Middle East.

    General and Administrative Expenses

        Our general and administrative expenses for the year ended September 30, 2013 increased $16.4 million, or 20.3%, to $97.3 million as compared to $80.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. As a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, general and administrative expenses increased to 1.9% for the year ended September 30, 2013 from 1.5% for the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The increases in general administrative expenses were primarily due to increased performance-based compensation.

    Other Income

        Our other income for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $7.1 million to $3.5 million as compared to $10.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The decrease in other income for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily due to decreased earnings from investments.

    Interest Expense

        Our interest expense for the year ended September 30, 2013 was $44.7 million as compared to $46.7 million of interest expense for the year ended September 30, 2012.

    Income Tax Expense

        Our income tax expense for the year ended September 30, 2013 increased $18.2 million, or 24.5%, to $92.6 million as compared to $74.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. The effective tax rate was 27.6% and 425.7% for the years ended September 30, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        The increase in income tax expense for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily due to the change in tax jurisdictional mix of income, a higher pretax income than the prior year, and a current year restructuring transaction that resulted in U.S. income tax expense.

52


Table of Contents

    Net Income (Loss) Attributable to AECOM

        The factors described above resulted in the net income attributable to AECOM of $239.2 million for year ended September 30, 2013, as compared to the net loss attributable to AECOM of $58.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2012.

Results of Operations by Reportable Segment

Professional Technical Services

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
   
 
 
  Change  
 
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  $   %  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenue

  $ 7,242.9   $ 7,276.9   $ (34.0 )   (0.5 )%

Other direct costs

    2,826.5     2,669.6     156.9     5.9  
                     

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    4,416.4     4,607.3     (190.9 )   (4.1 )

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    3,999.5     4,183.5     (184.0 )   (4.4 )
                     

Gross profit

  $ 416.9   $ 423.8   $ (6.9 )   (1.6 )%
                     
                     

        The following table presents the percentage relationship of certain items to revenue, net of other direct costs:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    100.0 %   100.0 %

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    90.6     90.8  
           

Gross profit

    9.4 %   9.2 %
           
           

    Revenue

        Revenue for our PTS segment for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $34.0 million, or 0.5%, to $7,242.9 million as compared to $7,276.9 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. Revenue provided by acquired companies was $166.9 million. Excluding revenue provided by acquired companies, revenue decreased $200.9 million, or 2.8%, over the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The decrease in revenue, excluding acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily attributable to a decrease in Australia of approximately $300 million substantially from decreased mining related services. These decreases were partially offset by an increase in Asia of approximately $60 million primarily from engineering and program management services on infrastructure projects.

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Revenue, net of other direct costs, for our PTS segment for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $190.9 million, or 4.1%, to $4,416.4 million as compared to $4,607.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. Revenue, net of other direct costs provided by acquired companies was $128.3 million. Excluding revenue, net of other direct costs, provided by acquired companies, revenue, net of other direct costs, decreased $319.2 million, or 6.9%, over the year ended September 30, 2012.

53


Table of Contents

        The decrease in revenue, net of other direct costs, excluding revenue, net of other direct costs provided by acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily due to a decrease in Australia of approximately $190 million substantially from decreased mining related services, and a reduction in engineering and program management services in the Americas of approximately $180 million, partially offset by an increase in Asia of approximately $70 million primarily from engineering and program management services on infrastructure projects.

    Gross Profit

        Gross profit for our PTS segment for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $6.9 million, or 1.6%, to $416.9 million as compared to $423.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2012. Gross profit provided by acquired companies was $10.5 million. Excluding gross profit provided by acquired companies, gross profit decreased $17.4 million, or 4.1%, from the year ended September 30, 2012. As a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, gross profit increased to 9.4% of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2013, from 9.2% in the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The decrease in gross profit, excluding gross profit provided by acquired companies, for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily attributable to a decline in our Australian mining related services, which led us to incur severance costs of approximately $15 million.

Management Support Services

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
   
 
 
  Change  
 
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  $   %  
 
  ($ in millions)
 

Revenue

  $ 910.6   $ 941.3   $ (30.7 )   (3.3 )%

Other direct costs

    350.0     364.7     (14.7 )   (4.0 )
                     

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    560.6     576.6     (16.0 )   (2.8 )

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    527.5     578.5     (51.0 )   (8.8 )
                     

Gross profit (loss)

  $ 33.1   $ (1.9 ) $ 35.0     * %
                     
                     

*
Not meaningful

        The following table presents the percentage relationship of certain items to revenue, net of other direct costs:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 

Revenue, net of other direct costs

    100.0 %   100.0 %

Cost of revenue, net of other direct costs

    94.1     100.3  
           

Gross profit (loss)

    5.9 %   (0.3 )%
           
           

    Revenue

        Revenue for our MSS segment for the year ended September 30, 2013, decreased $30.7 million, or 3.3%, to $910.6 million as compared to $941.3 million for the year ended September 30, 2012.

54


Table of Contents

    Revenue, Net of Other Direct Costs

        Revenue, net of other direct costs, for our MSS segment for the year ended September 30, 2013 decreased $16.0 million, or 2.8%, to $560.6 million as compared to $576.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2012.

    Gross Profit (Loss)

        Gross profit (loss) for our MSS segment for the year ended September 30, 2013 was $33.1 million as compared to $(1.9) million for the year ended September 30, 2012. As a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, gross profit (loss) increased to 5.9% of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2013 from (0.3)% in the year ended September 30, 2012.

        The increase in gross profit (loss) and gross profit (loss), as a percentage of revenue, net of other direct costs, for the year ended September 30, 2013 was primarily due to improved project performance.

Seasonality

        We experience seasonal trends in our business. Our revenue is typically higher in the last half of the fiscal year. The fourth quarter of our fiscal year (July 1 to September 30) is typically our strongest quarter. We find that the U.S. Federal Government tends to authorize more work during the period preceding the end of our fiscal year, September 30. In addition, many U.S. state governments with fiscal years ending on June 30 tend to accelerate spending during their first quarter, when new funding becomes available. Further, our construction management revenue typically increases during the high construction season of the summer months. Within the United States, as well as other parts of the world, our business generally benefits from milder weather conditions in our fiscal fourth quarter, which allows for more productivity from our on-site civil services. Our construction and project management services also typically expand during the high construction season of the summer months. The first quarter of our fiscal year (October 1 to December 31) is typically our weakest quarter. The harsher weather conditions impact our ability to complete work in parts of North America and the holiday season schedule affects our productivity during this period. For these reasons, coupled with the number and significance of client contracts commenced and completed during a particular period, as well as the timing of expenses incurred for corporate initiatives, it is not unusual for us to experience seasonal changes or fluctuations in our quarterly operating results.

Liquidity and Capital Resources

    Cash Flows

        Our principal sources of liquidity are cash flows from operations, borrowings under our credit facilities, and access to financial markets. Our principal uses of cash are operating expenses, capital expenditures, working capital requirements, acquisitions, repurchases of stock under our stock repurchase program and repayment of debt. We believe our anticipated sources of liquidity including operating cash flows, existing cash and cash equivalents, borrowing capacity under our revolving credit facility, the financing entered into in connection with the acquisition of URS Corporation, and our ability to issue debt or equity, if required, will be sufficient to meet our projected cash requirements for at least the next 12 months.

        At September 30, 2014, cash and cash equivalents were $574.2 million, a decrease of $26.5 million, or 4.4%, from $600.7 million at September 30, 2013. The decrease in cash and cash equivalents was primarily attributable to net repayments of borrowings under credit agreements, cash payments for capital expenditures, business acquisitions, investments in joint ventures, and stock repurchases, partially offset by cash provided by operating activities.

55


Table of Contents

        Net cash provided by operating activities was $360.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2014, a decrease of $48.0 million, or 11.7%, from $408.6 million for the year ended September 30, 2013. The decrease was primarily attributable to the timing of receipts and payments of working capital, which includes accounts receivable, accounts payable, accrued expenses, and billings in excess of costs on uncompleted contracts. The sale of trade receivables to financial institutions during the year ended September 30, 2014 provided a net benefit of $10.8 million as compared to $64.9 million during the year ended September 30, 2013, giving effect to a decrease in cash provided by operating activities of $54.1 million. We expect to continue to sell trade receivables in the future as long as the terms continue to remain favorable to AECOM.

        Net cash used in investing activities was $142.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2014, compared with $139.5 million for the year ended September 30, 2013. This increase was primarily attributable to an increase in net investment in unconsolidated joint ventures, increased payments for business acquisitions, net of cash acquired, and an increase in cash payments for capital expenditures, partially offset by a benefit from the sale of investments and cash acquired from the consolidation of a joint venture.

        Net cash used in financing activities was $233.8 million for the year ended September 30, 2014, compared with $254.4 million for the year ended September 30, 2013. The decrease was primarily attributable to a decrease in payments to repurchase common stock of $353.2 million, partially offset by an increase in net repayments and borrowings under credit agreements of $312.2 million and an increase in distributions to noncontrolling interests.

    URS Acquisition

        We expect to incur approximately $250 million of amortization of intangible assets expense and $290 million of acquisition and integration expense in the next 12 months.

    Working Capital

        Working capital, or current assets less current liabilities, decreased $99.8 million, or 9.3%, to $978.3 million at September 30, 2014 from $1,078.1 million at September 30, 2013. Net accounts receivable, which includes billed and unbilled costs and fees, net of billings in excess of costs on uncompleted contracts, increased $255.6 million, or 12.7%, to $2,275.4 million at September 30, 2014.

        Accounts receivable increased 13.4%, or $312.7 million, to $2,655.0 million at September 30, 2014 from $2,342.3 million at September 30, 2013.

        Days Sales Outstanding (DSO), which includes accounts receivable, net of billings in excess of costs on uncompleted contracts, was 85 days at September 30, 2014 compared to 88 days at September 30, 2013.

        In Note 5, Accounts Receivable—Net, in the notes to our consolidated financial statements, a comparative analysis of the various components of accounts receivable is provided. Substantially all unbilled receivables are expected to be billed and collected within twelve months.

        Unbilled receivables related to claims are recorded only if it is probable that the claim will result in additional contract revenue and if the amount can be reliably estimated. In such cases, revenue is recorded only to the extent that contract costs relating to the claim have been incurred. Other than as disclosed, there were no significant net receivables related to contract claims as of September 30, 2014 and 2013. Award fees in unbilled receivables are accrued only when there is sufficient information to assess contract performance. On contracts that represent higher than normal risk or technical difficulty, award fees are generally deferred until an award fee letter is received.

        Because our revenue depends to a great extent on billable labor hours, most of our charges are invoiced following the end of the month in which the hours were worked, the majority usually within

56


Table of Contents

15 days. Other direct costs are normally billed along with labor hours. However, as opposed to salary costs, which are generally paid on either a bi-weekly or monthly basis, other direct costs are generally not paid until payment is received (in some cases in the form of advances) from the customers.

    Debt

        Debt consisted of the following:

 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Unsecured term credit agreement

  $ 712.5   $ 750.0  

Unsecured senior notes

    263.9     260.2  

Unsecured revolving credit facility

        114.7  

Other debt

    27.6     48.4  
           

Total debt

    1,004.0     1,173.3  

Less: Current portion of debt and short-term borrowings

    (64.4 )   (84.3 )
           

Long-term debt, less current portion

  $ 939.6   $ 1,089.0  
           
           

        The following table presents, in millions, scheduled maturities of our debt as of September 30, 2014:

Fiscal Year
   
 

2015

  $ 64.4  

2016

    38.0  

2017

    37.7  

2018

    600.0  

2019

     

Thereafter

    263.9  
       

Total

  $ 1,004.0  
       
       

    Unsecured Term Credit Agreement

        In June 2013, we entered into a Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (Term Credit Agreement) with Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent and a lender, and the other lenders party thereto. Pursuant to the Term Credit Agreement, we borrowed $750 million and may borrow up to an additional $100 million subject to certain conditions, including Company and lender approval. We used approximately $675 million of the proceeds from the loans to repay indebtedness under our prior term loan facility. The loans under the Term Credit Agreement bear interest, at our option, at either the Base Rate (as defined in the Term Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin or the Eurodollar Rate (as defined in the Term Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin. The applicable margin for the Base Rate loans is a range of 0.125% to 1.250% and the applicable margin for Eurodollar Rate loans is a range of 1.125% to 2.250%, both based on our debt-to-earnings leverage ratio at the end of each fiscal quarter. For the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013, the average interest rate of our term loan facility was 1.66% and 1.98%, respectively. Payments of the initial principal amount outstanding under the Term Credit Agreement are required on an annual basis and began on June 30, 2014 with the final principal balance of $600 million due on June 7, 2018. We may, at our option, prepay the loans at any time, without penalty. Our obligations under the Term Credit Agreement are guaranteed by certain of our subsidiaries pursuant to one or more subsidiary guarantees.

57


Table of Contents

    Unsecured Senior Notes

        In July 2010, we issued $300 million of notes to private institutional investors. The notes consisted of $175.0 million of 5.43% Senior Notes, Series A, due July 2020 and $125.0 million of 1.00% Senior Discount Notes, Series B, due July 2022 for net proceeds of $249.8 million. The outstanding accreted balance of Series B Notes, which have an effective interest rate of 5.62%, was $88.9 million and $85.2 million at September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The fair value of our unsecured senior notes was approximately $287.4 million and $269.4 million at September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. We calculated the fair values based on model-derived valuations using market observable inputs, which are Level 2 inputs under the accounting guidance. Our obligations under the notes are guaranteed by certain of our subsidiaries pursuant to one or more subsidiary guarantees. We have the option to prepay the notes at any time at their called principal amount, together with any accrued and unpaid interest, plus a make-whole premium.

    Unsecured Revolving Credit Facility

        In January 2014, we entered into a Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (Revolving Credit Agreement), which provides for a borrowing capacity of $1.05 billion. The Revolving Credit Agreement expires on January 29, 2019, and prior to this expiration date, principal amounts outstanding under the Revolving Credit Agreement may be repaid and reborrowed at our option without prepayment or penalty, subject to certain conditions including the absence of any event of default. We may request an increase in capacity of up to a total of $1.25 billion, subject to certain conditions including the absence of any event of default. The loans under the Revolving Credit Agreement may be borrowed in dollars or in certain foreign currencies and bear interest, at our option, at either the Base Rate (as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin or the Eurocurrency Rate (as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin. The applicable margin for the Base Rate loans is a range of 0.125% to 1.250% and the applicable margin for the Eurocurrency Rate loans is a range of 1.125% to 2.250%, both based on our debt-to-earnings leverage ratio at the end of each fiscal quarter. In addition to these borrowing rates, there is a commitment fee which ranges from 0.125% to 0.350% on any unused commitment. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, $0.0 million and $114.7 million, respectively, were outstanding under our revolving credit facility. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, outstanding standby letters of credit totaled $12.1 million and $35.5 million, respectively, under our revolving credit facility. As of September 30, 2014, we had $1,037.9 million available under our Revolving Credit Agreement.

    Covenants and Restrictions

        Under our debt agreements relating to our unsecured revolving credit facility, unsecured term credit agreement, and unsecured senior notes, we are subject to a maximum consolidated leverage ratio at the end of each fiscal quarter. This ratio is calculated by dividing consolidated funded debt (including financial letters of credit and other adjustments per our debt agreements) by consolidated earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, and amortization (EBITDA). Subject to certain differences among our debt agreements, EBITDA is defined as consolidated net income attributable to AECOM plus interest, depreciation and amortization expense, amounts set aside for taxes and other non-cash items (including a calculated annualized EBITDA from our acquisitions). As of September 30, 2014, our most restrictive consolidated leverage ratio under our debt agreements was 2.55, which did not exceed our maximum consolidated leverage ratio permitted under our debt agreements of 3.0.

        Our Revolving Credit Agreement and Term Credit Agreement also contain certain covenants that limit our ability to, among other things, (i) merge with other entities, (ii) enter into a transaction resulting in a change of control, (iii) create new liens, (iv) sell assets outside of the ordinary course of business, (v) enter into transactions with affiliates, (vi) substantially change the general nature of our Company and our subsidiaries taken as a whole, and (vii) incur indebtedness and contingent obligations.

58


Table of Contents

        Additionally, our unsecured senior notes contain covenants that limit (i) certain types of indebtedness, which include indebtedness incurred by subsidiaries and indebtedness secured by a lien, (ii) merging with other entities, (iii) entering into a transaction resulting in a change of control, (iv) creating new liens, (v) selling assets outside of the ordinary course of business, (vi) entering into transactions with affiliates, and (vii) substantially changing the general nature of our Company and our subsidiaries taken as a whole. The unsecured senior notes also contain a financial covenant that requires us to maintain a net worth above a calculated threshold. The threshold is calculated as $1.2 billion plus 40% of the consolidated net income for each fiscal quarter commencing with the fiscal quarter ending June 30, 2010. In the calculation of this threshold, we cannot include a consolidated net loss that may occur in any fiscal quarter. Our net worth for this financial covenant is defined as total AECOM stockholders' equity, which is consolidated stockholders' equity, including any redeemable common stock and stock units and the liquidation preference of any preferred stock. As of September 30, 2014, this amount was $2.2 billion, which exceeds the calculated threshold of $1.7 billion.

        Should we fail to comply with these covenants, all or a portion of our borrowings under the unsecured senior notes and unsecured term credit agreements could become immediately payable and our unsecured revolving credit facility could be terminated. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, we were in compliance with all such covenants.

        Our average effective interest rate on total borrowings, including the effects of the interest rate swap agreements, during the year ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was 2.8%, 3.0% and 3.1%, respectively.

    Other Debt

        Other debt consists primarily of bank overdrafts and obligations under capital leases and other unsecured credit facilities. In addition to the unsecured revolving credit facility discussed above, we also have other unsecured credit facilities primarily used for standby letters of credit issued for payment of performance guarantees. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, these outstanding standby letters of credit totaled $301.0 million and $236.4 million, respectively. As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, we had $327.4 million and $331.8 million, respectively, available under our unsecured credit facilities.

    Commitments and Contingencies

        Other than normal property and equipment additions and replacements, expenditures to further the implementation of our enterprise resource planning system, commitments under our incentive compensation programs, amounts we may expend to repurchase stock under our stock repurchase program and acquisitions from time to time, we currently do not have any significant capital expenditures or outlays planned except as described below. However, if we acquire additional businesses in the future or if we embark on other capital-intensive initiatives, additional working capital may be required.

        Under our unsecured revolving credit facility and other facilities discussed in Other Debt above, as of September 30, 2014, there was approximately $313.1 million outstanding under standby letters of credit issued primarily in connection with general and professional liability insurance programs and for contract performance guarantees. For those projects for which we have issued a performance guarantee, if the project subsequently fails to meet guaranteed performance standards, we may either incur significant additional costs or be held responsible for the costs incurred by the client to achieve the required performance standards. See Note 24 in the notes to our consolidated financial statements for information regarding the consideration paid and debt obligation incurred in connection with our acquisition of URS Corporation.

59


Table of Contents

        We recognized on our balance sheet the funded status (measured as the difference between the fair value of plan assets and the projected benefit obligation) of our pension plans. The total amounts of employer contributions paid for the year ended September 30, 2014 were $4.9 million for U.S. plans and $16.4 million for non-U.S. plans. Funding requirements for each plan are determined based on the local laws of the country where such plan resides. In certain countries, the funding requirements are mandatory while in other countries, they are discretionary. We do not have a required minimum contribution for our domestic plans; however, we may make additional discretionary contributions. In the future, such pension funding may increase or decrease depending on changes in the levels of interest rates, pension plan performance and other factors.

    Tishman Inquiry

        The U.S. Attorney's Office for the Eastern District of New York (USAO) has informed our subsidiary Tishman Construction Corporation (TCC) that, in connection with a wage and hour investigation of several New York area contractors, the USAO is investigating potential improper overtime payments to union workers on projects managed by TCC and other contractors in New York dating back to 1999. TCC, which was acquired by us in 2010, has cooperated fully with the investigation and, as of this date, no actions have been filed.

    AECOM Australia

        In 2005 and 2006, the Company's main Australian subsidiary, AECOM Australia Pty Ltd (AECOM Australia), performed a traffic forecast assignment for a client consortium as part of the client's project to design, build, finance and operate a tolled motorway tunnel in Australia. To fund the motorway's design and construction, the client formed certain special purpose vehicles (SPVs) that raised approximately $700 million Australian dollars through an initial public offering (IPO) of equity units in 2006 and approximately an additional $1.4 billion Australian dollars in long term bank loans. The SPVs went into insolvency administrations in February 2011.

        KordaMentha, the receivers for the SPVs (the RCM Applicants), caused a lawsuit to be filed against AECOM Australia by the RCM Applicants in the Federal Court of Australia on May 14, 2012. Portigon AG (formerly WestLB AG), one of the lending banks to the SPVs, filed a lawsuit in the Federal Court of Australia against AECOM Australia on May 18, 2012. Separately, a class action lawsuit, which has been amended to include approximately 770 of the IPO investors, was filed against AECOM Australia in the Federal Court of Australia on May 31, 2012.

        All of the lawsuits claim damages that purportedly resulted from AECOM Australia's role in connection with the above described traffic forecast. The RCM Applicants have claimed damages of approximately $1.68 billion Australian dollars (including interest, as of March 31, 2014). The damages claimed by Portigon as of June 17, 2014 were also recently quantified at approximately $76 million Australian dollars (including interest). We believe this claim is duplicative of damages already included in the RCM Applicants' claim to the extent Portigon receives a portion of the RCM Applicants' recovery. The class action applicants claim that they represent investors who acquired approximately $155 million Australian dollars of securities.

        AECOM Australia disputes the claimed entitlements to damages asserted by all applicants and is vigorously defending the claims brought against it. The likely resolution of these matters cannot be reasonably determined at this time. However, if these matters are not resolved in AECOM Australia's favor then, depending upon the outcome, such resolution could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations.

60


Table of Contents

Contractual Obligations and Commitments

        The following summarizes our contractual obligations and commercial commitments as of September 30, 2014:

Contractual Obligations and Commitments
  Total   Less than
One Year
  One to
Three Years
  Three to
Five Years
  More than
Five Years
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Debt

  $ 1,004.0   $ 64.4   $ 75.7   $ 600.0   $ 263.9  

Interest on debt

    141.3     26.6     51.6     37.6     25.5  

Operating leases

    886.0     181.4     281.2     188.7     234.7  

Other

    87.9     60.6     27.3          

Pension obligations

    418.0     38.7     76.5     81.2     221.6  
                       

Total contractual obligations and commitments

  $ 2,537.2   $ 371.7   $ 512.3   $ 907.5   $ 745.7  
                       
                       

New Accounting Pronouncements and Changes in Accounting

        In February 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued new accounting guidance to update the presentation of reclassifications from comprehensive income to net income in consolidated financial statements. Under this new guidance, an entity is required to present information about the amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income either by the respective line items of net income or by cross-reference to other required disclosures. The new guidance does not change the requirements for reporting net income or other comprehensive income in financial statements. This guidance was effective for our fiscal year beginning October 1, 2013 and did not have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

        In February 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance for the recognition, measurement, and disclosure of obligations resulting from joint and several liability arrangements for which the total amount of the obligation (within the scope of this guidance) is fixed at the reporting date. Examples of obligations within the scope of this guidance include debt arrangements, other contractual obligations, and settled litigation and judicial rulings. This new guidance was effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2013 and subsequent interim periods. This guidance is effective for our fiscal year beginning October 1, 2014 and it is not expected to have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

        In July 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance that requires the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits as a reduction of the deferred tax assets, when a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward exists at the reporting date. This new guidance was effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2013 and subsequent interim periods. This guidance is effective for our fiscal year beginning October 1, 2014 and it is not expected to have a material impact on our consolidated financial statements.

        In May 2014, the FASB issued new accounting guidance which amended the existing accounting standards for revenue recognition. The new accounting guidance establishes principles for recognizing revenue upon the transfer of promised goods or services to customers, in an amount that reflects the expected consideration received in exchange for those goods or services. This guidance is effective for our fiscal year beginning October 1, 2017. Early adoption is not permitted. The amendments may be applied retrospectively to each prior period presented or retrospectively with the cumulative effect recognized as of the date of initial application. We have not selected a transition method and are currently in the process of evaluating the impact of adoption of the new accounting guidance on our consolidated financial statements.

61


Table of Contents

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

        We enter into various joint venture arrangements to provide architectural, engineering, program management, construction management and operations and maintenance services. The ownership percentage of these joint ventures is typically representative of the work to be performed or the amount of risk assumed by each joint venture partner. Some of these joint ventures are considered variable interest entities. We have consolidated all joint ventures for which we have control. For all others, our portion of the earnings are recorded in equity in earnings of joint ventures. See Note 7 in the notes to our consolidated financial statements. We do not believe that we have any off-balance sheet arrangements that have or are reasonably likely to have a current or future effect on our financial condition, changes in financial condition, revenues or expenses, results of operations, liquidity, capital expenditures or capital resources that would be material to investors.

ITEM 7A.    QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

    Financial Market Risks

        We are exposed to market risk, primarily related to foreign currency exchange rates and interest rate exposure of our debt obligations that bear interest based on floating rates. We actively monitor these exposures. Our objective is to reduce, where we deem appropriate to do so, fluctuations in earnings and cash flows associated with changes in foreign exchange rates and interest rates. In order to accomplish this objective, we sometimes enter into derivative financial instruments, such as forward contracts and interest rate hedge contracts. It is our policy and practice to use derivative financial instruments only to the extent necessary to manage our exposures. We do not use derivative financial instruments for trading purposes.

    Foreign Exchange Rates

        We are exposed to foreign currency exchange rate risk resulting from our operations outside of the U.S. We use foreign currency forward contracts from time to time to mitigate foreign currency risk. We limit exposure to foreign currency fluctuations in most of our contracts through provisions that require client payments in currencies corresponding to the currency in which costs are incurred. As a result of this natural hedge, we generally do not need to hedge foreign currency cash flows for contract work performed. The functional currency of our significant foreign operations is the respective local currency.

    Interest Rates

        Our senior revolving credit facility and certain other debt obligations are subject to variable rate interest which could be adversely affected by an increase in interest rates. As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, we had $712.5 million and $864.7 million, respectively, in outstanding borrowings under our unsecured term credit agreements and our unsecured revolving credit facility. Interest on amounts borrowed under these agreements is subject to adjustment based on certain levels of financial performance. The applicable margin that is added to the borrowing's base rate can range from 0.0% to 2.5%. For the year ended September 30, 2014, our weighted average floating rate borrowings were $945.2 million, or $457.7 million excluding borrowings with effective fixed interest rates due to interest rate swap agreements. If short term floating interest rates had increased or decreased by 1%, our interest expense for the year ended September 30, 2014 would have increased or decreased by $4.6 million. We invest our cash in a variety of financial instruments, consisting principally of money market securities or other highly liquid, short-term securities that are subject to minimal credit and market risk.

62


Table of Contents

ITEM 8.    FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

AECOM Technology Corporation
Index to Consolidated Financial Statements
September 30, 2014

Audited Annual Financial Statements

     

Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

    64

Consolidated Balance Sheets at September 30, 2014 and 2013

    66

Consolidated Statements of Operations for the Years Ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012

    67

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the Years Ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012

    68

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity for the Years Ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012

    69

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012

    70

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements

    71

63


Table of Contents

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors and Stockholders of AECOM Technology Corporation

        We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of AECOM Technology Corporation (the "Company") as of September 30, 2014 and 2013, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), stockholders' equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2014. Our audits also included the financial statement schedule listed in the Index at Item 15(a). These financial statements and schedule are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and schedule based on our audits.

        We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the consolidated financial position of AECOM Technology Corporation at September 30, 2014 and 2013, and the consolidated results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2014, in conformity with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles. Also, in our opinion, the related financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole, present fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

        We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), AECOM Technology Corporation's internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (1992 framework) and our report dated November 17, 2014 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

Los Angeles, California
November 17, 2014

64


Table of Contents


Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

The Board of Directors and Stockholders of AECOM Technology Corporation

        We have audited AECOM Technology Corporation's (the "Company") internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2014, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (1992 framework) (the "COSO criteria"). AECOM Technology Corporation's management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting, and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in the accompanying Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting based on our audit.

        We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

        A company's internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company's internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

        Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

        In our opinion, AECOM Technology Corporation maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2014, based on the COSO criteria.

        We also have audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated balance sheets of AECOM Technology Corporation as of September 30, 2014 and 2013, and the related consolidated statements of operations, comprehensive income (loss), stockholders' equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2014 and our report dated November 17, 2014 expressed an unqualified opinion thereon.

/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

Los Angeles, California
November 17, 2014

65


Table of Contents


AECOM Technology Corporation

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(in thousands, except share data)

 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 

ASSETS

             

CURRENT ASSETS:

             

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 521,784   $ 450,328  

Cash in consolidated joint ventures

    52,404     150,349  
           

Total cash and cash equivalents

    574,188     600,677  

Accounts receivable—net

    2,654,976     2,342,262  

Prepaid expenses and other current assets

    177,536     168,714  

Income taxes receivable

    1,541      

Deferred tax assets—net

    25,872     19,949  
           

TOTAL CURRENT ASSETS

    3,434,113     3,131,602  

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT—NET

    281,979     270,672  

DEFERRED TAX ASSETS—NET

    118,038     143,478  

INVESTMENTS IN UNCONSOLIDATED JOINT VENTURES

    142,901     106,422  

GOODWILL

    1,937,338     1,811,754  

INTANGIBLE ASSETS—NET

    90,238     83,149  

OTHER NON-CURRENT ASSETS

    118,770     118,546  
           

TOTAL ASSETS

  $ 6,123,377   $ 5,665,623  
           
           

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

             

CURRENT LIABILITIES:

             

Short-term debt

  $ 23,915   $ 29,578  

Accounts payable

    1,047,155     725,389  

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

    964,627     915,282  

Income taxes payable

        6,127  

Billings in excess of costs on uncompleted contracts

    379,574     322,486  

Current portion of long-term debt

    40,498     54,687  
           

TOTAL CURRENT LIABILITIES

    2,455,769     2,053,549  

OTHER LONG-TERM LIABILITIES

    455,563     448,920  

LONG-TERM DEBT

    939,565     1,089,060  
           

TOTAL LIABILITIES

    3,850,897     3,591,529  

COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES (Note 20)

   
 
   
 
 

AECOM STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY:

   
 
   
 
 

Common stock—authorized, 300,000,000 shares of $0.01 par value as of September 30, 2014 and 2013; issued and outstanding 96,715,797 and 96,016,358 shares as of September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively

    967     960  

Additional paid-in capital

    1,864,971     1,809,627  

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

    (356,602 )   (261,299 )

Retained earnings

    677,181     472,155  
           

TOTAL AECOM STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

    2,186,517     2,021,443  

Noncontrolling interests

    85,963     52,651  
           

TOTAL STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

    2,272,480     2,074,094  
           

TOTAL LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY

  $ 6,123,377   $ 5,665,623  
           
           

   

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

66


Table of Contents


AECOM Technology Corporation

Consolidated Statements of Operations

(in thousands, except per share data)

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 

Revenue

  $ 8,356,783   $ 8,153,495   $ 8,218,180  

Cost of revenue

   
7,953,607
   
7,703,507
   
7,796,321
 
               

Gross profit

    403,176     449,988     421,859  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

   
57,924
   
24,319
   
48,650
 

General and administrative expenses

    (80,908 )   (97,318 )   (80,903 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

    (27,310 )        

Goodwill impairment

            (336,000 )
               

Income from operations

    352,882     376,989     53,606  

Other income

   
2,748
   
3,522
   
10,603
 

Interest expense

    (40,842 )   (44,737 )   (46,726 )
               

Income before income tax expense

    314,788     335,774     17,483  

Income tax expense

    82,024     92,578     74,416  
               

Net income (loss)

    232,764     243,196     (56,933 )

Noncontrolling interests in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (2,910 )   (3,953 )   (1,634 )
               

Net income (loss) attributable to AECOM

  $ 229,854   $ 239,243   $ (58,567 )
               
               

Net income (loss) attributable to AECOM per share:

                   

Basic

  $ 2.36   $ 2.38   $ (0.52 )

Diluted

  $ 2.33   $ 2.35   $ (0.52 )

Weighted average shares outstanding:

   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Basic

    97,226     100,618     111,875  

Diluted

    98,657     101,942     111,875  

   

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

67


Table of Contents


AECOM Technology Corporation

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income (Loss)

(in thousands)

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 

Net income (loss)

  $ 232,764   $ 243,196   $ (56,933 )

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Net unrealized gain (loss) on derivatives, net of tax

    315     1,568     (3,716 )

Foreign currency translation adjustments

    (72,715 )   (70,441 )   53,895  

Pension adjustments, net of tax

    (24,161 )   (14,582 )   (41,778 )
               

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

    (96,561 )   (83,455 )   8,401  
               

Comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

    136,203     159,741     (48,532 )

Noncontrolling interests in comprehensive income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (1,652 )   (2,624 )   (1,634 )
               

Comprehensive income (loss) attributable to AECOM, net of tax

  $ 134,551   $ 157,117   $ (50,166 )
               
               

   

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

68


Table of Contents


AECOM Technology Corporation

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity

(in thousands)

 
  Common
Stock
  Additional
Paid-In
Capital
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
  Retained
Earnings
  Total
AECOM
Stockholders'
Equity
  Non-
Controlling
Interests
  Total
Stockholder's
Equity
 

BALANCE AT SEPTEMBER 30, 2011

  $ 1,132   $ 1,699,207   $ (187,574 ) $ 826,946   $ 2,339,711   $ 55,426   $ 2,395,137  

Net loss

                      (58,567 )   (58,567 )   1,634     (56,933 )

Other comprehensive income

                8,401           8,401           8,401  

Issuance of stock

    9     18,622                 18,631           18,631  

Repurchases of stock

    (83 )   (7,081 )         (162,290 )   (169,454 )         (169,454 )

Proceeds from exercise of options

    4     4,537                 4,541           4,541  

Tax benefit from exercise of stock options

          (350 )               (350 )         (350 )

Stock based compensation

    8     26,543                 26,551           26,551  

Other transactions with noncontrolling interests

                                (753 )   (753 )

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

                                (1,283 )   (1,283 )
                               

BALANCE AT SEPTEMBER 30, 2012

    1,070     1,741,478     (179,173 )   606,089     2,169,464     55,024     2,224,488  

Net income

                      239,243     239,243     3,953     243,196  

Other comprehensive loss

                (82,126 )         (82,126 )   (1,329 )   (83,455 )

Issuance of stock

    11     28,340                 28,351           28,351  

Repurchases of stock

    (147 )   (8,380 )         (373,177 )   (381,704 )         (381,704 )

Proceeds from exercise of options

    8     14,357                 14,365           14,365  

Tax benefit from exercise of stock options

          1,239                 1,239           1,239  

Stock based compensation

    18     32,593                 32,611           32,611  

Other transactions with noncontrolling interests

                                13,488     13,488  

Contributions from noncontrolling interests

                                1,421     1,421  

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

                                (19,906 )   (19,906 )
                               

BALANCE AT SEPTEMBER 30, 2013

    960     1,809,627     (261,299 )   472,155     2,021,443     52,651     2,074,094  

Net income

                      229,854     229,854     2,910     232,764  

Other comprehensive loss

                (95,303 )         (95,303 )   (1,258 )   (96,561 )

Issuance of stock

    4     13,882                 13,886           13,886  

Repurchases of stock

    (14 )   (6,778 )         (24,828 )   (31,620 )         (31,620 )

Proceeds from exercise of options

    6     13,411                 13,417           13,417  

Tax benefit from exercise of stock options

          402                 402           402  

Stock based compensation

    11     34,427                 34,438           34,438  

Other transactions with noncontrolling interests

                                61,913     61,913  

Contributions from noncontrolling interests

                                     

Distributions to noncontrolling interests

                                (30,253 )   (30,253 )
                               

BALANCE AT SEPTEMBER 30, 2014

  $ 967   $ 1,864,971   $ (356,602 ) $ 677,181   $ 2,186,517   $ 85,963   $ 2,272,480  
                               
                               

   

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

69


Table of Contents


AECOM Technology Corporation

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(in thousands)

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES:

                   

Net income (loss)

  $ 232,764   $ 243,196   $ (56,933 )

Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by operating activities:

                   

Depreciation and amortization

    95,394     94,406     102,974  

Equity in earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures

    (57,924 )   (24,319 )   (48,650 )

Distribution of earnings from unconsolidated joint ventures

    23,839     31,159     26,401  

Non-cash stock compensation

    34,438     32,611     26,551  

Excess tax benefit from share-based payment

    (748 )   (1,754 )   (1,254 )

Foreign currency translation

    (20,794 )   (16,061 )   9,735  

Deferred income tax expense (benefit)

    27,155     (7,210 )   (20,303 )

Goodwill impairment

            336,000  

Other

    1,460     1,821     (5,286 )

Changes in operating assets and liabilities, net of effects of acquisitions:

                   

Accounts receivable

    (14,405 )   92,152     (21,544 )

Prepaid expenses and other assets

    (31,103 )   (21,836 )   11,363  

Accounts payable

    91,955     (47,019 )   80,999  

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

    3,283     71,125     14,682  

Billings in excess of costs on uncompleted contracts

    3,095     (12,945 )   (5,376 )

Other long-term liabilities

    (23,702 )   (19,027 )   (28,180 )

Income taxes payable

    (4,082 )   (7,701 )   12,173  
               

Net cash provided by operating activities

    360,625     408,598     433,352  
               

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES:

                   

Payments for business acquisitions, net of cash acquired

    (53,099 )   (42,005 )   (12,571 )

Cash acquired from consolidation of joint venture

    18,955          

Proceeds from disposal of businesses and property

    3,646     2,724     2,647  

Net investment in unconsolidated joint ventures

    (52,173 )   (23,822 )   (2,846 )

Sales (purchases) of investments

    2,727     (24,270 )   1,871  

Payments for capital expenditures

    (62,852 )   (52,117 )   (62,874 )
               

Net cash used in investing activities

    (142,796 )   (139,490 )   (73,773 )
               

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES:

                   

Proceeds from borrowings under credit agreements

    1,810,318     2,280,080     1,454,861  

Repayments of borrowings under credit agreements

    (1,998,882 )   (2,156,399 )   (1,550,996 )

Cash paid for debt and equity issuance costs

    (8,067 )   (1,616 )    

Proceeds from issuance of common stock

    13,886     14,029     13,760  

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

    13,417     14,365     4,541  

Payments to repurchase common stock

    (34,924 )   (388,101 )   (159,751 )

Excess tax benefit from share-based payment

    748     1,754     1,254  

Net distributions to noncontrolling interests

    (30,253 )   (18,485 )   (1,283 )
               

Net cash used in financing activities

    (233,757 )   (254,373 )   (237,614 )
               

EFFECT OF EXCHANGE RATE CHANGES ON CASH

    (10,561 )   (7,834 )   14,871  

NET (DECREASE) INCREASE IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

    (26,489 )   6,901     136,836  

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT BEGINNING OF YEAR

    600,677     593,776     456,940  
               

CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT END OF YEAR

  $ 574,188   $ 600,677   $ 593,776  
               
               

SUPPLEMENTAL CASH FLOW INFORMATION:

                   

Equity issued for acquisitions (non-cash)

  $   $ 14,322   $ 857  
               
               

Equity issued to settle liabilities (non-cash)

  $   $   $ 4,016  
               
               

Interest paid

  $ 43,362   $ 37,342   $ 39,044  
               
               

Income taxes paid, net of refunds received

  $ 68,797   $ 115,508   $ 38,482  
               
               

   

See accompanying Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

70


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. Significant Accounting Policies

        Organization —AECOM Technology Corporation and its consolidated subsidiaries (the Company) provide professional technical and management support services for commercial and government clients around the world. These services encompass a variety of technical disciplines, including consulting, planning, architectural and engineering design, and program and construction management for a broad range of projects. These services are applied to a number of areas and industries, including transportation infrastructure; research, testing and defense facilities; water, wastewater and other environmental programs; land development; security and communication systems; institutional, mining, industrial and commercial and energy-related facilities. The Company also provides operations and maintenance services to governmental agencies throughout the U.S. and abroad.

        Fiscal Year —The Company reports results of operations based on 52 or 53-week periods ending on the Friday nearest September 30. For clarity of presentation, all periods are presented as if the year ended on September 30. Fiscal years 2014, 2013 and 2012 contained 53, 52 and 52 weeks, respectively, and ended on October 3, September 27, and September 28, respectively.

        Use of Estimates —The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (GAAP) requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. The more significant estimates affecting amounts reported in the consolidated financial statements relate to revenues under long-term contracts and self-insurance accruals. Actual results could differ from those estimates.

        Principles of Consolidation and Presentation —The consolidated financial statements include the accounts of all majority-owned subsidiaries and material joint ventures in which the Company is the primary beneficiary. All inter-company accounts have been eliminated in consolidation. Also see Note 7 regarding joint ventures and variable interest entities.

        Revenue Recognition —The Company generally utilizes a cost-to-cost approach in applying the percentage-of-completion method of revenue recognition. Under this approach, revenue is earned in proportion to total costs incurred, divided by total costs expected to be incurred. Recognition of revenue and profit is dependent upon a number of factors, including the accuracy of a variety of estimates made at the balance sheet date, engineering progress, materials quantities, the achievement of milestones, penalty provisions, labor productivity and cost estimates made at the balance sheet date. Due to uncertainties inherent in the estimation process, actual completion costs may vary from estimates. If estimated total costs on contracts indicate a loss, the Company recognizes that estimated loss in the period the estimated loss first becomes known.

        In the course of providing its services, the Company routinely subcontracts for services and incurs other direct costs on behalf of its clients. These costs are passed through to clients and, in accordance with industry practice and GAAP, are included in the Company's revenue and cost of revenue. Because subcontractor services and other direct costs can change significantly from project to project and period to period, changes in revenue may not be indicative of business trends. These other direct costs for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $3.5 billion, $3.2 billion and $3.0 billion, respectively.

71


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

1. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

        Cost-Plus Contracts.     The Company enters into two major types of cost-plus contracts:

        Cost-Plus Fixed Fee.     Under cost-plus fixed fee contracts, the Company charges clients for its costs, including both direct and indirect costs, plus a fixed negotiated fee. The total estimated cost plus the fixed negotiated fee represents the total contract value. The Company recognizes revenue based on the actual labor and other direct costs incurred, plus the portion of the fixed fee it has earned to date.

        Cost-Plus Fixed Rate.     Under the Company's cost-plus fixed rate contracts, the Company charges clients for its direct and indirect costs based upon a negotiated rate. The Company recognizes revenue based on the actual total costs it has expended and the applicable fixed rate.

        Certain cost-plus contracts provide for award fees or a penalty based on performance criteria in lieu of a fixed fee or fixed rate. Other contracts include a base fee component plus a performance-based award fee. In addition, the Company may share award fees with subcontractors. The Company records accruals for fee-sharing as fees are earned. The Company generally recognizes revenue to the extent of costs actually incurred plus a proportionate amount of the fee expected to be earned. The Company takes the award fee or penalty on contracts into consideration when estimating revenue and profit rates, and it records revenue related to the award fees when there is sufficient information to assess anticipated contract performance. On contracts that represent higher than normal risk or technical difficulty, the Company may defer all award fees until an award fee letter is received. Once an award fee letter is received, the estimated or accrued fees are adjusted to the actual award amount.

        Certain cost-plus contracts provide for incentive fees based on performance against contractual milestones. The amount of the incentive fees varies, depending on whether the Company achieves above, at, or below target results. The Company originally recognizes revenue on these contracts based upon expected results. These estimates are revised when necessary based upon additional information that becomes available as the contract progresses.

    Time-and-Materials Contracts.

        Time-and-Materials.     Under time-and-materials contracts, the Company negotiates hourly billing rates and charges its clients based on the actual time that it expends on a project. In addition, clients reimburse the Company for its actual out-of-pocket costs of materials and other direct incidental expenditures that it incurs in connection with its performance under the contract. Profit margins on time-and-materials contracts fluctuate based on actual labor and overhead costs that it directly charges or allocates to contracts compared to negotiated billing rates. Many of the Company's time-and-materials contracts are subject to maximum contract values and, accordingly, revenue relating to these contracts is recognized as if these contracts were a fixed-price contract.

    Fixed-Price Contracts.

        Fixed-Price.     Fixed-price contracting is the predominant contracting method outside of the United States. There are typically two types of fixed-price contracts. The first and more common type, lump-sum, involves performing all of the work under the contract for a specified lump-sum fee. Lump-sum contracts are typically subject to price adjustments if the scope of the project changes or unforeseen conditions arise. The second type, fixed-unit price, involves performing an estimated number of units of work at an agreed price per unit, with the total payment under the contract determined by the actual number of units delivered. The Company recognizes revenue on fixed-price contracts using the percentage-of-completion

72


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

1. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

method described above. Prior to completion, recognized profit margins on any fixed-price contract depend on the accuracy of the Company's estimates and will increase to the extent that its actual costs are below the estimated amounts. Conversely, if the Company's costs exceed these estimates, its profit margins will decrease and the Company may realize a loss on a project. The Company recognizes anticipated losses on contracts in the period in which they become evident.

    Service-Related Contracts.

        Service-Related.     Service-related contracts, including operations and maintenance services and a variety of technical assistance services, are accounted for over the period of performance, in proportion to the costs of performance.

        Contract Claims —Claims are amounts in excess of the agreed contract price (or amounts not included in the original contract price) that the Company seeks to collect from customers or others for delays, errors in specifications and designs, contract terminations, change orders in dispute or unapproved as to both scope and price or other causes of unanticipated additional costs. The Company records contract revenue related to claims only if it is probable that the claim will result in additional contract revenue and if the amount can be reliably estimated. In such cases, the Company records revenue only to the extent that contract costs relating to the claim have been incurred. As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company had no significant net receivables related to contract claims.

        Government Contract Matters —The Company's federal government and certain state and local agency contracts are subject to, among other regulations, regulations issued under the Federal Acquisition Regulations (FAR). These regulations can limit the recovery of certain specified indirect costs on contracts and subjects the Company to ongoing multiple audits by government agencies such as the Defense Contract Audit Agency (DCAA). In addition, most of the Company's federal and state and local contracts are subject to termination at the discretion of the client.

        Audits by the DCAA and other agencies consist of reviews of the Company's overhead rates, operating systems and cost proposals to ensure that the Company accounted for such costs in accordance with the Cost Accounting Standards of the FAR (CAS). If the DCAA determines the Company has not accounted for such costs consistent with CAS, the DCAA may disallow these costs. There can be no assurance that audits by the DCAA or other governmental agencies will not result in material cost disallowances in the future.

        Cash and Cash Equivalents —The Company's cash equivalents include highly liquid investments which have an initial maturity of three months or less.

        Allowance for Doubtful Accounts —The Company records its accounts receivable net of an allowance for doubtful accounts. This allowance for doubtful accounts is estimated based on management's evaluation of the contracts involved and the financial condition of its clients. The factors the Company considers in its contract evaluations include, but are not limited to:

    Client type—federal or state and local government or commercial client;

    Historical contract performance;

    Historical collection and delinquency trends;

73


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

1. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

    Client credit worthiness; and

    General economic conditions.

        Derivative Financial Instruments —The Company accounts for its derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities and carries them at fair value.

        For derivative instruments that hedge the exposure to variability in expected future cash flows that are designated as cash flow hedges, the effective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative instrument is reported as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income in stockholders' equity and reclassified into income in the same period or periods during which the hedged transaction affects earnings. The ineffective portion of the gain or loss on the derivative instrument, if any, is recognized in current income. To receive hedge accounting treatment, cash flow hedges must be highly effective in offsetting changes to expected future cash flows on hedged transactions.

        The net gain or loss on the effective portion of a derivative instrument that is designated as an economic hedge of the foreign currency translation exposure generated by the re-measurement of certain assets and liabilities denominated in a non-functional currency in a foreign operation is reported in the same manner as a foreign currency translation adjustment. Accordingly, any gains or losses related to these derivative instruments are recognized in current income.

        Derivatives that do not qualify as hedges are adjusted to fair value through current income.

        Fair Value of Financial Instruments —The Company determines the fair values of its financial instruments, including short-term investments, debt instruments and derivative instruments, and pension and post-retirement plan assets based on inputs or assumptions that market participants would use in pricing an asset or a liability. The Company categorizes its instruments using a valuation hierarchy for disclosure of the inputs used to measure fair value. This hierarchy prioritizes the inputs into three broad levels as follows: Level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities; Level 2 inputs are quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets or inputs that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly through market corroboration, for substantially the full term of the financial instrument; Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs based on the Company's assumptions used to measure assets and liabilities at fair value. The classification of a financial asset or liability within the hierarchy is determined based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value measurement.

        The carrying amounts of cash and cash equivalents, accounts receivable and accounts payable approximate fair value because of the short maturities of these instruments. The carrying amount of the revolving credit facility approximates fair value because the interest rates are based upon variable reference rates. See also Notes 9 and 11.

        The Company's fair value measurement methods may produce a fair value calculation that may not be indicative of net realizable value or reflective of future fair values. Although the Company believes its valuation methods are appropriate and consistent with those used by other market participants, the use of different methodologies or assumptions to determine fair value could result in a different fair value measurement at the reporting date.

        Property and Equipment —Property and equipment are recorded at cost and are depreciated over their estimated useful lives using the straight-line method. Expenditures for maintenance and repairs are

74


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

1. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

expensed as incurred. Typically, estimated useful lives range from three to ten years for equipment, furniture and fixtures. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the shorter of their estimated useful lives or the remaining terms of the underlying lease agreement.

        Long-lived Assets —Long-lived assets to be held and used are reviewed for impairment whenever events or circumstances indicate that the assets may be impaired. For assets to be held and used, impairment losses are recognized based upon the excess of the asset's carrying amount over the fair value of the asset. For long-lived assets to be disposed, impairment losses are recognized at the lower of the carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell.

        Goodwill and Acquired Intangible Assets —Goodwill represents the excess of amounts paid over the fair value of net assets acquired from an acquisition. In order to determine the amount of goodwill resulting from an acquisition, the Company performs an assessment to determine the value of the acquired company's tangible and identifiable intangible assets and liabilities. In its assessment, the Company determines whether identifiable intangible assets exist, which typically include backlog and customer relationships. Intangible assets are amortized over the period in which the contractual or economic benefits of the intangible assets are expected to be realized.

        The Company tests goodwill for impairment annually for each reporting unit in the fourth quarter of the fiscal year, and between annual tests if events occur or circumstances change which suggest that goodwill should be evaluated. Such events or circumstances include significant changes in legal factors and business climate, recent losses at a reporting unit, and industry trends, among other factors. A reporting unit is defined as an operating segment or one level below an operating segment. The Company's impairment tests are performed at the operating segment level as they represent the Company's reporting units.

        The impairment test is a two-step process. During the first step, the Company estimates the fair value of the reporting unit using income and market approaches, and compares that amount to the carrying value of that reporting unit. In the event the fair value of the reporting unit is determined to be less than the carrying value, a second step is required. The second step requires the Company to perform a hypothetical purchase allocation for that reporting unit and to compare the resulting current implied fair value of the goodwill to the current carrying value of the goodwill for that reporting unit. In the event that the current implied fair value of the goodwill is less than the carrying value, an impairment charge is recognized. See also Note 4.

        Pension Plans —The Company has certain defined benefit pension plans. The Company calculates the market-related value of assets, which is used to determine the return-on-assets component of annual pension expense and the cumulative net unrecognized gain or loss subject to amortization. This calculation reflects the Company's anticipated long-term rate of return and amortization of the difference between the actual return (including capital, dividends, and interest) and the expected return over a five-year period. Cumulative net unrecognized gains or losses that exceed 10% of the greater of the projected benefit obligation or the market related value of plan assets are subject to amortization.

        Insurance Reserves —The Company maintains insurance for certain insurable business risks. Insurance coverage contains various retention and deductible amounts for which the Company accrues a liability based upon reported claims and an actuarially determined estimated liability for certain claims incurred but not reported. It is the Company's policy not to accrue for any potential legal expense to be incurred in

75


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

1. Significant Accounting Policies (Continued)

defending the Company's position. The Company believes that its accruals for estimated liabilities associated with professional and other liabilities are sufficient and any excess liability beyond the accrual is not expected to have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations or financial position.

        Foreign Currency Translation —The Company's functional currency is the U.S. dollar. Results of operations for foreign entities are translated to U.S. dollars using the average exchange rates during the period. Assets and liabilities for foreign entities are translated using the exchange rates in effect as of the date of the balance sheet. Resulting translation adjustments are recorded as a foreign currency translation adjustment into other accumulated comprehensive income/(loss) in stockholders' equity.

        The Company uses foreign currency forward contracts from time to time to mitigate foreign currency risk. The Company limits exposure to foreign currency fluctuations in most of its contracts through provisions that require client payments in currencies corresponding to the currency in which costs are incurred. As a result of this natural hedge, the Company generally does not need to hedge foreign currency cash flows for contract work performed. The functional currency of all significant foreign operations is the respective local currency.

        Noncontrolling Interests —Noncontrolling interests represent the equity investments of the minority owners in our joint ventures and other subsidiary entities that we consolidate in our financial statements.

        Income Taxes —The Company files a consolidated federal income tax return and combined / consolidated state tax returns and separate company state tax returns. The Company accounts for certain income and expense items differently for financial reporting and income tax purposes. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the difference between the financial statement and tax basis of assets and liabilities, applying enacted statutory tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. In determining the need for a valuation allowance, management reviews both positive and negative evidence, including the nature, frequency, and severity of cumulative financial reporting losses in recent years, the future reversal of existing temporary differences, predictability of future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences of the character necessary to realize the asset, relevant carry forward periods, taxable income in carry-back years if carry-back is permitted under tax law, and prudent and feasible tax planning strategies that would be implemented, if necessary, to protect against the loss of the deferred tax asset. Based upon management's assessment of all available evidence, the Company has concluded that it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance, will be realized.

        In July 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance that requires the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits as a reduction of the deferred tax assets, when a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward exists at the reporting date. This new guidance was effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2013 and subsequent interim periods. This guidance is effective for the Company's fiscal year beginning October 1, 2014 and it is not expected to have a material impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        Acquisition and Integration Expenses —Acquisition and integration expenses are comprised of transaction costs, professional fees, and personnel costs, including due diligence and integration activities, primarily related to the acquisition of URS Corporation (Note 24).

76


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

2. New Accounting Pronouncements and Changes in Accounting

        In February 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued new accounting guidance to update the presentation of reclassifications from comprehensive income to net income in consolidated financial statements. Under this new guidance, an entity is required to present information about the amounts reclassified out of accumulated other comprehensive income either by the respective line items of net income or by cross-reference to other required disclosures. The new guidance does not change the requirements for reporting net income or other comprehensive income in financial statements. This guidance was effective for the Company's fiscal year beginning October 1, 2013 and did not have a material impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        In February 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance for the recognition, measurement, and disclosure of obligations resulting from joint and several liability arrangements for which the total amount of the obligation (within the scope of this guidance) is fixed at the reporting date. Examples of obligations within the scope of this guidance include debt arrangements, other contractual obligations, and settled litigation and judicial rulings. This new guidance was effective for annual reporting periods beginning after December 15, 2013 and subsequent interim periods. This guidance is effective for the Company's fiscal year beginning October 1, 2014 and it is not expected to have a material impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        In July 2013, the FASB issued new accounting guidance that requires the presentation of unrecognized tax benefits as a reduction of the deferred tax assets, when a net operating loss carryforward, a similar tax loss, or a tax credit carryforward exists at the reporting date. This new guidance was effective for annual reporting periods beginning on or after December 15, 2013 and subsequent interim periods. This guidance is effective for the Company's fiscal year beginning October 1, 2014 and it is not expected to have a material impact on the Company's consolidated financial statements.

        In May 2014, the FASB issued new accounting guidance which amended the existing accounting standards for revenue recognition. The new accounting guidance establishes principles for recognizing revenue upon the transfer of promised goods or services to customers, in an amount that reflects the expected consideration received in exchange for those goods or services. This guidance is effective for the Company's fiscal year beginning October 1, 2017. Early adoption is not permitted. The amendments may be applied retrospectively to each prior period presented or retrospectively with the cumulative effect recognized as of the date of initial application. The Company has not selected a transition method and is currently in the process of evaluating the impact of adoption of the new accounting guidance on its consolidated financial statements.

3. Stock Repurchase Program

        The Company's Board of Directors has authorized the repurchase of up to $1.0 billion in Company stock. Share repurchases can be made through open market purchases or other methods, including pursuant to a Rule 10b5-1 plan. From the inception of the stock repurchase program, the Company has purchased a total of 27.4 million shares at an average price of $24.10 per share, for a total cost of $660.1 million as of September 30, 2014.

4. Business Acquisitions, Goodwill, and Intangible Assets

        The Company completed two, two and one business acquisitions during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Business acquisitions completed during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 did not meet the quantitative thresholds to require pro forma

77


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

4. Business Acquisitions, Goodwill, and Intangible Assets (Continued)

disclosures of operating results, either individually or in the aggregate, based on the Company's consolidated assets, investments and net income. The Company also obtained control of an unconsolidated joint venture that resulted in its consolidation during the year ended September 30, 2014, as further discussed in Note 7.

        Business acquisitions during the year ended September 30, 2014 included Hunt Construction Group, a United States-based commercial construction management firm which serves clients in both the public and private sectors, and Spain-based ACE International Consultants S.L., a leading consulting firm specializing in economic and social development cooperation and private sector development.

        Business acquisitions during the year ended September 30, 2013 included South Africa-based BKS Group and Asia-based KPK Quantity Surveyors.

        During the year ended September 30, 2012, the Company acquired an environmental engineering firm in Asia.

        The aggregate value of all consideration for acquisitions consummated during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $88.5 million, $82.0 million and $15.4 million, respectively. The following table summarizes the estimated fair values of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, as of the acquisition dates, from acquisitions consummated during the fiscal years presented:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Cash acquired

  $ 17.1   $ 20.1   $ 1.9  

Other current assets

    256.2     41.5     7.8  

Goodwill

    72.7     72.6     10.5  

Intangible assets

    11.9     9.4     1.5  

Other non-current assets

    16.5     8.6     3.3  

Current liabilities

    (274.1 )   (54.9 )   (8.8 )

Non-current liabilities

    (11.8 )   (15.3 )   (0.8 )
               

Net assets acquired

  $ 88.5   $ 82.0   $ 15.4  
               
               

        Acquired intangible assets above includes the following:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Backlog

  $ 5.8   $ 4.2   $ 0.7  

Customer relationships

    4.6     5.2     0.8  

Trademark / tradename

    1.5          
               

Total intangible assets

  $ 11.9   $ 9.4   $ 1.5  
               
               

78


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

4. Business Acquisitions, Goodwill, and Intangible Assets (Continued)

        Consideration for acquisitions above includes the following:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Cash paid

  $ 70.2   $ 62.1   $ 14.5  

Promissory notes

    18.3     5.6      

Equity issued

        14.3     0.9  
               

Total consideration

  $ 88.5   $ 82.0   $ 15.4  
               
               

        All of the above acquisitions were accounted for under the purchase method of accounting. As such, the purchase consideration of each acquired company was allocated to acquired tangible and intangible assets and liabilities based upon their fair values. The final purchase price allocation has not been completed for acquisitions made during the year ended September 30, 2014. The excess of the purchase consideration over the fair value of the net tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired was recorded as goodwill. The determination of fair values of assets and liabilities acquired requires the Company to make estimates and use valuation techniques when market value is not readily available. The results of operations of each company acquired have been included in the Company's financial statements from the date of acquisition. Transaction costs associated with business acquisitions are expensed as they are incurred.

        At the time of acquisition, the Company preliminarily estimates the amount of the identifiable intangible assets acquired based upon historical valuations of similar acquisitions and the facts and circumstances available at the time. The Company determines the final value of the identifiable intangible assets as soon as information is available, but not more than 12 months from the date of acquisition. Post-acquisition adjustments primarily relate to project related liabilities.

        During the fourth quarter of its fiscal year, the Company conducts its annual goodwill impairment test. The impairment evaluation process includes, among other things, making assumptions about variables such as revenue growth rates, profitability, discount rates, and industry market multiples, which are subject to a high degree of judgment.

        As a result of the first step of the fiscal 2012 impairment analysis, the Company identified adverse market conditions and business trends within the Europe, Middle East, and Africa (EMEA) and MSS reporting units, which led the Company to determine that goodwill was impaired. Adverse market conditions included prolonged and sustained deterioration of European macroeconomic conditions in EMEA and decreased U.S. government military activities and unsuccessful contract pursuits in MSS. The reporting units' goodwill impairments largely relate to the following acquired businesses:

    MSS—McNeil Technologies, Inc.

    EMEA—Davis Langdon Europe and Middle East

        Significant changes to the assumptions used in the September 30, 2012 as compared to the September 30, 2011 analysis were financial forecasts and market multiples. While both the MSS and the EMEA reporting units have historically generated positive cash flows, and are expected to continue to generate positive cash flows, the fair value of future cash flows of the Company's EMEA and MSS

79


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

4. Business Acquisitions, Goodwill, and Intangible Assets (Continued)

reporting units decreased. Additionally, the market multiples for the two reporting units decreased. The market multiples used were as follows:

 
  September 30,  
 
  2012   2011  

Market multiple of revenue:

             

EMEA

    0.35     0.5  

MSS

    0.35     0.5  

        The second step of the analysis was performed to measure the impairment as the excess of the goodwill carrying value over its implied fair value. This analysis resulted in an impairment of $336.0 million, or $317.2 million, net of tax. The goodwill carrying values of the EMEA and MSS reporting units before and after the goodwill impairment expense were as follows:

 
  September 30, 2012  
 
  EMEA   MSS  

Carrying value before impairment

  $ 345.5   $ 347.8  

Goodwill impairment

    (155.0 )   (181.0 )
           

Carrying value after impairment

  $ 190.5   $ 166.8  
           
           

        The changes in the carrying value of goodwill by reportable segment for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013 were as follows:

 
  Fiscal Year 2014  
 
  September 30,
2013
  Post-
Acquisition
Adjustments
  Foreign
Exchange
Impact
  Acquired   September 30,
2014
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Professional Technical Services

  $ 1,645.0   $ 5.0   $ (31.3 ) $ 151.8   $ 1,770.5  

Management Support Services

    166.8                 166.8  
                       

Total

  $ 1,811.8   $ 5.0   $ (31.3 ) $ 151.8   $ 1,937.3  
                       
                       

 

 
  Fiscal Year 2013  
 
  September 30,
2012
  Post-
Acquisition
Adjustments
  Foreign
Exchange
Impact
  Acquired   September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Professional Technical Services

  $ 1,608.6   $   $ (36.2 ) $ 72.6   $ 1,645.0  

Management Support Services

    166.8                 166.8  
                       

Total

  $ 1,775.4   $   $ (36.2 ) $ 72.6   $ 1,811.8  
                       
                       

        Included in the acquired goodwill above for the year ended September 30, 2014 is $79.1 million of recorded goodwill as a result of the consolidation of an unconsolidated joint venture, as further discussed in Note 7.

80


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

4. Business Acquisitions, Goodwill, and Intangible Assets (Continued)

        The gross amounts and accumulated amortization of the Company's acquired identifiable intangible assets with finite useful lives as of September 30, 2014 and 2013, included in intangible assets—net, in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets, were as follows:

 
  September 30, 2014   September 30, 2013    
 
  Gross
Amount
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Intangible
Assets, Net
  Gross
Amount
  Accumulated
Amortization
  Intangible
Assets, Net
  Amortization
Period
(years)
 
  (in millions)

Backlog

  $ 110.0   $ (97.4 )   12.6   $ 94.9   $ (89.4 ) $ 5.5   1 - 5

Customer relationships

    161.6     (85.4 )   76.2     147.1     (69.5 )   77.6   10

Trademark / tradename

    9.3     (7.9 )   1.4     7.8     (7.8 )     2
                             

Total

  $ 280.9   $ (190.7 ) $ 90.2   $ 249.8   $ (166.7 ) $ 83.1    
                             
                             

        Amortization expense of acquired intangible assets included within cost of revenue was $24.0 million and $21.2 million for the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The following table presents estimated amortization expense of existing intangible assets for the succeeding years:

Fiscal Year
  (in millions)  

2015

  $ 26.5  

2016

    17.5  

2017

    13.2  

2018

    9.9  

2019

    9.0  

Thereafter

    14.1  
       

Total

  $ 90.2  
       
       

5. Accounts Receivable—Net

        Net accounts receivable consisted of the following:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Billed

  $ 1,248.4   $ 1,177.6  

Unbilled

    1,214.8     1,076.8  

Contract retentions

    263.9     174.3  
           

Total accounts receivable—gross

    2,727.1     2,428.7  

Allowance for doubtful accounts

    (72.1 )   (86.4 )
           

Total accounts receivable—net

  $ 2,655.0   $ 2,342.3  
           
           

        Billed accounts receivable represent amounts billed to clients that have yet to be collected. Unbilled accounts receivable represents the contract revenue recognized but not yet billed pursuant to contract terms or accounts billed after the period end. Substantially all unbilled receivables as of September 30,

81


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

5. Accounts Receivable—Net (Continued)

2014 and 2013 are expected to be billed and collected within twelve months. Contract retentions represent amounts invoiced to clients where payments have been withheld pending the completion of certain milestones, other contractual conditions or upon the completion of the project. These retention agreements vary from project to project and could be outstanding for several months or years.

        Allowances for doubtful accounts have been determined through specific identification of amounts considered to be uncollectible and potential write-offs, plus a non-specific allowance for other amounts for which some potential loss has been determined to be probable based on current and past experience.

        Other than the U.S. government, no single client accounted for more than 10% of the Company's outstanding receivables at September 30, 2014 and 2013.

        The Company sold trade receivables to financial institutions, of which $111.9 million and $100.2 million were outstanding as of September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Company does not retain financial or legal obligations for these receivables that would result in material losses. The Company's ongoing involvement is limited to the remittance of customer payments to the financial institutions with respect to the sold trade receivables.

6. Property and Equipment

        Property and equipment, at cost, consists of the following:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended    
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  Useful Lives
(years)
 
  (in millions)
   

Building and land

  $ 11.5   $ 4.4   27

Leasehold improvements

    299.7     289.9   2 - 12

Computer systems and equipment

    302.6     257.0   3 - 10

Furniture and fixtures

    101.5     106.4   5 - 10

Automobiles

    6.8     5.4   3 - 10
             

Total

    722.1     663.1    

Accumulated depreciation and amortization

    (440.1 )   (392.4 )  
             

Property and equipment, net

  $ 282.0   $ 270.7    
             
             

        Depreciation expense for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $69.1 million, $70.7 million and $77.1 million, respectively. Included in depreciation expense is amortization of capitalized software costs in the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 of $7.3 million, $6.4 million and $6.2 million, respectively. Unamortized capitalized software costs at September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 were $39.9 million, $29.6 million and $24.1 million, respectively.

        Depreciation is calculated using primarily the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the assets, or in the case of leasehold improvements and capitalized leases, the lesser of the remaining term of the lease or its estimated useful life.

82


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

7. Joint Ventures and Variable Interest Entities

        The Company's joint ventures provide architecture, engineering, program management, construction management and operations and maintenance services. Joint ventures, the combination of two or more partners, are generally formed for a specific project. Management of the joint venture is typically controlled by a joint venture executive committee, comprised of representatives from the joint venture partners. The joint venture executive committee normally provides management oversight and controls decisions which could have a significant impact on the joint venture.

        Some of the Company's joint ventures have no employees and minimal operating expenses. For these joint ventures, the Company's employees perform work for the joint venture, which is then billed to a third-party customer by the joint venture. These joint ventures function as pass through entities to bill the third-party customer. For consolidated joint ventures of this type, the Company records the entire amount of the services performed and the costs associated with these services, including the services provided by the other joint venture partners, in the Company's result of operations. For certain of these joint ventures where a fee is added by an unconsolidated joint venture to client billings, the Company's portion of that fee is recorded in equity in earnings of joint ventures.

        The Company also has joint ventures that have their own employees and operating expenses, and to which the Company generally makes a capital contribution. The Company accounts for these joint ventures either as consolidated entities or equity method investments based on the criteria further discussed below.

        The Company follows guidance issued by the FASB on the consolidation of variable interest entities (VIEs) that requires companies to utilize a qualitative approach to determine whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE. The process for identifying the primary beneficiary of a VIE requires consideration of the factors that indicate a party has the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the joint ventures' economic performance, including powers granted to the joint venture's program manager, powers contained in the joint venture governing board and, to a certain extent, a company's economic interest in the joint venture. The Company analyzes its joint ventures and classifies them as either:

    a VIE that must be consolidated because the Company is the primary beneficiary or the joint venture is not a VIE and the Company holds the majority voting interest with no significant participative rights available to the other partners; or

    a VIE that does not require consolidation and is treated as an equity method investment because the Company is not the primary beneficiary or the joint venture is not a VIE and the Company does not hold the majority voting interest.

        As part of the above analysis, if it is determined that the Company has the power to direct the activities that most significantly impact the joint venture's economic performance, the Company considers whether or not it has the obligation to absorb losses or rights to receive benefits of the VIE that could potentially be significant to the VIE.

        Contractually required support provided to the Company's joint ventures is discussed in Note 20.

83


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

7. Joint Ventures and Variable Interest Entities (Continued)

        Summary of unaudited financial information of the consolidated joint ventures is as follows:

 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Current assets

  $ 314.1   $ 185.7  

Non-current assets

    106.2      
           

Total assets

  $ 420.3   $ 185.7  
           
           

Current liabilities

  $ 229.1   $ 38.9  

Non-current liabilities

         
           

Total liabilities

    229.1     38.9  

Total AECOM equity

   
116.6
   
106.8
 

Noncontrolling interests

    74.6     40.0  
           

Total owners' equity

    191.2     146.8  
           

Total liabilities and owners' equity

  $ 420.3   $ 185.7  
           
           

        Total revenue of the consolidated joint ventures was $614.5 million, $490.9 million and $468.6 million for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The assets of the Company's consolidated joint ventures are restricted for use only by the particular joint venture and are not available for the general operations of the Company.

        Summary of unaudited financial information of the unconsolidated joint ventures is as follows:

 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Current assets

  $ 539.6   $ 525.5  

Non-current assets

    273.7     98.7  
           

Total assets

  $ 813.3   $ 624.2  
           
           

Current liabilities

  $ 397.9   $ 384.1  

Non-current liabilities

    91.0     17.5  
           

Total liabilities

    488.9     401.6  

Joint venturers' equity

   
324.4
   
222.6
 
           

Total liabilities and joint venturers' equity

  $ 813.3   $ 624.2  
           
           

AECOM's investment in joint ventures

  $ 142.9   $ 106.4  

        Total revenue of the unconsolidated joint ventures was $2.0 billion, $2.1 billion and $2.0 billion for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Total operating income of the unconsolidated joint ventures were $57.7 million, $70.1 million and $127.5 million for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

84


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

7. Joint Ventures and Variable Interest Entities (Continued)

        Summary of AECOM's equity in earnings of unconsolidated joint ventures is as follows:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Pass through joint ventures

  $ 10.2   $ 6.4   $ 5.2  

Other joint ventures

    47.7     17.9     43.4  
               

Total

  $ 57.9   $ 24.3   $ 48.6  
               
               

        Included in equity in earnings above is a $37.4 million gain recognized upon change in control ($23.4 million, net of tax) of an unconsolidated joint venture in the year ended September 30, 2014. The Company obtained control of the joint venture through modifications to the joint venture's operating agreement, which required the Company to consolidate the joint venture. The acquisition date fair value of the previously held equity interest was $58.0 million, excluding the control premium. The measurement of the fair value of the equity interest immediately before obtaining control of the joint venture resulted in the pre-tax gain of $37.4 million. The Company utilized income and market approaches, in addition to obtaining an independent third party valuation, in determining the joint venture's fair value, which includes making assumptions about variables such as revenue growth rates, profitability, discount rates, and industry market multiples. These assumptions are subject to a high degree of judgment. Total assets and liabilities of this entity included in the accompanying consolidated balance sheet at the acquisition date were $207.8 million and $48.1 million, respectively. This acquisition did not meet the quantitative thresholds to require pro forma disclosures of operating results based on the Company's consolidated assets, investments and net income. This joint venture performs engineering and program management services in the Middle East and is included in the Company's PTS segment.

8. Pension Plans

        In the U.S., the Company sponsors a Defined Benefit Pension Plan (the Pension Plan) which covers substantially all permanent employees hired as of March 1, 1998, subject to eligibility and vesting requirements, and required contributions from participating employees through March 31, 1998. Benefits under this plan generally are based on the employee's years of creditable service and compensation. Effective April 1, 2004, the Company set a maximum on the amount of compensation used to determine pension benefits based on the highest calendar year of compensation earned in the 10 completed calendar years from 1994 through 2003, or the relevant IRS annual compensation limit, whichever is lower. Outside the U.S., the Company sponsors various pension plans, which are appropriate to the country in which the Company operates, some of which are government mandated.

85


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Pension Plans (Continued)

        The following tables provide reconciliations of the changes in the U.S. and international plans' benefit obligations, reconciliations of the changes in the fair value of assets for the last three years ended September 30, and reconciliations of the funded status as of September 30 of each year.

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Change in benefit obligation:

                                     

Benefit obligation at beginning of year

  $ 180.3   $ 622.1   $ 192.9   $ 574.0   $ 171.0   $ 504.3  

Service cost

        0.7         0.9         1.1  

Participant contributions

    0.4     0.2     0.4     0.3     0.6     0.3  

Interest cost

    7.8     27.9     6.6     23.8     7.7     25.6  

Benefits paid

    (12.8 )   (23.3 )   (11.0 )   (18.8 )   (10.0 )   (25.7 )

Actuarial (gain) loss

    23.2     62.3     (8.6 )   49.0     23.6     50.3  

Plan settlements

        (2.0 )       (5.7 )       (2.4 )

Net transfer in/(out)/acquisitions

    18.1                      

Foreign currency translation (gain) loss

        (11.3 )       (1.4 )       20.5  
                           

Benefit obligation at end of year

  $ 217.0   $ 676.6   $ 180.3   $ 622.1   $ 192.9   $ 574.0  
                           
                           

 

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Change in plan assets

                                     

Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year

  $ 119.8   $ 489.9   $ 112.3   $ 462.4   $ 91.5   $ 417.3  

Actual return on plan assets

    14.2     60.4     11.3     37.4     17.0     39.0  

Employer contributions

    4.9     16.4     6.8     16.2     13.2     17.2  

Participant contributions

    0.4     0.2     0.4     0.3     0.6     0.3  

Benefits paid

    (12.8 )   (23.3 )   (11.0 )   (18.8 )   (10.0 )   (25.7 )

Plan settlements

        (2.0 )       (5.7 )       (2.4 )

Net transfer in/(out)/acquisitions

    13.2                      

Foreign currency translation (loss) gain

        (9.0 )       (1.9 )       16.7  
                           

Fair value of plan assets at end of year

  $ 139.7   $ 532.6   $ 119.8   $ 489.9   $ 112.3   $ 462.4  
                           
                           

86


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Pension Plans (Continued)

 

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30, 2014   September 30, 2013   September 30, 2012  
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Reconciliation of funded status:

                                     

Funded status at end of year

  $ (77.3 ) $ (144.0 ) $ (60.5 ) $ (132.2 ) $ (80.6 ) $ (111.6 )

Contribution made after measurement date

    N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A     N/A  
                           

Net amount recognized at end of year

  $ (77.3 ) $ (144.0 ) $ (60.5 ) $ (132.2 ) $ (80.6 ) $ (111.6 )
                           
                           

        The following table sets forth the amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets as of September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30, 2014   September 30, 2013   September 30, 2012  
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets:

                                     

Other non-current assets

  $   $ 1.1   $   $ 0.6   $   $  

Accrued expenses and other current liabilities

    (1.7 )       (1.4 )       (1.7 )    

Other long-term liabilities

    (75.6 )   (145.1 )   (59.1 )   (132.8 )   (78.9 )   (111.6 )
                           

Net amount recognized in the balance sheet

  $ (77.3 ) $ (144.0 ) $ (60.5 ) $ (132.2 ) $ (80.6 ) $ (111.6 )
                           
                           

        The following table details the reconciliation of amounts in the consolidated statements of stockholders' equity for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30, 2014   September 30, 2013   September 30, 2012  
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Reconciliation of amounts in consolidated statements of stockholders' equity:

                                     

Prior service credit

  $   $ 5.8   $   $ 6.0   $   $ 6.2  

Net (loss)

    (113.0 )   (190.1 )   (99.4 )   (170.7 )   (115.1 )   (143.2 )
                           

Total recognized in accumulated other comprehensive (loss)

  $ (113.0 ) $ (184.3 ) $ (99.4 ) $ (164.7 ) $ (115.1 ) $ (137.0 )
                           
                           

87


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Pension Plans (Continued)

        The following table details the components of net periodic benefit cost for the plans in fiscal 2014, 2013 and 2012:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Components of net periodic (benefit) cost:

                                     

Service costs

  $   $ 0.7   $   $ 1.0   $   $ 1.1  

Interest cost on projected benefit obligation

    7.8     27.9     6.6     23.8     7.7     25.6  

Expected return on plan assets

    (8.6 )   (26.1 )   (8.5 )   (22.7 )   (8.4 )   (25.3 )

Amortization of prior service costs

        (0.2 )       (0.2 )       (0.2 )

Amortization of net loss

    4.0     4.9     4.3     4.0     3.1     2.3  

Settlement loss recognized

        0.4         2.6         0.5  
                           

Net periodic (benefit) cost

  $ 3.2   $ 7.6   $ 2.4   $ 8.5   $ 2.4   $ 4.0  
                           
                           

        The amount, net of applicable deferred income taxes, included in other comprehensive income arising from a change in net prior service cost and net gain/loss was $7.6 million, $2.6 million and $9.0 million in the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

        Amounts included in accumulated other comprehensive loss as of September 30, 2014 that are expected to be recognized as components of net periodic benefit cost during fiscal 2015 are (in millions):

 
  U.S.   Int'l  

Amortization of prior service cost

  $   $ 0.2  

Amortization of net actuarial losses

    (4.3 )   (6.2 )
           

Total

  $ (4.3 ) $ (6.0 )
           
           

        The table below provides additional year-end information for pension plans with accumulated benefit obligations in excess of plan assets.

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  
 
  (in millions)
 

Projected benefit obligation

  $ 217.0   $ 658.5   $ 180.3   $ 601.7   $ 192.9   $ 574.0  

Accumulated benefit obligation

    217.0     656.3     180.3     599.8     192.9     570.6  

Fair value of plan assets

    139.7     513.4     119.8     469.0     112.3     462.4  

        Funding requirements for each plan are determined based on the local laws of the country where such plan resides. In certain countries, the funding requirements are mandatory while in other countries, they are discretionary. The Company currently intends to contribute $17.0 million to the international plans in fiscal 2015. The Company does not have a required minimum contribution for the U.S. plans; however, the

88


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Pension Plans (Continued)

Company may make discretionary contributions. The Company currently intends to contribute $5.4 million to U.S. plans in fiscal 2015.

        The table below provides the expected future benefit payments, in millions:

Year Ending September 30,
  U.S.   Int'l  

2015

  $ 12.2   $ 26.5  

2016

    14.9     21.9  

2017

    13.4     26.3  

2018

    12.9     29.1  

2019

    13.4     25.8  

2020 - 2024

    68.3     153.3  
           

Total

  $ 135.1   $ 282.9  
           
           

        The underlying assumptions for the pension plans are as follows:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  

Weighted-average assumptions to determine benefit obligation:

                                     

Discount rate

    4.00 %   3.94 %   4.40 %   4.44 %   3.50 %   4.39 %

Salary increase rate

    N/A     2.38 %   N/A     2.58 %   N/A     2.36 %

Weighted-average assumptions to determine net periodic benefit cost:

                                     

Discount rate

    4.40 %   4.44 %   3.50 %   4.39 %   4.65 %   5.12 %

Salary increase rate

    N/A     2.58 %   N/A     2.36 %   N/A     2.65 %

Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets

    7.50 %   5.40 %   7.50 %   5.11 %   7.50 %   5.65 %

        Pension costs are determined using the assumptions as of the beginning of the plan year, October 1. The funded status is determined using the assumptions as of the end of the plan year.

        The following table summarizes the Company's target allocation for 2014 and pension plan asset allocation, both U.S. and international, as of September 30, 2014 and 2013:

 
   
   
  Percentage of Plan Assets
as of September 30,
 
 
  Target
Allocations
 
 
  2014   2013  
 
  U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l   U.S.   Int'l  

Asset Category

                                     

Equities

    45 %   1 %   58 %   28 %   49 %   28 %

Debt

    42     47     31     33     34     37  

Cash

    3     1     1     3     1     4  

Property and other

    10     51     10     36     16     31  
                           

Total

    100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %   100 %
                           
                           

89


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Pension Plans (Continued)

        The Company's policy is to minimize the risk of large losses through diversification in a portfolio of stocks, bonds, and cash equivalents, as appropriate, which may reflect varying rates of return. The percentage of assets allocated to cash is to assure liquidity to meet benefit disbursements and general operating expenses.

        To develop the expected long-term rate of return on assets assumption, the Company considered the historical returns and the future expectations for returns for each asset class, as well as the target asset allocation of the pension portfolio and the diversification of the portfolio. This resulted in the selection of a 7.5% and 5.4% weighted-average long-term rate of return on assets assumption for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2014 for U.S. and non-U.S. plans, respectively.

        As of September 30, 2014, the fair values of the Company's post- retirement benefit plan assets by major asset categories were as follows:

 
   
  Fair Value Measurement as of
September 30, 2014
 
 
  Total
Carrying
Value as of
September 30,
2014
  Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 7.9   $ 3.4   $ 4.5   $  

Investment funds

                         

Diversified funds

    159.3         159.3      

Equity funds

    220.3         220.3      

Fixed income funds

    219.3         219.3      

Hedge funds

    27.9         14.2     13.7  

Assets held by insurance company

    37.6         37.6      
                   

Total

  $ 672.3   $ 3.4   $ 655.2   $ 13.7  
                   
                   

        As of September 30, 2013, the fair values of the Company's post- retirement benefit plan assets by major asset categories are as follows:

 
   
  Fair Value Measurement as of September 30, 2013  
 
  Total
Carrying
Value as of
September 30,
2013
  Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
(Level 1)
  Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
  Significant
Unobservable
Inputs
(Level 3)
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Cash and cash equivalents

  $ 11.0   $ 11.0   $   $  

Investment funds

                         

Diversified funds

    108.6         108.6      

Equity funds

    192.4         192.4      

Fixed income funds

    220.6         220.6      

Hedge funds

    25.0         12.4     12.6  

Assets held by insurance company

    46.1         46.1      

Real estate

    6.0         6.0      
                   

Total

  $ 609.7   $ 11.0   $ 586.1   $ 12.6  
                   
                   

90


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

8. Pension Plans (Continued)

        Changes for the year ended September 30, 2014, in the fair value of the Company's recurring post-retirement plan Level 3 assets are as follows:

 
  September 30,
2013
Beginning
balance
  Actual return
on plan assets,
relating to
assets still held
at reporting
date
  Actual return
on plan assets,
relating to
assets sold
during the
period
  Purchases,
sales and
settlements
  Transfer
into /
(out of)
Level 3
  Change
due to
exchange
rate
changes
  September 30,
2014
Ending
balance
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Investment funds

                                           

Hedge funds

  $ 12.6   $ 1.1   $   $   $   $   $ 13.7  
                               

Total

  $ 12.6   $ 1.1   $   $   $   $   $ 13.7  
                               
                               

        Changes for the year ended September 30, 2013, in the fair value of the Company's recurring post-retirement plan Level 3 assets are as follows:

 
  September 30,
2012
Beginning
balance
  Actual return
on plan assets,
relating to
assets still held
at reporting
date
  Actual return
on plan assets,
relating to
assets sold
during the
period
  Purchases,
sales
and
settlements
  Transfer
into /
(out of)
Level 3
  Change
due to
exchange
rate
changes
  September 30,
2013
Ending
balance
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Investment funds

                                           

Hedge funds

  $ 10.6   $ 2.0   $   $   $   $   $ 12.6  
                               

Total

  $ 10.6   $ 2.0   $   $   $   $   $ 12.6  
                               
                               

        Cash equivalents are mostly comprised of short-term money-market instruments and are valued at cost, which approximates fair value.

        For equity investment funds not traded on an active exchange, or if the closing price is not available, the trustee obtains indicative quotes from a pricing vendor, broker, or investment manager. These funds are categorized as Level 2 if the custodian obtains corroborated quotes from a pricing vendor or categorized as Level 3 if the custodian obtains uncorroborated quotes from a broker or investment manager.

        Fixed income investment funds categorized as Level 2 are valued by the trustee using pricing models that use verifiable observable market data (e.g., interest rates and yield curves observable at commonly quoted intervals), bids provided by brokers or dealers, or quoted prices of securities with similar characteristics.

        Hedge funds categorized as Level 3 are valued based on valuation models that include significant unobservable inputs and cannot be corroborated using verifiable observable market data. Hedge funds are valued by independent administrators. Depending on the nature of the assets, the general partners or independent administrators use both the income and market approaches in their models. The market approach consists of analyzing market transactions for comparable assets while the income approach uses earnings or the net present value of estimated future cash flows adjusted for liquidity and other risk factors. As of September 30, 2014, there were no material changes to the valuation techniques.

91


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Debt

        Debt consisted of the following:

 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Unsecured term credit agreement

  $ 712.5   $ 750.0  

Unsecured senior notes

    263.9     260.2  

Unsecured revolving credit facility

        114.7  

Other debt

    27.6     48.4  
           

Total debt

    1,004.0     1,173.3  

Less: Current portion of debt and short-term borrowings

    (64.4 )   (84.3 )
           

Long-term debt, less current portion

  $ 939.6   $ 1,089.0  
           
           

        The following table presents, in millions, scheduled maturities of our debt as of September 30, 2014:

Fiscal Year
   
 

2015

  $ 64.4  

2016

    38.0  

2017

    37.7  

2018

    600.0  

2019

     

Thereafter

    263.9  
       

Total

  $ 1,004.0  
       
       

    Unsecured Term Credit Agreement

        In June 2013, the Company entered into a Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (Term Credit Agreement) with Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent and a lender, and the other lenders party thereto. Pursuant to the Term Credit Agreement, the Company borrowed $750 million and may borrow up to an additional $100 million subject to certain conditions, including Company and lender approval. The Company used approximately $675 million of the proceeds from the loans to repay indebtedness under our prior term loan facility. The loans under the Term Credit Agreement bear interest, at our option, at either the Base Rate (as defined in the Term Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin or the Eurodollar Rate (as defined in the Term Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin. The applicable margin for the Base Rate loans is a range of 0.125% to 1.250% and the applicable margin for Eurodollar Rate loans is a range of 1.125% to 2.250%, both based on our debt-to-earnings leverage ratio at the end of each fiscal quarter. For the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013, the average interest rate of the Company's term loan facility was 1.66% and 1.98%, respectively. Payments of the initial principal amount outstanding under the Term Credit Agreement are required on an annual basis and began on June 30, 2014 with the final principal balance of $600 million due on June 7, 2018. The Company may, at its option, prepay the loans at any time, without penalty. The Company's obligations under the Term Credit Agreement are guaranteed by certain of our subsidiaries pursuant to one or more subsidiary guarantees.

92


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Debt (Continued)

    Unsecured Senior Notes

        In July 2010, the Company issued $300 million of notes to private institutional investors. The notes consisted of $175.0 million of 5.43% Senior Notes, Series A, due July 2020 and $125.0 million of 1.00% Senior Discount Notes, Series B, due July 2022 for net proceeds of $249.8 million. The outstanding accreted balance of Series B Notes, which have an effective interest rate of 5.62%, was $88.9 million and $85.2 million at September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The fair value of the Company's unsecured senior notes was approximately $287.4 million and $269.4 million at September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The Company calculated the fair values based on model-derived valuations using market observable inputs, which are Level 2 inputs under the accounting guidance. The Company's obligations under the notes are guaranteed by certain of its subsidiaries pursuant to one or more subsidiary guarantees. The Company has the option to prepay the notes at any time at their called principal amount, together with any accrued and unpaid interest, plus a make-whole premium.

    Unsecured Revolving Credit Facility

        In January 2014, the Company entered into a Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement (Revolving Credit Agreement), which provides for a borrowing capacity of $1.05 billion. The Revolving Credit Agreement expires on January 29, 2019, and prior to this expiration date, principal amounts outstanding under the Revolving Credit Agreement may be repaid and reborrowed at the Company's option without prepayment or penalty, subject to certain conditions including the absence of any event of default. The Company may request an increase in capacity of up to a total of $1.25 billion, subject to certain conditions including the absence of any event of default. The loans under the Revolving Credit Agreement may be borrowed in dollars or in certain foreign currencies and bear interest, at our option, at either the Base Rate (as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin or the Eurocurrency Rate (as defined in the Revolving Credit Agreement) plus an applicable margin. The applicable margin for the Base Rate loans is a range of 0.125% to 1.250% and the applicable margin for the Eurocurrency Rate loans is a range of 1.125% to 2.250%, both based on the Company's debt-to-earnings leverage ratio at the end of each fiscal quarter. In addition to these borrowing rates, there is a commitment fee which ranges from 0.125% to 0.350% on any unused commitment. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, $0.0 million and $114.7 million, respectively, were outstanding under the Company's revolving credit facility. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, outstanding standby letters of credit totaled $12.1 million and $35.5 million, respectively, under the Company's revolving credit facility. As of September 30, 2014, the Company had $1,037.9 million available under our Revolving Credit Agreement.

    Covenants and Restrictions

        Under the Company's debt agreements relating to its unsecured revolving credit facility, unsecured term credit agreement, and unsecured senior notes, the Company is subject to a maximum consolidated leverage ratio at the end of each fiscal quarter. This ratio is calculated by dividing consolidated funded debt (including financial letters of credit and other adjustments per its debt agreements) by consolidated earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation, and amortization (EBITDA). Subject to certain differences among our debt agreements, EBITDA is defined as consolidated net income attributable to AECOM plus interest, depreciation and amortization expense, amounts set aside for taxes and other non-cash items (including a calculated annualized EBITDA from our acquisitions). As of September 30, 2014, the Company's most restrictive consolidated leverage ratio under its debt agreements was 2.55, which did not exceed the Company's maximum consolidated leverage ratio permitted under its debt agreements of 3.0.

93


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

9. Debt (Continued)

        Our Revolving Credit Agreement and Term Credit Agreement also contain certain covenants that limit our ability to, among other things, (i) merge with other entities, (ii) enter into a transaction resulting in a change of control, (iii) create new liens, (iv) sell assets outside of the ordinary course of business, (v) enter into transactions with affiliates, (vi) substantially change the general nature of the Company and its subsidiaries taken as a whole, and (vii) incur indebtedness and contingent obligations.

        Additionally, the Company's unsecured senior notes contain covenants that limit (i) certain types of indebtedness, which include indebtedness incurred by subsidiaries and indebtedness secured by a lien, (ii) merging with other entities, (iii) entering into a transaction resulting in a change of control, (iv) creating new liens, (v) selling assets outside of the ordinary course of business, (vi) entering into transactions with affiliates, and (vii) substantially changing the general nature of our Company and our subsidiaries taken as a whole. The unsecured senior notes also contain a financial covenant that requires us to maintain a net worth above a calculated threshold. The threshold is calculated as $1.2 billion plus 40% of the consolidated net income for each fiscal quarter commencing with the fiscal quarter ending June 30, 2010. In the calculation of this threshold, the Company cannot include a consolidated net loss that may occur in any fiscal quarter. The Company's net worth for this financial covenant is defined as total AECOM stockholders' equity, which is consolidated stockholders' equity, including any redeemable common stock and stock units and the liquidation preference of any preferred stock. As of September 30, 2014, this amount was $2.2 billion, which exceeds the calculated threshold of $1.7 billion.

        Should the Company fail to comply with these covenants, all or a portion of its borrowings under the unsecured senior notes and unsecured term credit agreements could become immediately payable and its unsecured revolving credit facility could be terminated. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company was in compliance with all such covenants.

        The Company's average effective interest rate on total borrowings, including the effects of the interest rate swap agreements, during the year ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was 2.8%, 3.0% and 3.1%, respectively.

    Other Debt

        Other debt consists primarily of bank overdrafts, obligations under capital leases, and other unsecured credit facilities. In addition to the unsecured revolving credit facility discussed above, the Company also has other unsecured credit facilities primarily used for standby letters of credit issued for payment of performance guarantees. At September 30, 2014 and 2013, these outstanding standby letters of credit totaled $301.0 million and $236.4 million, respectively. As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company had $327.4 million and $331.8 million, respectively, available under these unsecured credit facilities.

10. Derivative Financial Instruments

        The Company uses certain interest rate derivative contracts to hedge interest rate exposures on the Company's variable rate debt. The Company enters into foreign currency derivative contracts with financial institutions to reduce the risk that its cash flows and earnings will be adversely affected by foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations. The Company's hedging program is not designated for trading or speculative purposes.

        The Company recognizes derivative instruments as either assets or liabilities on the accompanying consolidated balance sheets at fair value. The Company records changes in the fair value (i.e., gains or

94


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

10. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

losses) of the derivatives that have been designated as accounting hedges in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations as cost of revenue, interest expense or to accumulated other comprehensive loss in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets.

    Cash Flow Hedges

        The Company uses interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges to fix the variable interest rates on portions of the Company's debt. The Company also uses foreign currency options designated as cash flow hedges to hedge forecasted revenue transactions denominated in currencies other than the U.S. dollar. The Company initially reports any gain on the effective portion of a cash flow hedge as a component of accumulated other comprehensive loss. Depending on the type of cash flow hedge, the gain is subsequently reclassified to either interest expense when the interest expense on the variable rate debt is recognized, or to cost of revenue when the hedged revenues are recorded. If the hedged transaction becomes probable of not occurring, any gain or loss related to interest rate swap agreements or foreign currency options would be recognized in other income (expense). Further, the Company excludes the change in the time value of the foreign currency options from the assessment of hedge effectiveness. The Company records the premium paid or time value of an option on the date of purchase as an asset. Thereafter, the Company recognizes any change to this time value in cost of revenue.

        The notional principal, fixed rates and related expiration dates of the Company's outstanding interest rate swap agreements were as follows:

 
  September 30, 2014    
 
 
Notional Amount
(in millions)
  Fixed
Rate
  Expiration
Date
   

  $ 300.0     1.63 % June 2018    

    250.0     0.95 % September 2015    

    200.0     0.68 % December 2014    

 

 
  September 30, 2013    
 
 
Notional Amount
(in millions)
  Fixed
Rate
  Expiration
Date
   

  $ 250.0     0.95 % September 2015    

    200.0     0.68 % December 2014    

    150.0     0.55 % December 2013    

        There were no foreign currency options to purchase British Pounds (GBP) with Brazilian Reals (BRL) at September 30, 2014. The notional principal of foreign currency options to purchase GBP with BRL was BRL 2.1 million (or approximately $0.9 million) at September 30, 2013.

    Foreign Currency Forward Contracts

        The Company uses foreign currency forward contracts, which are not designated as accounting hedges, to hedge intercompany transactions and other monetary assets or liabilities denominated in currencies other than the functional currency of a subsidiary. Gains and losses on these contracts are recognized in cost of revenue for those instruments related to the provision of their respective services or general and administrative expenses, along with the offsetting losses and gains of the related hedged items.

95


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

10. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to purchase U.S. dollars with foreign currencies was $69.5 million at September 30, 2014. The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to sell U.S. dollars for foreign currencies was $71.5 million at September 30, 2014. The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to purchase GBP with BRL was BRL 1.1 million (or approximately $0.4 million) at September 30, 2014. The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to purchase U.S. dollars with foreign currencies was $171.8 million at September 30, 2013. The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to sell U.S. dollars for foreign currencies was $174.2 million at September 30, 2013. The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to purchase GBP with BRL was BRL 4.0 million (or approximately $1.8 million) at September 30, 2013. The notional principal of foreign currency forward contracts to sell GBP for BRL was BRL 8.2 million (or approximately $3.6 million) at September 30, 2013.

    Other Derivatives

        Other derivatives that are not designated as hedging instruments consist of option contracts that the Company uses to hedge anticipated transactions in currencies other than the functional currency of a subsidiary. The Company recognizes gains and losses on these contracts as well as the offsetting losses and gains of the related hedged item costs in cost of revenue. The Company records the premium paid or time value of an option on the date of purchase as an asset. Thereafter, the Company recognizes any change to this time value in cost of revenue. There were no such option contracts were outstanding at September 30, 2014 and 2013.

        The fair values of our outstanding derivative instruments were as follows (in millions):

 
   
  Fair Value of
Derivative
Instruments
as of
 
 
  Balance Sheet Location   Sep 30,
2014
  Sep 30,
2013
 

Derivative assets

                 

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:

                 

Foreign currency options

  Prepaid expenses and other current assets   $   $ 0.1  

Interest rate swap agreements

  Other non-current asset     1.7      

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:

                 

Foreign currency forward contracts

  Prepaid expenses and other current assets     3.1     1.6  
               

Total

      $ 4.8   $ 1.7  
               
               

Derivative liabilities

                 

Derivatives designated as hedging instruments:

                 

Interest rate swap agreements

  Accrued expenses and other current liabilities   $ 4.8   $ 2.6  

Interest rate swap agreements

  Other long-term liabilities         1.1  

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:

                 

Foreign currency forward contracts

  Accrued expenses and other current liabilities     3.7     1.5  
               

Total

      $ 8.5   $ 5.2  
               
               

96


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

10. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

        At September 30, 2014, the effective portion of the Company's interest rate swap agreements designated as cash flow hedges before tax effect was $3.0 million, of which $4.8 million is expected to be reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss to interest expense within the next 12 months. At September 30, 2014, the effective portion of the Company's foreign currency options designated as cash flow hedges before tax effect were immaterial.

        The effect of derivative instruments in cash flow hedging relationships on income and other comprehensive income is summarized below (in millions):

 
  Increase in Losses
Recognized in Accumulated
Other Comprehensive Loss
on Derivatives Before Tax
Effect (Effective Portion)
Year Ended September 30,
 
 
  2014   2013   2012  

Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationship:

                   

Interest rate swap agreements

  $ (2.4 ) $ (0.5 ) $ (8.4 )

 

 
   
  Losses Reclassified from
Accumulated Other
Comprehensive Loss into
Income (Effective Portion)
Year Ended September 30,
 
 
  Location   2014   2013   2012  

Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationship:

                       

Interest rate swap agreements

  Interest expense   $ (2.9 ) $ (3.1 ) $ (2.2 )

Foreign currency options

  Cost of revenue     (0.1 )        

 

 
   
  Losses Recognized in
Income on Derivatives
(Amount Excluded from
Effectiveness Testing and
Ineffective Portion)(1)
Year Ended September 30,
 
 
  Location   2014   2013   2012  

Derivatives in cash flow hedging relationship:

                       

Foreign currency options

  Cost of revenue   $   $ (0.1 ) $ (0.1 )

(1)
Losses related to the ineffective portion of the hedges were not material in all periods presented.

        The gain recognized in accumulated other comprehensive loss from the Company's foreign currency options was immaterial for all years presented. The gain reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss into income from the foreign currency options was immaterial for all years presented. Additionally, there were no losses recognized in income due to amounts excluded from effectiveness testing from the Company's interest rate swap agreements.

97


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

10. Derivative Financial Instruments (Continued)

        The effect of derivative instruments not designated as hedging instruments on income is summarized below (in millions):

 
   
  Gains / (Losses) Recognized
in Income on Derivatives
(Amount Excluded from
Effectiveness Testing and
Ineffective Portion)(1)
Year Ended September 30,
 
 
  Location   2014   2013   2012  

Derivatives not designated as hedging instruments:

                       

Foreign currency forward contracts

  General and administrative expenses   $ (0.1 ) $ (4.7 ) $ 4.2  

Foreign currency forward contracts

  Cost of revenue             0.1  

Option contracts

  Cost of revenue         (0.3 )   (0.1 )
                   

      $ (0.1 ) $ (5.0 ) $ 4.2  
                   
                   

(1)
Losses related to the ineffective portion of the hedges were not material in all periods presented.

11. Fair Value Measurements

        Fair value is the price that would be received from selling an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. When determining fair value, the Company considers the principal or most advantageous market in which it would transact, and the Company considers assumptions that market participants would use when pricing the asset or liability. It measures certain financial and nonfinancial assets and liabilities at fair value on a recurring and nonrecurring basis.

        Nonfinancial assets and liabilities include items such as goodwill and long lived assets that are measured at fair value resulting from impairment, if deemed necessary. During the year ended September 30, 2012, the Company recognized an impairment of goodwill within both its PTS and MSS reportable segments. For further information regarding the impairment of goodwill refer to Note 4 herein.

    Fair Value Hierarchy

        The three levels of inputs may be used to measure fair value, as discussed in Note 1. There were no significant transfers between any of the levels of the fair value hierarchy during the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013. The Company classifies its derivative financial instruments within Level 2 as the valuation inputs are based on quoted prices and market observable data of similar instruments.

98


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

11. Fair Value Measurements (Continued)

        The following table summarizes the Company's non-pension financial assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis (at least annually) in millions:

 
  September 30,
2014
  Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Similar Assets
(Level 2)
 

Interest rate swap agreements

  $ 1.7   $ 1.7  

Foreign currency forward contracts

    3.1     3.1  
           

Total assets

  $ 4.8   $ 4.8  
           
           

Interest rate swap agreements

  $ 4.8   $ 4.8  

Foreign currency forward contracts

    3.7     3.7  
           

Total liabilities

  $ 8.5   $ 8.5  
           
           

 

 
  September 30,
2013
  Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Similar Assets
(Level 2)
 

Foreign currency options

  $ 0.1   $ 0.1  

Foreign currency forward contracts

    1.6     1.6  
           

Total assets

  $ 1.7   $ 1.7  
           
           

Interest rate swap agreements

  $ 3.7   $ 3.7  

Foreign currency forward contracts

    1.5     1.5  
           

Total liabilities

  $ 5.2   $ 5.2  
           
           

        For additional information about the Company's derivative financial instruments refer to Note 10 herein.

12. Concentration of Credit Risk

        Financial instruments which potentially subject the Company to concentrations of credit risk consist principally of cash investments and trade receivables. The Company's cash balances and short-term investments are maintained in accounts held by major banks and financial institutions located primarily in the U.S., Canada, Europe, Australia, Middle East and Hong Kong. If the Company extends significant credit to clients in a specific geographic area or industry, the Company may experience disproportionately high levels of default if those clients are adversely affected by factors particular to their geographic area or industry. Concentrations of credit risk with respect to trade receivables are limited due to the large number of customers comprising the Company's customer base, including, in large part, governments, government agencies and quasi-government organizations, and their dispersion across many different industries and geographies. See Note 21 regarding the Company's foreign revenues. In order to mitigate credit risk, the Company continually reviews the credit worthiness of its major private clients.

99


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

13. Leases

        The Company and its subsidiaries are lessees in non-cancelable leasing agreements for office buildings and equipment. The related payments are expensed on a straight-line basis over the lease term, including, as applicable, any free-rent period during which the Company has the right to use the asset. For leases with renewal options where the renewal is reasonably assured, the lease term, including the renewal period is used to determine the appropriate lease classification and to compute periodic rental expense. The following table presents, in millions, amounts payable under non-cancelable operating lease commitments during the following fiscal years:

Year Ending September 30,
   
 

2015

  $ 181.4  

2016

    154.8  

2017

    126.4  

2018

    102.6  

2019

    86.1  

Thereafter

    234.7  
       

Total

  $ 886.0  
       
       

        Rent expense for leases for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was approximately $210.4 million, $225.4 million and $237.4 million, respectively. When the Company is required to restore leased facilities to original condition, provisions are made over the period of the lease.

14. Other Financial Information

        Accrued expenses and other current liabilities consist of the following:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Accrued salaries and benefits

  $ 400.6   $ 410.6  

Accrued contract costs

    446.4     404.2  

Other accrued expenses

    117.6     100.5  
           

  $ 964.6   $ 915.3  
           
           

        Accrued contract costs above include balances related to professional liability accruals of $120.2 million and $121.3 million as of September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. The remaining accrued contract costs primarily relate to costs for services provided by subcontractors and other non-employees.

100


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

14. Other Financial Information (Continued)

        Other long-term liabilities consist of the following:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Pension liabilities (Note 8)

  $ 221.3   $ 192.7  

Reserve for uncertain tax positions (Note 18)

    52.6     60.2  

Other

    181.7     196.0  
           

  $ 455.6   $ 448.9  
           
           

15. Reclassifications out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss

        The accumulated balances and reporting period activities for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 related to reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive loss are summarized as follows (in millions):

 
  Pension
Related
Adjustments
  Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
  Loss on
Derivative
Instruments
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
 

Balances at September 30, 2011

  $ (136.5 ) $ (51.1 ) $   $ (187.6 )

Other comprehensive income before reclassification

    (44.7 )   53.8     (5.0 )   4.1  

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss:

                         

Actuarial losses, net of tax

    3.0             3.0  

Cash flow hedge losses, net of tax

            1.3     1.3  
                   

Balances at September 30, 2012

  $ (178.2 ) $ 2.7   $ (3.7 ) $ (179.2 )
                   
                   

 

 
  Pension
Related
Adjustments
  Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
  Loss on
Derivative
Instruments
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
 

Balances at September 30, 2012

  $ (178.2 ) $ 2.7   $ (3.7 ) $ (179.2 )

Other comprehensive income before reclassification

    (19.9 )   (69.1 )   (0.2 )   (89.2 )

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss:

                         

Actuarial losses, net of tax

    5.3             5.3  

Cash flow hedge losses, net of tax

            1.8     1.8  
                   

Balances at September 30, 2013

  $ (192.8 ) $ (66.4 ) $ (2.1 ) $ (261.3 )
                   
                   

101


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

15. Reclassifications out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Loss (Continued)

 

 
  Pension
Related
Adjustments
  Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
  Loss on
Derivative
Instruments
  Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Loss
 

Balances at September 30, 2013

  $ (192.8 ) $ (66.4 ) $ (2.1 ) $ (261.3 )

Other comprehensive income before reclassification

    (30.3 )   (71.4 )   (1.4 )   (103.1 )

Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss:

                         

Actuarial losses, net of tax

    6.1             6.1  

Cash flow hedge losses, net of tax

            1.7     1.7  
                   

Balances at September 30, 2014

  $ (217.0 ) $ (137.8 ) $ (1.8 ) $ (356.6 )
                   
                   

 

 
  Year Ended
September 30,
2014
  Year Ended
September 30,
2013
  Year Ended
September 30,
2012
 

Cash flow hedges(1)

  $ 2.9   $ 3.0   $ 2.2  

Taxes

    (1.2 )   (1.2 )   (0.9 )
               

Cash flow hedges, net of tax

  $ 1.7   $ 1.8   $ 1.3  
               
               

Actuarial losses(2)

  $ 8.7   $ 8.0   $ 4.7  

Taxes

    (2.6 )   (2.7 )   (1.7 )
               

Actuarial losses, net of tax

  $ 6.1   $ 5.3   $ 3.0  
               
               

(1)
This accumulated other comprehensive component is reclassified in Interest expense in our Consolidated Statements of Income. See Note 10, Derivative Financial Instruments, for more information.

(2)
This accumulated other comprehensive component is reclassified in Cost of revenue and General and administrative expenses in our Consolidated Statements of Income. See Note 8, Pension Benefit Obligations, for more information.

16. Stockholders' Equity

        Common Stock Units —Common stock units are only redeemable for common stock. In the event of liquidation of the Company, holders of stock units are entitled to no greater rights than holders of common stock. See also Note 17.

17. Stock Plans

        Defined Contribution Plans —Substantially all permanent employees are eligible to participate in defined contribution plans provided by the Company. Under these plans, participants may make contributions into a variety of funds, including a fund that is fully invested in Company stock. Employees are not required to allocate any funds to Company stock. Employees may generally reallocate their account balances on a daily basis; however, employees classified as insiders are restricted under the Company's insider trading policy.

102


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

17. Stock Plans (Continued)

        Stock compensation expense relating to employer contributions under defined contribution plans for fiscal years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $14.4 million, $14.6 million and $15.9 million, respectively. Issuances of AECOM common stock related to employee participants' contributions to these defined contribution plans are included as issuances of stock in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Equity and of Cash Flows.

        Stock Incentive Plans —Under the 2006 Stock Incentive Plan, the Company has up to 19.8 million securities remaining available for future issuance under stock options or up to 9.9 million securities remaining available for restricted stock awards and performance stock awards as of September 30, 2014. Stock options may be granted to employees and non-employee directors with an exercise price not less than the fair market value of the stock on the date of grant. Unexercised options expire seven years after date of grant.

        During the three years in the period ended September 30, 2014, option activity was as follows:

 
  Number of
Options
(in millions)
  Weighted
Average
Exercise Price
 

Balance, September 30, 2011

    2.9   $ 21.38  

Granted

         

Exercised

    (0.4 )   11.40  

Cancelled

        26.23  
             

Balance, September 30, 2012

    2.5     22.81  
             
             

Granted

         

Exercised

    (0.8 )   18.31  

Cancelled

    (0.1 )   26.83  
             

Balance, September 30, 2013

    1.6     24.73  
             
             

Granted

    0.6     31.62  

Exercised

    (0.5 )   23.64  

Cancelled

    (0.1 )   26.87  
             

Balance, September 30, 2014

    1.6     27.69  
             
             

Exercisable as of September 30, 2012

    2.1   $ 22.07  
             
             

Exercisable as of September 30, 2013

    1.4     24.51  
             
             

Exercisable as of September 30, 2014

    0.9     25.16  
             
             

103


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

17. Stock Plans (Continued)

        The following table summarizes information concerning outstanding and exercisable options as of September 30, 2014:

 
  Options Outstanding    
  Options Exercisable  
 
  Number
Outstanding
as of
September 30,
2014
(in millions)
  Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
  Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(in millions)
  Number
Exercisable
as of
September 30,
2014
(in millions)
  Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contractual
Life
  Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price
 

Range of Exercise Prices

                                           

$21.01 - $23.94

    0.4     1.18   $ 23.46   $ 4.1     0.4     1.18   $ 23.46  

  24.45 -  28.67

    0.5     2.06     26.24     3.6     0.5     2.06     26.24  

  30.96 -  34.00

    0.7     9.17     31.65     0.8         0.66     32.53  
                                       

    1.6     4.69     27.69   $ 8.5     0.9     1.65     25.16  
                                       
                                       

        The remaining contractual life of options outstanding at September 30, 2014 range from 0.03 to 9.43 years and have a weighted average remaining contractual life of 4.69 years. The aggregate intrinsic value of stock options exercised during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 was $4.3 million, $7.9 million and $3.9 million, respectively.

        The fair value of the Company's employee stock option awards is estimated on the date of grant. The expected term of awards granted represents the period of time the awards are expected to be outstanding. The risk-free interest rate is based on U.S. Treasury bond rates with maturities equal to the expected term of the option on the grant date. The Company uses historical data as a basis to estimate the probability of forfeitures. The weighted average grant-date fair value of stock options granted during the year ended September 30, 2014 was $7.83.

        The Company grants stock units to employees under the Performance Earnings Program (PEP), whereby units are earned and issued dependent upon meeting established performance objectives and vesting over a three-year period. Additionally, the Company issues restricted stock units, which are earned based on service conditions. The grant date fair value of PEP awards and restricted stock unit awards is that day's closing market price of the Company's common stock. The weighted average grant date fair value of PEP awards was $29.32, $22.27, and $20.58 during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. The weighted average grant date fair value of restricted stock unit awards was $29.60, $22.83, and $20.62 during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Total compensation expense related to these share-based payments including stock options was $34.4 million, $32.6 million and $26.6 million during the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. Unrecognized compensation expense related to total share-based payments outstanding as of September 30, 2014 was $62.4 million, to be recognized on a straight-line basis over the awards' respective vesting periods which are generally three years.

        Cash flow attributable to tax benefits resulting from tax deductions in excess of compensation cost recognized for those stock options (excess tax benefits) is classified as financing cash flows. Excess tax benefits of $0.7 million, $1.8 million and $1.3 million for the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively, have been classified as financing cash inflows in the Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

104


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

18. Income Taxes

        Income before income taxes included income (loss) from domestic operations of $138.2 million, $111.8 million and $(89.2) million for fiscal years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012 and income from foreign operations of $176.6 million, $224.0 million and $106.7 million for fiscal years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012.

        Income tax expense (benefit) on continuing operations is comprised of:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Current:

                   

Federal

  $ 5.3   $ 30.3   $ 29.3  

State

    3.3     9.9     2.1  

Foreign

    46.3     59.7     63.3  
               

Total current income tax expense

    54.9     99.9     94.7  
               

Deferred:

                   

Federal

    27.7     5.8     (19.2 )

State

    5.6     (10.6 )   0.6  

Foreign

    (6.2 )   (2.5 )   (1.7 )
               

Total deferred income tax expense (benefit)

    27.1     (7.3 )   (20.3 )
               

Total income tax expense

  $ 82.0   $ 92.6   $ 74.4  
               
               

        The major elements contributing to the difference between the U.S. federal statutory rate of 35.0% and the effective tax rate are as follows:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  Amount   %   Amount   %   Amount   %  
 
  (in millions)
 

Tax at federal statutory rate

  $ 110.2     35.0 % $ 117.5     35.0 % $ 6.1     35.0 %

State income tax, net of federal benefit

    5.0     1.6     2.5     0.7     1.1     6.3  

U.S. income tax credits and incentives

    (3.5 )   (1.1 )   (10.8 )   (3.2 )   (2.9 )   (16.6 )

Foreign tax rate differential

    (22.5 )   (7.2 )   (9.9 )   (2.9 )   (25.4 )   (145.1 )

Foreign Research and Experimentation credits

    (3.6 )   (1.1 )   (3.9 )   (1.1 )   (5.8 )   (33.3 )

Goodwill impairment

                    101.1     578.3  

Change in uncertain tax positions

    (4.5 )   (1.4 )   (7.3 )   (2.2 )   (4.1 )   (23.4 )

Valuation allowance

    6.3     2.0     1.6     0.5     0.5     2.7  

Domestic production activities deduction

    (11.7 )   (3.7 )   (2.6 )   (0.8 )   (1.2 )   (6.8 )

Nondeductible transaction costs

    2.8     0.9             1.3     7.6  

Other items, net

    3.5     1.1     5.5     1.6     3.7     21.0  
                           

Total income tax expense

  $ 82.0     26.1 % $ 92.6     27.6 % $ 74.4     425.7 %
                           
                           

105


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

18. Income Taxes (Continued)

        The deferred tax assets (liabilities) are as follows:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Deferred tax assets:

             

Compensation and benefit accruals not currently deductible

  $ 65.5   $ 74.7  

Net operating loss carry forwards

    69.3     58.1  

Self insurance reserves

    48.8     54.7  

Research and Experimentation and other tax credits

    34.2     38.3  

Pension liability

    59.4     58.5  

Accrued liabilities

    63.7     56.1  

Investments in joint ventures/non-controlled subsidiaries

    20.7     13.9  

State taxes

    1.5     0.9  

Other

    4.0     4.2  
           

Total deferred tax assets

    367.1     359.4  
           

Deferred tax liabilities:

             

Unearned revenue

    (122.9 )   (139.3 )

Depreciation and amortization

    (59.2 )   (20.1 )

Acquired intangible assets

    (14.8 )   (15.8 )
           

Total deferred tax liabilities

    (196.9 )   (175.2 )
           

Valuation allowance

    (27.1 )   (20.8 )
           

Net deferred tax assets

  $ 143.1   $ 163.4  
           
           

        As of September 30, 2014, the Company has available unused state net operating loss (NOL) carry forwards of $230.6 million and foreign NOL carry forwards of $260.2 million which expire at various dates. In addition, as of September 30, 2014, the Company has unused state research and development credits of $17.5 million and California Enterprise Zone Tax Credits of $4.6 million which can be carried forward indefinitely.

        As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, gross deferred tax assets were $367.1 million and $359.4 million, respectively. The Company has recorded a valuation allowance of approximately $27.1 million and $20.8 million at September 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, related to state and foreign net operating loss carry forwards and credits. The Company has performed an assessment of positive and negative evidence, including the nature, frequency, and severity of cumulative financial reporting losses in recent years, the future reversal of existing temporary differences, predictability of future taxable income exclusive of reversing temporary differences of the character necessary to realize the asset, relevant carry forward periods, taxable income in carry-back years if carry-back is permitted under tax law, and prudent and feasible tax planning strategies that would be implemented, if necessary, to protect against the loss of the deferred tax asset. Although realization is not assured, based on the Company's assessment, the Company has concluded that it is more likely than not that the remaining gross deferred tax asset (exclusive of

106


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

18. Income Taxes (Continued)

deferred tax liabilities) of $340.0 million will be realized and, as such, no additional valuation allowance has been provided.

        As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company has remaining tax-deductible goodwill of $251.6 million and $283.9 million, respectively, resulting from acquisitions. The amortization of this goodwill is deductible over various periods ranging up to 15 years.

        The Company does not provide for U.S. taxes or foreign withholding taxes on undistributed earnings from non-U.S. subsidiaries because such earnings are able to and intended to be reinvested indefinitely. The undistributed earnings are approximately $976.7 million. If undistributed pre-tax earnings were distributed, foreign tax credits could become available under current law to partially or fully reduce the resulting U.S. income tax liability. If such earnings were repatriated, additional tax expense may result, although the calculation of such additional taxes is not practicable.

        As of September 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company had a liability for unrecognized tax benefits, including potential interest and penalties, net of related tax benefit, totaling $52.6 million and $60.2 million, respectively. The gross unrecognized tax benefits as of September 30, 2014 and 2013 were $47.5 million and $53.7 million, respectively, excluding interest, penalties, and related tax benefit. Of the $47.5 million, approximately $28.6 million would be included in the effective tax rate if recognized in the fiscal year ended September 30, 2014. The adoption of ASC 805, "Accounting for Business Combinations," at the beginning of the fiscal year ended September 30, 2010 changed the treatment of the reversal of unrecognized tax benefits related to acquired companies which prior to adoption of ASC 805 would have impacted goodwill, but after the adoption of ASC 805, results in the recognition of income tax benefit. A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of gross unrecognized tax benefits is as follows:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Balance at the beginning of the year

  $ 53.7   $ 55.8  

Gross increase in prior years' tax positions

    3.3     7.2  

Gross decrease in prior years' tax positions

    (7.6 )   (5.6 )

Decrease due to settlement with tax authorities

    (2.0 )   (1.6 )

Gross increase in current period's tax positions

    2.2     3.8  

Lapse of statute of limitations

    (2.1 )   (5.9 )
           

Balance at the end of the year

  $ 47.5   $ 53.7  
           
           

        The Company classifies interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions within the income tax expense line in the accompanying consolidated statements of operations. At September 30, 2014, the accrued interest and penalties were $6.2 million and $2.9 million, respectively, excluding any related income tax benefits. As of September 30, 2013, the accrued interest and penalties were $7.3 million and $2.7 million, respectively, excluding any related income tax benefits.

        The Company files income tax returns in numerous tax jurisdictions, including the U.S., and numerous U.S. states and non-U.S. jurisdictions around the world. The statute of limitations varies by jurisdiction in which the Company operates. Because of the number of jurisdictions in which the Company files tax

107


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

18. Income Taxes (Continued)

returns, in any given year the statute of limitations in certain jurisdictions may expire without examination within the 12-month period from the balance sheet date.

        The Company is currently under examination by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service for the fiscal years ended September 30, 2010 and September 30, 2011. With a few exceptions, the Company is no longer subject to U.S. state or non-U.S. income tax examinations by tax on authorities for years before fiscal year 2009. The Company anticipates that some of the audits may be concluded in the foreseeable future, including in fiscal year ending September 30, 2015. Based on the status of these audits, it is reasonably possible that the conclusion of the audits may result in a reduction of unrecognized tax benefits. It is not possible to estimate the impact of any change at this time.

19. Earnings Per Share

        Basic earnings per share (EPS) excludes dilution and is computed by dividing net income available for common stockholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Diluted EPS is computed by dividing net income by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding and potential common shares for the period. The Company includes as potential common shares the weighted average dilutive effects of outstanding stock options and restricted stock units using the treasury stock method. The computation of diluted loss per share for the year ended September 30, 2012 excludes 0.7 million of potential common shares due to their antidilutive effect.

        The following table sets forth a reconciliation of the denominators of basic and diluted earnings per share:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30,
2014
  September 30,
2013
  September 30,
2012
 
 
  (in millions)
 

Denominator for basic earnings per share

    97.2     100.6     111.9  

Potential common shares

    1.5     1.3      
               

Denominator for diluted earnings per share

    98.7     101.9     111.9  
               
               

        As discussed in Note 3, EPS includes the effect of repurchased shares. For the years ended September 30, 2014 and 2013, options excluded from the calculation of potential common shares were not significant.

20. Commitments and Contingencies

        The Company records amounts representing its probable estimated liabilities relating to claims, guarantees, litigation, audits and investigations. The Company relies in part on qualified actuaries to assist it in determining the level of reserves to establish for insurance-related claims that are known and have been asserted against it, and for insurance-related claims that are believed to have been incurred based on actuarial analysis, but have not yet been reported to the Company's claims administrators as of the respective balance sheet dates. The Company includes any adjustments to such insurance reserves in its consolidated results of operations.

108


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

20. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

        The Company is a defendant in various lawsuits arising in the normal course of business. In the opinion of management, based upon current information and discussions with counsel, with the exception of the matters noted below, the ultimate resolution of these matters will not have a material adverse effect on its consolidated balance sheet or statements of operations or cash flows.

        In some instances, the Company guarantees that a project, when complete, will achieve specified performance standards. If the project subsequently fails to meet guaranteed performance standards, the Company may either incur additional costs or be held responsible for the costs incurred by the client to achieve the required performance standards. At September 30, 2014, the Company was contingently liable in the amount of approximately $313.1 million under standby letters of credit issued primarily in connection with general and professional liability insurance programs and for payment of performance guarantees.

        In the ordinary course of business, the Company enters into various agreements providing financial or performance assurances to clients on behalf of certain unconsolidated partnerships, joint ventures and other jointly executed contracts. These agreements are entered into primarily to support the project execution commitments of these entities. In addition, in connection with the investment activities of AECOM Capital, we provide guarantees of certain obligations, including guarantees for completion of projects, repayment of debt, environmental indemnity obligations and acts of willful misconduct. The guarantees have various expiration dates. The maximum potential payment amount of an outstanding performance guarantee is the remaining cost of work to be performed by or on behalf of third parties. Generally, under joint venture arrangements, if a partner is financially unable to complete its share of the contract, the other partner(s) will be required to complete those activities. The Company generally only enters into joint venture arrangements with partners who are reputable, financially sound and who carry appropriate levels of surety bonds for the project in order to adequately assure completion of their assignments. The Company does not expect that these guarantees will have a material adverse effect on its consolidated balance sheet or statements of operations or cash flows.

    Tishman Inquiry

        The U.S. Attorney's Office for the Eastern District of New York (USAO) has informed the Company's subsidiary Tishman Construction Corporation (TCC) that, in connection with a wage and hour investigation of several New York area contractors, the USAO is investigating potential improper overtime payments to union workers on projects managed by TCC and other contractors in New York dating back to 1999. TCC, which was acquired by the Company in 2010, has cooperated fully with the investigation and, as of this date, no actions have been filed.

    AECOM Australia

        In 2005 and 2006, the Company's main Australian subsidiary, AECOM Australia Pty Ltd (AECOM Australia), performed a traffic forecast assignment for a client consortium as part of the client's project to design, build, finance and operate a tolled motorway tunnel in Australia. To fund the motorway's design and construction, the client formed certain special purpose vehicles (SPVs) that raised approximately $700 million Australian dollars through an initial public offering (IPO) of equity units in 2006 and approximately an additional $1.4 billion Australian dollars in long term bank loans. The SPVs went into insolvency administrations in February 2011.

109


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

20. Commitments and Contingencies (Continued)

        KordaMentha, the receivers for the SPVs (the RCM Applicants), caused a lawsuit to be filed against AECOM Australia by the RCM Applicants in the Federal Court of Australia on May 14, 2012. Portigon AG (formerly WestLB AG), one of the lending banks to the SPVs, filed a lawsuit in the Federal Court of Australia against AECOM Australia on May 18, 2012. Separately, a class action lawsuit, which has been amended to include approximately 770 of the IPO investors, was filed against AECOM Australia in the Federal Court of Australia on May 31, 2012.

        All of the lawsuits claim damages that purportedly resulted from AECOM Australia's role in connection with the above described traffic forecast. The RCM Applicants have claimed damages of approximately $1.68 billion Australian dollars (including interest, as of March 31, 2014). The damages claimed by Portigon as of June 17, 2014 were also recently quantified at approximately $76 million Australian dollars (including interest). The Company believes this claim is duplicative of damages already included in the RCM Applicants' claim to the extent Portigon receives a portion of the RCM Applicants' recovery. The class action applicants claim that they represent investors who acquired approximately $155 million Australian dollars of securities.

        AECOM Australia disputes the claimed entitlements to damages asserted by all applicants and is vigorously defending the claims brought against it. The likely resolution of these matters cannot be reasonably determined at this time. However, if these matters are not resolved in AECOM Australia's favor then, depending upon the outcome, such resolution could have a material adverse effect on the Company's results of operations.

21. Reportable Segments and Geographic Information

        The Company's operations are organized into two reportable segments: Professional Technical Services (PTS) and Management Support Services (MSS). The Company's PTS reportable segment delivers planning, consulting, architectural and engineering design, and program and construction management services to commercial and government clients worldwide. The Company's MSS reportable segment provides program and facilities management and maintenance, training, logistics, consulting, and technical assistance and systems integration services, primarily for agencies of the U.S. government. These reportable segments are organized by the types of services provided, the differing specialized needs of the respective clients, and how the Company manages its business. The Company has aggregated operating segments into its PTS reportable segment based on their similar characteristics, including similar long term financial performance, the nature of services provided, internal processes for delivering those services, and types of customers.

        Management internally analyzes the results of its operations using several non-GAAP measures. A significant portion of the Company's revenues relates to services provided by subcontractors and other non-employees that it categorizes as other direct costs. Other direct costs are segregated from cost of revenues resulting in revenue, net of other direct costs, which is a measure of work performed by Company employees. The Company has included information on revenue, net of other direct costs, as it believes that it is useful to view its revenue exclusive of costs associated with external service providers.

110


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

21. Reportable Segments and Geographic Information (Continued)

        The following tables set forth unaudited summarized financial information concerning the Company's reportable segments:

Reportable Segments:
  Professional
Technical
Services
  Management
Support
Services
  Corporate   Total  
 
  (in millions)
 

Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2014:

                         

Revenue

  $ 7,609.9   $ 746.9   $   $ 8,356.8  

Revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    4,462.7     392.9         4,855.6  

Gross profit

    365.2     38.0         403.2  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    41.4     16.5         57.9  

General and administrative expenses

            (80.9 )   (80.9 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

            (27.3 )   (27.3 )

Operating income (loss)

    406.6     54.5     (108.2 )   352.9  

Segment assets

   
5,366.0
   
392.4
   
365.0
   
6,123.4
 

Gross profit as a % of revenue

    4.8 %   5.1 %         4.8 %

Gross profit as a % of revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    8.2 %   9.7 %         8.3 %

Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2013:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Revenue

  $ 7,242.9   $ 910.6   $   $ 8,153.5  

Revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    4,416.4     560.6         4,977.0  

Gross profit

    416.9     33.1         450.0  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    12.3     12.0         24.3  

General and administrative expenses

            (97.3 )   (97.3 )

Operating income (loss)

    429.2     45.1     (97.3 )   377.0  

Segment assets

   
4,827.5
   
598.0
   
240.1
   
5,665.6
 

Gross profit as a % of revenue

    5.8 %   3.6 %         5.5 %

Gross profit as a % of revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    9.4 %   5.9 %         9.0 %

Fiscal Year Ended September 30, 2012:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Revenue

  $ 7,276.9   $ 941.3   $   $ 8,218.2  

Revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    4,607.3     576.6         5,183.9  

Gross profit

    423.8     (1.9 )       421.9  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    16.8     31.8         48.6  

General and administrative expenses

            (80.9 )   (80.9 )

Goodwill impairment

    (155.0 )   (181.0 )       (336.0 )

Operating income (loss)

    285.6     (151.1 )   (80.9 )   53.6  

Gross profit as a % of revenue

   
5.8

%
 
(0.2

)%
       
5.1

%

Gross profit as a % of revenue, net of other direct costs(1)

    9.2 %   (0.3 )%         8.1 %

(1)
Non-GAAP measure.

111


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

21. Reportable Segments and Geographic Information (Continued)

Geographic Information:

 
  Fiscal Year Ended  
 
  September 30, 2014   September 30, 2013   September 30, 2012  
 
  Revenue   Long-Lived
Assets
  Revenue   Long-Lived
Assets
  Revenue   Long-Lived
Assets
 
 
  (in millions)
 

United States

  $ 4,933.7     1,603.7   $ 4,829.6     1,477.3   $ 4,756.0     1,496.8  

Asia Pacific

    1,338.2     340.5     1,507.2     361.0     1,715.1     374.9  

Canada

    561.1     146.7     712.0     168.4     708.8     189.2  

Europe

    788.2     270.8     599.4     267.2     608.2     243.6  

Other foreign countries

    735.6     209.5     505.3     116.6     430.1     85.8  
                           

Total

  $ 8,356.8     2,571.2   $ 8,153.5     2,390.5   $ 8,218.2     2,390.3  
                           
                           

        The Company attributes revenue by geography based on the external customer's country of origin. Long-lived assets consist of noncurrent assets excluding deferred tax assets.

22. Major Clients

        Other than the U.S. federal government, no single client accounted for 10% or more of the Company's revenue in any of the past five fiscal years. Approximately 15%, 18% and 18% of the Company's revenue was derived through direct contracts with agencies of the U.S. federal government in the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively. One of these contracts accounted for approximately 3%, 4% and 4% of the Company's revenue in the years ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012, respectively.

112


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

23. Quarterly Financial Information—Unaudited

        In the opinion of management, the following unaudited quarterly data reflects all adjustments necessary for a fair statement of the results of operations. All such adjustments are of a normal recurring nature.

Fiscal Year 2014:
  First
Quarter
  Second
Quarter
  Third
Quarter
  Fourth
Quarter
 
 
  (in millions, except per share data)
 

Revenue

  $ 1,953.9   $ 1,872.2   $ 1,968.2   $ 2,562.5  

Cost of revenue

    1,875.7     1,784.8     1,859.7     2,433.4  
                   

Gross profit

    78.2     87.4     108.5     129.1  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    36.1     7.4     6.0     8.4  

General and administrative expenses

    (23.9 )   (26.4 )   (15.1 )   (15.5 )

Acquisition and integration expenses

            (7.8 )   (19.5 )
                   

Income from operations

    90.4     68.4     91.6     102.5  

Other income (expenses)

        (0.2 )   1.0     1.9  

Interest expense

    (10.4 )   (10.5 )   (9.8 )   (10.1 )
                   

Income before income tax expense

    80.0     57.7     82.8     94.3  

Income tax expense

    23.5     15.2     13.7     29.6  
                   

Net income

    56.5     42.5     69.1     64.7  

Noncontrolling interest in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (0.1 )   (2.3 )   0.1     (0.6 )
                   

Net income attributable to AECOM

  $ 56.4   $ 40.2   $ 69.2   $ 64.1  
                   
                   

Net income attributable to AECOM per share:

                         

Basic

  $ 0.59   $ 0.41   $ 0.71   $ 0.65  

Diluted

  $ 0.58   $ 0.41   $ 0.70   $ 0.64  

Weighted average common shares outstanding:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Basic

    96.3     97.0     97.5     98.1  

Diluted

    97.6     98.3     99.0     99.7  

113


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

23. Quarterly Financial Information—Unaudited (Continued)

Fiscal Year 2013:
  First
Quarter
  Second
Quarter
  Third
Quarter
  Fourth
Quarter
 
 
  (in millions, except per share data)
 

Revenue

  $ 2,017.3   $ 1,989.6   $ 2,067.5   $ 2,079.1  

Cost of revenue

    1,939.2     1,889.7     1,935.7     1,938.9  
                   

Gross profit

    78.1     99.9     131.8     140.2  

Equity in earnings of joint ventures

    5.9     7.9     4.1     6.4  

General and administrative expenses

    (22.1 )   (27.3 )   (24.0 )   (23.9 )
                   

Income from operations

    61.9     80.5     111.9     122.7  

Other income

    0.7     0.1     1.2     1.5  

Interest expense

    (10.9 )   (11.9 )   (11.7 )   (10.2 )
                   

Income before income tax expense

    51.7     68.7     101.4     114.0  

Income tax expense

    12.7     14.0     30.1     35.8  
                   

Net income

    39.0     54.7     71.3     78.2  

Noncontrolling interest in income of consolidated subsidiaries, net of tax

    (0.9 )   (0.9 )   (0.5 )   (1.7 )
                   

Net income attributable to AECOM

  $ 38.1   $ 53.8   $ 70.8   $ 76.5  
                   
                   

Net income attributable to AECOM per share:

                         

Basic

  $ 0.36   $ 0.54   $ 0.71   $ 0.78  

Diluted

  $ 0.36   $ 0.53   $ 0.70   $ 0.77  

Weighted average common shares outstanding:

   
 
   
 
   
 
   
 
 

Basic

    104.8     100.4     99.3     98.0  

Diluted

    105.5     101.8     100.8     99.7  

24. Subsequent Events

    Acquisition of URS Corporation

        On October 17, 2014, the Company completed the acquisition of the U.S. headquartered URS Corporation (URS), a leading international provider of engineering, construction, and technical services, by purchasing 100% of the outstanding shares of URS common stock. The Company paid a total consideration of approximately $2.3 billion in cash and issued approximately $1.6 billion of AECOM common stock to the former stockholders and certain equity award holders of URS. In connection with the acquisition, the Company also assumed URS's senior notes totaling $1.0 billion, and subsequently repaid in full URS's $0.6 billion 2011 term loan and URS's $0.1 billion revolving line of credit. Upon the occurrence of a change in control of URS, the URS senior noteholders had a right to redeem their notes at a cash price equal to 101% of the principal amount of the notes. The acquisition of URS was considered a change in control of URS and, as a result on October 24, 2014, the Company purchased $0.6 billion of URS's senior notes from the noteholders.

    Senior Unsecured Notes

        On October 6, 2014, the Company completed a private placement offering of $800,000,000 aggregate principal amount of its 5.750% Senior Notes due 2022 (the 2022 Notes) and $800,000,000 aggregate

114


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

24. Subsequent Events (Continued)

principal amount of its 5.875% Senior Notes due 2024 (the 2024 Notes and, together with the 2022 Notes, the Notes).

        At any time prior to October 15, 2017, the Company may redeem all or part of the 2022 Notes, at a redemption price equal to 100% of their principal amount, plus a "make whole" premium as of the redemption date, and accrued and unpaid interest (subject to the rights of holders of record on the relevant record date to receive interest due on the relevant interest payment date). In addition, at any time prior to October 15, 2017, the Company may redeem up to 35% of the original aggregate principal amount of the 2022 Notes with the proceeds of one or more equity offerings, at a redemption price equal to 105.750%, plus accrued and unpaid interest. Furthermore, at any time on or after October 15, 2017, the Company may redeem the 2022 Notes, in whole or in part, at once or over time, at the specified redemption prices plus accrued and unpaid interest thereon to the redemption date. At any time prior to July 15, 2024, the Company may redeem on one or more occasions all or part of the 2024 Notes at a redemption price equal to the sum of (i) 100% of the principal amount thereof, plus (ii) a "make-whole" premium as of the date of the redemption, plus any accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption. In addition, on or after July 15, 2024, the 2024 Notes may be redeemed by the Company at a redemption price of 100% of the principal amount thereof, plus accrued and unpaid interest to the date of redemption.

        The indenture contains customary events of default, including, among other things, payment default, exchange default, failure to provide certain notices thereunder and certain provisions related to bankruptcy events. The indenture also contains customary negative covenants.

        In connection with the offering of the Notes, the Company and the guarantors entered into a Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of October 6, 2014 and agreed to use commercially reasonable efforts to (i) file with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (SEC) a registration statement relating to the registered exchange offer (the Exchange Offer) to exchange the Notes for a new series of the Company's exchange notes having terms substantially identical in all material respects to, and in the same aggregate principal amount as the Notes, (ii) cause the Exchange Offer registration statement to be declared effective by the SEC on or prior to the 390th day following October 6, 2014 (or if such 390th day is not a business day, the next succeeding business day (the Exchange Date)), (iii) cause the Exchange Offer registration statement to be effective continuously and keep the exchange offer open for a period not less than 30 days after the date notice of the exchange offer is mailed to the holders of the Notes and (iv) cause the Exchange Offer to be consummated in no event later than the Exchange Date.

        Under certain circumstances, the Company and the guarantors have agreed to use their commercially reasonable efforts to (i) file a shelf registration statement relating to the resale of the Notes on or prior to the Exchange Date (such date being the Shelf Filing Deadline), (ii) cause the shelf registration statement to be declared effective not later than the 60th day after the Shelf Filing Deadline (or if such 60th day is not a business day, the next succeeding business day) and (iii) keep such shelf registration continuously effective until two years after its effective date (or such shorter period that will terminate when all the Notes covered thereby have been sold pursuant thereto).

        If the Company fails to meet any of these targets, the annual interest rate on the Notes will increase by 0.25%, and will increase by an additional 0.25% for each subsequent 90-day period during which the default continues, up to a maximum additional interest rate of 1.0% per year. If the Company cures the default, the interest rate on the Notes will revert to the original level.

115


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

24. Subsequent Events (Continued)

    Credit Agreement; Security Agreement

        In connection with the acquisition of URS, on October 17, 2014, the Company entered into a new credit agreement (the Credit Agreement). The Credit Agreement consists of (i) a term loan A facility in an aggregate principal amount of $1.925 billion, (ii) a term loan B facility in an aggregate principal amount of $0.76 billion, (iii) a revolving credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of $1.05 billion, and (iv) an incremental performance letter of credit facility in an aggregate principal amount of $500 million. These facilities under the Credit Agreement may be increased by an additional amount of up to $500 million.

        Pursuant to the Credit Agreement, certain subsidiaries of the Company (the Guarantors) have guaranteed the obligations of the borrowers under the Credit Agreement. The borrowers' obligations under the Credit Agreement are secured by a lien on substantially all of the assets of the Company and the Guarantors pursuant to a security and pledge agreement (the Security Agreement). The collateral under the Security Agreement is subject to release upon fulfillment of certain conditions specified in the Credit Agreement and Security Agreement.

        The Credit Agreement and related loan documents contain covenants that limit the ability of the Company and certain of its subsidiaries to, among other things:

    create, incur, assume, or suffer to exist liens;

    incur or guarantee indebtedness;

    pay dividends or repurchase stock;

    enter into transactions with affiliates;

    consummate asset sales, acquisitions or mergers;

    enter into certain type of burdensome agreements; or

    make investments.

        The Credit Agreement also requires compliance with certain financial covenants, including a maximum consolidated leverage ratio and a minimum consolidated interest coverage ratio, in each case calculated as set forth in the Credit Agreement.

        The Credit Agreement contains customary events of default, including:

    a change of control;

    failure to make required payments;

    failure to comply with certain agreements or covenants;

    failure to pay, or acceleration of, certain other indebtedness;

    certain events of bankruptcy and insolvency; and

    failure to pay certain judgments.

        The Credit Agreement replaced (i) the Company's Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of June 7, 2013, and (ii) the Company's Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of January 29, 2014, which such prior facilities were terminated and repaid in full on October 17, 2014 in connection with the entry into the Credit Agreement.

116


Table of Contents


AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)

24. Subsequent Events (Continued)

        In connection with the consummation of the URS acquisition on October 17, 2014, AECOM also prepaid in full $300 million face value (plus accrued interest as well as a prepayment penalty of $56 million) of its 5.43% Series A notes due July 2020 and 1.00% Senior Discount Notes, Series B, due July 2022. Borrowings under the Credit Agreement were used to prepay the Senior Notes.

    URS Senior Notes

        The URS senior notes are general unsecured senior obligations of AECOM Global II, LLC (as successor in interest to URS) and URS Fox US LP and are fully and unconditionally guaranteed on a joint-and-several basis by certain former URS domestic subsidiary guarantors.

117


Table of Contents


AECOM Technology Corporation

Schedule II: Valuation and Qualifying Accounts

(amounts in millions)

 
  Balance at
Beginning
of Year
  Additions
Charged to Cost
of Revenue
  Deductions(a)   Other and
Foreign
Exchange Impact
  Balance at
the End of
the Year
 

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

                               

Fiscal Year 2014

 
$

86.4
 
$

17.3
 
$

(38.4

)

$

6.8
 
$

72.1
 

Fiscal Year 2013

    112.8     18.3     (45.5 )   0.8     86.4  

Fiscal Year 2012

    120.2     28.7     (37.7 )   1.6     112.8  

(a)
Primarily relates to accounts written-off and recoveries

118


Table of Contents

ITEM 9.    CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

        None.

ITEM 9A.    CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures

        Our management, with the participation of our CEO and CFO, are responsible for establishing and maintaining "disclosure controls and procedures" (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Exchange Act) for our company. Based on their evaluation as of the end of the period covered by this report, our CEO and CFO have concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective to ensure that the information required to be disclosed by us in this Annual Report on Form 10-K was (i) recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC's rules and (ii) accumulated and communicated to our management, including our principal executive and principal financial officers, to allow timely decisions regarding required disclosures.

Management's Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

        Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Internal control over financial reporting is defined in Rule 13a-15(f) or 15d-15(f) promulgated under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, as a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company's principal executive and principal financial officers and effected by the company's board of directors, management and other personnel, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that in reasonable detail accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company's assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

        Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

        Our management, with the participation of our CEO and CFO, assessed the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of September 30, 2014, the end of our fiscal year. Our management based its assessment on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (1992 framework). Our management's assessment included evaluation and testing of the design and operating effectiveness of key financial reporting controls, process documentation, accounting policies, and our overall control environment.

        Based on our management's assessment, our management has concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective as of September 30, 2014. Our management communicated the results of its assessment to the Audit Committee of our Board of Directors.

        Our independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young LLP, audited our financial statements for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2014 included in this Annual Report on Form 10-K, and

119


Table of Contents

has issued an audit report on our assessment of the Company's internal control over financial reporting, a copy of which is included earlier in this Annual Report on Form 10-K.

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

        Our management, including our CEO and CFO, confirm that there were no changes in our company's internal control over financial reporting during the fiscal quarter ended September 30, 2014 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, our company's internal control over financial reporting.

ITEM 9B.    OTHER INFORMATION

        None.


PART III

ITEM 10.    DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

        Incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of our fiscal 2014 year end.

ITEM 11.    EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

        Incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of our fiscal 2014 year end.

ITEM 12.    SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT AND RELATED STOCKHOLDERS MATTERS

        Other than with respect to the information relating to our equity compensation plans, which is incorporated herein by reference to Part II, Item 5, "Equity Compensation Plans" of this Form 10-K, the information required by this item is incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of our fiscal 2014 year end.

ITEM 13.    CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS, AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

        Incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of our fiscal 2014 year end.

ITEM 14.    PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTING FEES AND SERVICES

        Incorporated by reference from our definitive proxy statement for the 2015 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of our fiscal 2014 year end.

120


Table of Contents


PART IV

ITEM 15.    EXHIBITS, FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

    (a)
    Documents filed as part of this report:

    (1)
    The company's Consolidated Financial Statements at September 30, 2014 and 2013 and for each of the three years in the period ended September 30, 2014 and the notes thereto, together with the report of the independent auditors on those Consolidated Financial Statements are hereby filed as part of this report.

    (2)
    Financial Statement Schedule II—Valuation and Qualifying Accounts for the Years Ended September 30, 2014, 2013 and 2012.

    (3)
    See Exhibits and Index to Exhibits, below.

    (b)
    Exhibits.

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  2.1   Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of July 11, 2014, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, ACM Mountain I, LLC, AECOM Global II, LLC (formerly ACM Mountain II, LLC) and URS Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 14, 2014)

 

3.1

 

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of AECOM Technology Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company's annual report on Form 10-K filed with the SEC on November 18, 2011)

 

3.2

 

Certificate of Amendment to Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of AECOM Technology Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Company's registration statement on Form S-4 filed with the SEC on August 1, 2014)

 

3.3

 

Certificate of Correction of Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of AECOM Technology Corporation

 

3.4

 

Certificate of Designations for Class C Preferred Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

3.5

 

Certificate of Designations for Class E Preferred Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.3 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

3.6

 

Certificate of Designations for Class F Convertible Preferred Stock, Series 1 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.4 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

3.7

 

Certificate of Designations for Class G Convertible Preferred Stock, Series 1 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.5 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

3.8

 

Amended and Restated Bylaws (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 2, 2009)

 

4.1

 

Form of Common Stock Certificate (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

121


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  4.2   Indenture, dated as of October 6, 2014, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, the Guarantors party thereto, and U.S. Bank, National Association, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 8, 2014)

 

4.3

 

Indenture, dated March 15, 2012, between URS Corporation, URS Fox U.S. LP and U.S. Bank National Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.01 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 20, 2012)

 

4.4

 

First Supplemental Indenture, dated March 15, 2012, by and among URS Corporation, URS Fox U.S. LP, the additional guarantor parties thereto and U.S. Bank National Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.02 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 20, 2012)

 

4.5

 

Second Supplemental Indenture, dated March 15, 2012, by and among URS Corporation, URS Fox U.S. LP, the additional guarantor parties thereto and U.S. Bank National Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.03 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 20, 2012)

 

4.6

 

Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of May 14, 2012, by and among URS Corporation, URS Fox U.S. LP, the additional guarantor parties thereto and U.S. Bank National Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on May 18, 2012)

 

4.7

 

Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of September 24, 2012, by and among URS Corporation, URS Fox U.S. LP, the additional guarantor parties thereto and U.S. Bank National Association (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 26, 2012)

 

4.8

 

Fifth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of October 17, 2014, by and among AECOM Global II, LLC, URS Fox U.S. LP and U.S. Bank National Association

 

4.9

 

Registration Rights Agreement, dated October 6, 2014, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, AECOM Government Services, Inc., AECOM Technical Services, Inc., Tishman Construction Corporation, other Guarantors, and Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 8, 2014)

 

4.10

 

First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of October 17, 2014, by and among the guarantors thereto and U.S. Bank National Association

 

10.1

 

Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of July 20, 2011, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent and a lender, and the lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 26, 2011)

 

10.2

 

Second Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of June 7, 2013, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent and a lender, and the lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K with the SEC on June 13, 2013)

122


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  10.3   Fourth Amendment to Third Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of June 7, 2013, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, the subsidiaries party thereto, Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent and a lender, and the lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8- K with the SEC on June 13, 2013)

 

10.4

#

AECOM Technology Corporation Stock Purchase Plan, restated as of October 1, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.5

#

Amendment 2006-1, dated as of October 1, 2006, to AECOM Technology Corporation Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.6

#

1992 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, restated as of November 20, 1997 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.7

#

First Amendment, effective July 1, 1998, to the 1992 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.8

#

Second Amendment, effective March 1, 2003, to the 1992 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.9

#

Third Amendment, effective April 1, 2004, to the 1992 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.10

#

1996 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan, restated as of November 20, 1997 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.11

#

First Amendment, effective July 1, 1998, to the 1996 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.12

#

Second Amendment, effective April 1, 2004, to the 1996 Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.13

#

1998 Management Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.14

#

First Amendment, effective January 1, 2002, to the 1998 Management Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.15

#

Second Amendment, effective July 1, 1998, to the 1998 Management Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

123


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  10.16 # Third Amendment, effective October 31, 2004, to the 1998 Management Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.17

#

1996 Excess Benefit Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to the Company's registration statement on Form 1 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.18

#

First Amendment, effective July 1, 1998, to the 1996 Excess Benefit Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.19

#

Second Amendment, effective March 1, 2003, to the 1996 Excess Benefit Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.20

#

Third Amendment, effective April 1, 2004, to the 1996 Excess Benefit Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.21

#

2005 ENSR Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.22

#

2005 UMA Group Ltd. Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.23

#

2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.24

#

Cansult Merger Investment Plan, dated September 11, 2006 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.25

#

AECOM Technology Corporation Equity Investment Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.26

#

Global Stock Investment Plan—United Kingdom (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.27

#

Hong Kong Stock Investment Plan—Grandfathered Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.28

#

AECOM Retirement & Savings Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.35 to the Company's registration statement on Form 10 filed with the SEC on January 29, 2007)

 

10.29

#

Change in Control Severance Policy for Key Executives (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 11, 2009)

 

10.30

#

Standard Terms and Conditions for Non-Qualified Stock Options under AECOM Technology Corporation 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on December 5, 2008)

124


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  10.31 # Standard Terms and Conditions for Restricted Stock Units under AECOM Technology Corporation 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on December 5, 2008)

 

10.32

#

Standard Terms and Conditions for Performance Earnings Program under AECOM Technology Corporation 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on December 5, 2008)

 

10.33

#

Employment Agreement, dated as of July 14, 2010, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, Tishman Construction Corporation and Daniel R. Tishman (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 14, 2010)

 

10.34

 

Note Purchase Agreement, dated June 28, 2010, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation and the Purchasers identified therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on July 1, 2010)

 

10.35

#

AECOM Technology Corporation Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the Company's registration statement on Form S-8 filed with the SEC on May 24, 2010)

 

10.36

#

Consulting Agreement, dated as of February 8, 2011, between Francis S. Y. Bong and AECOM Technology Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on February 14, 2011)

 

10.37

#

Consulting Agreement, dated as of April 21, 2011, between Richard G. Newman and AECOM Technology Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on April 25, 2011)

 

10.38

#

Consulting Agreement, dated as of May 4, 2012, between Richard G. Newman and AECOM Technology Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Company's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on May 5, 2012)

 

10.39

#

Consulting Agreement Renewal Letter, dated as of May 7, 2013, between Richard G. Newman and AECOM Technology Corporation (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on May 8, 2013)

 

10.40

#

Amended and Restated 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Annex B to the Company's definitive proxy statement on Schedule 14A filed with the SEC on January 21, 2011)

 

10.41

#

Amended Stock Option Standard Terms and Conditions under 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on May 4, 2012)

 

10.42

#

Form of New and Amended Restricted Stock Unit Standard Terms and Conditions under the 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on December 21, 2012)

 

10.43

#

URS Corporation Restated Incentive Compensation Plan 2014 Plan Year Summary (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on May 13, 2014)

125


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  10.44 # URS Corporation Restated Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 31, 2009)

 

10.45

#

URS Federal Services, Inc. Restated Employees Retirement Plan

 

10.46

#

Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of September 8, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to URS's annual report on Form 10-K filed with the SEC on January 18, 2001)

 

10.47

#

First Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of August 11, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to URS's annual report on Form 10-K filed with the SEC on January 22, 2004)

 

10.48

#

Second Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of August 20, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to URS's annual report on Form 10-K filed with the SEC on January 13, 2005)

 

10.49

#

Fourth Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of November 15, 2005 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 18, 2005)

 

10.50

#

Fifth Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of August 1, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 6, 2008)

 

10.51

#

Sixth Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of November 26, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to URS's annual report on Form 10-K filed with the SEC on February 26, 2013)

 

10.52

#

Seventh Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Corporation and Joseph Masters, dated as of June 30, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 12, 2014)

 

10.53

#

Employment Agreement between EG&G Technical Services, Inc. and Randall A. Wotring, dated as of November 19, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on November 24, 2004)

 

10.54

#

First Amendment to Employment Agreement between EG&G Technical Services, Inc. and Randall A. Wotring, dated as of August 1, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 6, 2008)

 

10.55

#

Second Amendment to Employment Agreement between EG&G Technical Services, Inc. and Randall A. Wotring, dated as of November 27, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 to URS's annual report on Form 10-K filed with the SEC on February 26, 2013)

 

10.56

#

Third Amendment to Employment Agreement between URS Federal Services, Inc. and Randall A. Wotring, dated as of June 30, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.3 to URS's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on June 30, 2014)

 

10.57

#

Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between URS E&C Holdings and George L. Nash, Jr., dated as of March 27, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on May 13, 2014)

126


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  10.58 # First Amendment to Amended and Restated Employment Agreement between URS E&C Holdings, Inc. and George L. Nash, Jr. dated as of June 30, 2014 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on August 12, 2014)

 

10.59

#

Form of Officer Indemnification Agreement between URS Corporation and each of Joseph Masters, George L. Nash, and Randall A. Wotring (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on June 14, 2004)

 

10.60

#

Form of Director Indemnification Agreement between URS Corporation and each of Senator William H. Frist and Douglas W. Stotlar (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to URS's quarterly report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on June 14, 2004)

 

10.61

#

Letter Agreement, dated as of March 6, 2014, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation and Michael S. Burke (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 12, 2014)

 

10.62

#

URS Corporation 2008 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Company's registration statement on Form S-8 filed with the SEC on October 17, 2014)

 

10.63

#

Form of Special LTI Award Stock Option Terms and Conditions under the 2006 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 29, 2014)

 

10.64

 

Fourth Amended and Restated Credit Agreement, dated as of January 29, 2014, by and among AECOM Technology Corporation, certain Subsidiaries of AECOM Technology Corporation party thereto, Bank of America, N.A., as administrative agent and a lender, and the lenders party thereto (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 29, 2014)

 

10.65

 

Credit Agreement, dated as of October 17, 2014, among AECOM Technology Corporation and certain of its subsidiaries, as borrowers, certain lenders, Bank of America, N.A., as Administrative Agent, Swing Line Lender and L/C Issuer, MUFG Union Bank, N.A., BNP Paribas, JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., and the Bank of Nova Scotia, as Co-Syndication Agents, and BBVA Compass, Credit Agricole Corporate and Investment Bank, HSBC Bank USA, National Association, Sumitomo Mitsui Banking Corporation and Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as Co-Documentation Agents (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of the Company's current report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 17, 2014)

 

21.1

 

Subsidiaries of AECOM

 

23.1

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

31.1

 

Certification of the Company's Chief Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

31.2

 

Certification of the Company's Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

32

 

Certification of the Company's Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

127


Table of Contents

Exhibit
Numbers
  Description
  101.INS   XBRL Instance Document

 

101.SCH

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema

 

101.CAL

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase

 

101.LAB

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Labels Linkbase

 

101.PRE

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase

 

101.DEF

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase

#
Management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

128


Table of Contents


SIGNATURE

        Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

    AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

 

 

By:

 

/s/ MICHAEL S. BURKE

Michael S. Burke
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)

 

 

Date:

 

November 17, 2014

        Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant in the capacities and on the date indicated.

 
Signature
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 

 
  /s/ MICHAEL S. BURKE

Michael S. Burke
  Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer)   November 17, 2014

 

/s/ STEPHEN M. KADENACY

Stephen M. Kadenacy

 

President and Chief Financial Officer (Principal Financial Officer)

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ RONALD E. OSBORNE

Ronald E. Osborne

 

Senior Vice President, Corporate Controller (Principal Accounting Officer)

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ JOHN M. DIONISIO

John M. Dionisio

 

Executive Chairman

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ RICHARD G. NEWMAN

Richard G. Newman

 

Director, Chairman Emeritus

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ JAMES H. FORDYCE

James H. Fordyce

 

Director

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ LINDA GRIEGO

Linda Griego

 

Director

 

November 17, 2014

129


Table of Contents

 
Signature
 
Title
 
Date

 

 

 

 

 

 
  /s/ DAVID W. JOOS

David W. Joos
  Director   November 17, 2014

 

/s/ WILLIAM G. OUCHI

William G. Ouchi

 

Director

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ ROBERT J. ROUTS

Robert J. Routs

 

Director

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ WILLIAM P. RUTLEDGE

William P. Rutledge

 

Director

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ CLARENCE T. SCHMITZ

Clarence T. Schmitz

 

Director

 

November 17, 2014

 

/s/ DANIEL R. TISHMAN

Daniel R. Tishman

 

Director, AECOM Vice Chairman

 

November 17, 2014

130




Exhibit 3.3

 

CERTIFICATE OF CORRECTION OF

 AMENDED AND RESTATED CERIFICATE OF INCORPORATION OF

AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

 

AECOM Technology Corporation, a corporation organized and existing under the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware (the “Company”), in accordance with the provisions of Section 103 thereof, DOES HEREBY CERTIFY:

 

1.                                       The name of the Company is AECOM Technology Corporation.

 

2.                                       An Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of the Company (the “Certificate of Incorporation”) was filed with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware on June 15, 2011 and said Certificate of Incorporation requires correction as permitted by subsection (f) of Section 103 of the General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware.

 

3.                                       The inaccuracy or defect of said Certificate of Incorporation to be corrected is that it inadvertently omitted the Certificate of Designation, Preferences, Rights and Limitations of Series E Preferred Stock of the Company which was filed with the Secretary of State on September 7, 2004.

 

4.                                       The Certificate of Incorporation is corrected by inserting as a new Article FOURTH, Section 4, the following:

 

“4.       Pursuant to the authority conferred upon the Board of Directors of the Company by this Article FOURTH, the Board of Directors created a series of 20 shares of Preferred Stock designated as Series E Preferred Stock (the “Series E Preferred Stock”) by filing a Certificate of Designation of the Company with the Secretary of State of the State of Delaware on September 7, 2004, and the voting powers, designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional and other rights, and qualifications, limitations or restrictions of the Series E Preferred Stock are set forth in Appendix A hereto and are incorporated herein by reference.”

 

5.                                       The Certificate of Incorporation is further corrected by attaching Appendix A hereto as Appendix A to the Certificate of Incorporation.

 

6.                                       All other provisions of the Certificate of Incorporation remain unchanged.

 

1



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Company has caused this Certificate of Correction to be executed as of the 12th day of November, 2014.

 

 

 

AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ DAVID Y. GAN

 

Name:

David Y. Gan

 

Title:

Senior Vice President and Assistant General Counsel

 

AECOM Technology Corporation Certificate of Correction

 



 

APPENDIX A

 

CLASS E PREFERRED STOCK . There is hereby established a series of Preferred Stock designated Class E Preferred Stock (the “Class E Stock”) which will consist of the number of shares and have the following powers, preferences, rights, qualifications, limitations and restrictions:

 

(1)                         Number of Shares . The number of shares of Class E Stock shall be 20. The Corporation is authorized to issue fractional shares.

 

(2)                         Limitation as to Ownership . The shares of Class E Stock may only be issued to and held by the Trustee of the AECOM Technology Corporation Supplemental Trust.

 

(3)                          Voting Rights . Subject to the provisions of Article FIFTH of the Certificate of Incorporation and except as otherwise provided in this Certificate of Designation and General Corporation Law of the State of Delaware, the holders of the Class E Stock shall not be entitled to vote on any matters to be voted on by the Corporation’s stockholders except that the holders of Class E Stock shall be entitled to vote on any matters that are (i) submitted to the holders of the Corporation’s common stock and (ii) which involve:

 

(a)                   any voluntary liquidation, dissolution or other winding up of the affairs of the Corporation (in connection with the bankruptcy or insolvency of the Corporation or otherwise);

 

(b)                   the direct or indirect sale, transfer, conveyance or other disposition, in one of a series of related transactions, of all or substantially all of the properties or assets of the Corporation and its Subsidiaries, taken as a whole, to any “person” (as that terms is used in Section 13(d)(3) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, (the “Exchange Act”)) other than the Corporation or a wholly owned Subsidiary of the Corporation;

 

(c)                    the consummation of any transaction or series of related transactions (including, without limitation, any merger or consolidation) involving the Corporation the result of which is that any “person” (as defined above) becomes the Beneficial Owner (as defined below), directly or indirectly, of more than fifty percent (50)% of the Voting Stock of the Corporation, measured by voting power rather than number of shares, except for U.S. Trust Company N.A., as trustee of the Corporation’s U.S. Retirement and Savings Plan, Mourant & Co. Trustees Limited, as trustee of the Corporation’s stock or stock option plans in respect of employees based outside of the United States, and any successors, replacements or assigns of such trustees, and any other trustees under the Stock Plans (as defined below). Beneficial Owner has the meaning assigned to such term in Rule 13d-3 and Rule 13d-5 under the Exchange Act, except that in calculating the beneficial ownership of any particular “person”, such “person” shall be deemed to have beneficial ownership of all securities that such “person” has the right to acquire by conversion or exercise of other securities, whether such right is currently exercisable or is exercisable only

 

1



 

upon the occurrence of a subsequent condition. Stock Plans mean all stock, stock unit, stock purchase/loan and option plans and stock repurchase programs of the Corporation for the benefit of past, present and future employees, directors and consultants of the Corporation (as such) and approved by the Board of Directors; or

 

(d)                   the initial public offering of the Corporation’s common stock made pursuant to the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, on Form S-1 or Form S-3 (as defined in the Securities Act of 1933, as amended) or any successor forms, and following which the Common Stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange or quoted on The Nasdaq National Market.

 

The holders of Class E common stock shall be entitled to 100,000 votes per share on all matters to be voted on by the holders of Class E Stock pursuant to this Section (3). Except as otherwise provided by law, the Certificate of Incorporation or herein, the holders of Class E Stock and Common Stock shall vote together as one class on all such matters set forth in this Section (3), along with the holders of any other series of Preferred Stock having the right to vote on the matters set forth in this Section (3).

 

(4)                      Dividends . The holders of Class E Stock shares shall not be entitled to receive any dividends.

 

(5)                      Liquidation Preference . In the event of a voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the Corporation, the holders of the Class E Stock shall be entitled to receive, out of the assets of the Corporation legally available therefor, an amount equal to $1.00 per share of Class E Stock (the “Liquidation Preference”), and no more, before any payment shall be made or any assets distributed to holders of any class of Common Stock. If upon such liquidation, dissolution or winding up, the available assets of the Corporation for distribution to the holders of capital stock shall be insufficient to permit the payment to such holders of Class E Stock of the full preferential amount as set forth in this Section (5), then the entire remaining assets of the Corporation available to be distributed to the holders of the capital stock shall be distributed ratably among the holders of the Class E Stock and any other shares of Preferred Stock ranking on a parity with the Class E Stock as to the distribution of assets upon such liquidation, dissolution or winding up, provided that the holders of Class E Stock shall not receive any assets pursuant to this Section (5) unless the holders of the Corporation’s Class D Convertible Preferred Stock have been paid their respective preferential amount in full. A consolidation or merger of the Corporation with or into any other corporation or corporations, or a sale of all or substantially all of the assets of the Corporation, shall not be deemed to be a liquidation, dissolution or winding up within the meaning of this Section.

 

(6)                      Redemption at the Option of the Corporation . The Corporation may at any time redeem the whole or any portion of the outstanding shares of Class E Stock by paying therefor in cash an amount per share equal to the Liquidation Preference of a share of Class E Stock (the “Redemption Price”). At least 10 but not more than 60 days prior to the date fixed for redemption (the “Redemption Date”), the Corporation shall mail, postage prepaid, to the holders of record of the shares of Class E Stock at the address of each such holder as it appears on the books of the Corporation, a notice (the “Class E Stock Notice”) specifying

 

2



 

the Redemption Date and the number of shares held by such holder to be redeemed. On and after the Redemption Date, each holder of shares of Class E Stock shall surrender to the Corporation the certificate or certificates evidencing such shares at the principal executive offices of the Corporation and shall thereupon be paid in cash an amount equal to the number of shares of Class E Stock surrendered multiplied by the Redemption Price. If the Class E Stock Notice shall have been given as provided herein and if on the Redemption Date funds necessary for the redemption shall be available therefor, then on and after the Redemption Date the certificate or certificates representing the shares of Class E Stock shall represent solely the right to receive the Redemption Price.

 

(7)                      Conversion . The holders of Class E Stock shall have no conversion rights whatsoever.

 

(8)                      Status of Redeemed or Repurchased Shares . All shares of Class E Stock redeemed or repurchased by the Corporation shall be restored to the status of authorized but unissued shares of Preferred Stock, without designation as to series.

 

(9)                      No Sinking Fund . The shares of Class E Stock shall not be subject to any sinking fund or other obligation on the part of the Corporation to redeem or repurchase.

 

3




Exhibit 4.8

 

FIFTH SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE

THIS FIFTH SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE (this “ Supplemental Indenture ”), effective as of October 17, 2014, among AECOM Global II, LLC (“ AECOM Global ”), a Delaware limited liability company, URS FOX US LP, a Delaware limited partnership (“ Fox ”, and together with AECOM Global, the “ Issuers ” for all purposes of the Indenture and the Notes), and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee (the “ Trustee ”).  Capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined herein are used as defined in the Indenture referred to below.

 

WITNESSETH

 

WHEREAS, Fox and URS Corporation, a Delaware corporation (“ URS ”), have heretofore executed and delivered to the Trustee that certain Indenture dated as of March 15, 2012 (the “ Base Indenture ”), dated as of March 15, 2012, as supplemented by the First Supplemental Indenture dated as of March 15, 2012 (the “ First Supplement ”), the Second Supplemental Indenture dated as of March 15, 2012 (the “ Second Supplement ”), the Third Supplemental Indenture dated as of May 14, 2012 (the “ Third Supplement ”) and the Fourth Supplemental Indenture dated as of September 24, 2012 (the “ Fourth Supplement ”; together with the Base Indenture, the First Supplement, the Second Supplement and the Third Supplement, the “ Indenture ”), pursuant to which the 3.850% Senior Notes due 2017 (the “ 2017 Notes ”) and the 5.000% Senior Notes due 2022 (the “ 2022 Notes ”; together with the 2017 Notes, the “ Notes ”) were issued;

 

WHEREAS, pursuant to that certain Agreement and Plan of Merger dated July 11, 2014 among AECOM Technology Corporation, ACM Mountain I, LLC, AECOM Global (f/k/a ACM Mountain II, LLC) and URS, URS was merged with and into AECOM Global, with AECOM Global as the surviving company (the “ Merger ”);

 

WHEREAS, as a result of the Merger, AECOM Global is required to execute and deliver to the Trustee this Supplemental Indenture pursuant to which AECOM Global expressly assumes the obligations of URS under the Indenture and the Notes;

 

WHEREAS, pursuant to Section 9.1(d) of the Base Indenture, the Issuers and the Trustee are authorized to execute and deliver this Supplemental Indenture without the consent of Holders of the Notes; and

 

WHEREAS, all things necessary to make this Supplemental Indenture a valid indenture and agreement according to its terms have been done.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the parties hereto mutually covenant and agree for the equal and ratable benefit of the Holders of the Notes as follows:

 

1.                                       AMENDMENT.  This Supplemental Indenture is an amendment supplemental to the Indenture, and the Indenture and this Supplemental Indenture will henceforth

 



 

be read together.  Except as otherwise expressly amended hereby, the Indenture is in all respects ratified and confirmed and all the terms, conditions and provisions thereof shall remain in full force and effect.

 

2.                                       ASSUMPTION.  Pursuant to Article IV of the Base Indenture, AECOM Global hereby agrees to become a party to the Indenture as an Issuer and to assume all of the rights and obligations of URS under the Securities and the Indenture, including, but not limited to, the obligation to pay Additional Amounts.

 

3.                                       NEW YORK LAW TO GOVERN.  THE INTERNAL LAW OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK SHALL GOVERN AND BE USED TO CONSTRUE THIS SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE WITHOUT GIVING EFFECT TO APPLICABLE PRINCIPLES OF CONFLICTS OF LAW TO THE EXTENT THAT THE APPLICATION OF THE LAWS OF ANOTHER JURISDICTION WOULD BE REQUIRED THEREBY.

 

4.                                       COUNTERPARTS.  The parties may sign any number of copies of this Supplemental Indenture.  Each signed copy shall be an original, but all of them together represent the same agreement. Delivery of an executed counterpart of a signature page to the Indenture by facsimile, email or other electronic means shall be effective as delivery of a manually executed counterpart of the Indenture.

 

5.                                       EFFECT OF HEADINGS.  The Section headings herein are for convenience only and shall not affect the construction hereof.

 

6.                                       WAIVER OF JURY TRIAL.  EACH OF THE PARTIES HERETO HEREBY IRREVOCABLY WAIVES, TO THE FULLEST EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, ANY AND ALL RIGHT TO TRIAL BY JURY IN ANY LEGAL PROCEEDING ARISING OUT OF OR RELATING TO THIS SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE.

 

7.                                       TRUSTEE NOT RESPONSIBLE FOR RECITALS.  The recitals contained herein shall be taken as statements of the Issuers, and the Trustee does not assume any responsibility for the accuracy of the recitals. The Trustee makes no representations as to the validity or sufficiency of this Supplemental Indenture, except that the Trustee represents that it is duly authorized to execute and deliver this Supplemental Indenture and perform its Obligations hereunder. All rights, protections, privileges, indemnities and benefits granted or afforded to the Trustee under the Indenture shall be deemed incorporated herein by this reference and shall be deemed applicable to all actions taken, suffered or omitted by the Trustee under this Supplemental Indenture.

 

9.                                       NOTICES.  The address of the Issuers and Guarantors in Section 12.2 of the Base Indenture shall be amended as follows:

 

if to the Issuers or any Guarantor:

 

c/o AECOM Technology Corporation

1999 Avenue of the Stars, Suite 2600

 



 

Los Angeles, California 90067

Attention: Troy Rudd

Keenan Driscoll

Telephone: (213) 593-8000

Telecopier: (213) 593-8730

 

[Signature Page Follows]

 



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this Supplemental Indenture to be duly executed and attested, all as of the date first above written.

 

 

AECOM GLOBAL II, LLC

 

By: AECOM Technology Corporation,

 

its Sole Member

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/KEENAN DRISCOLL

 

 

Name:

Keenan Driscoll

 

 

Title:

Assistant Treasurer

 

 

 

URS FOX US LP

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ H. THOMAS HICKS

 

Name:

H. Thomas Hicks

 

Title:

Authorized Representative

 

 

 

U.S. BANK NATIONAL ASSOCIATION,

 

  as Trustee

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ BRADLEY E. SCARBROUGH

 

Name:

Bradley E. Scarbrough

 

Title:

Vice President

 

[Signature page to Fifth Supplemental Indenture]

 




Exhibit 4.10

 

FIRST SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE

 

FIRST SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE (this “ First Supplemental Indenture ”) dated as of October 17, 2014, among the guarantors signatory hereto (the “ New Guarantors ”), each a subsidiary of AECOM Technology Corporation, a Delaware corporation (the “ Company ”) and U.S. Bank National Association, as trustee under the indenture referred to below (the “ Trustee ”).

 

W I T N E S S E T H :

 

WHEREAS the Company and certain subsidiaries of the Company listed in Schedule I attached hereto (the “ Existing Guarantors ”) have heretofore executed and delivered to the Trustee an Indenture, dated as of October 6, 2014 (the “ Indenture ”), providing for the issuance of the Company’s 5.750% Senior Notes due 2022 (the “ 2022 Notes ”) and 5.875% Senior Notes due 2024 (the “ 2024 Notes ” and, together with the 2022 Notes, the “ Notes ”);

 

WHEREAS Section 4.18 of the Indenture provides that under certain circumstances the Company is required to cause the New Guarantors to execute and deliver to the Trustee a supplemental indenture pursuant to which the New Guarantors shall unconditionally guarantee all the Company’s obligations under the Notes pursuant to a Subsidiary Guarantee on the terms and conditions set forth herein; and

 

WHEREAS pursuant to Section 9.01(a)(7) of the Indenture, the Trustee and the Company are authorized to execute and deliver this First Supplemental Indenture without the consent of holders of the Notes;

 

NOW THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is hereby acknowledged, the New Guarantors, the Company and the Trustee mutually covenant and agree for the equal and ratable benefit of the holders of the Notes as follows:

 

1.                                       AGREEMENT TO GUARANTEE.  The New Guarantors hereby agree, jointly and severally with all the Existing Guarantors, to unconditionally guarantee the Company’s obligations under the Notes on the terms and subject to the conditions set forth in Article Ten of the Indenture and to be bound by all other applicable provisions of the Indenture and the Notes.

 

2.                                       RATIFICATION OF INDENTURE; SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURES PART OF INDENTURE.  Except as expressly amended hereby, the Indenture is in all respects ratified and confirmed and all the terms, conditions and provisions thereof shall remain in full force and effect.  This First Supplemental Indenture shall form a part of the Indenture for all purposes, and every holder of Notes heretofore or hereafter authenticated and delivered shall be bound hereby.

 

3.                                       GOVERNING LAW.  THIS FIRST SUPPLEMENTAL INDENTURE SHALL BE GOVERNED BY, AND CONSTRUED IN ACCORDANCE WITH, THE LAWS OF THE STATE OF NEW YORK.

 

4.                                       TRUSTEE.  The Trustee shall not be responsible in any manner whatsoever for or in respect of the validity or sufficiency of this First Supplemental Indenture or the Subsidiary Guarantee for or in respect of the recitals contained herein, all of which recitals are made solely by the New Guarantors and the Company.  All of the provisions contained in the Indenture in respect of the rights, privileges, protections, immunities, powers and duties of the Trustee shall be applicable in respect of this First Supplemental Indenture as fully and with like force and effect as though fully set forth in full herein.

 

5.                                       COUNTERPARTS.  The parties may sign any number of copies of this First Supplemental Indenture.  Each signed copy shall be an original, but all of them together represent the same agreement.  The exchange of copies of this First Supplemental Indenture and of signature pages by facsimile or PDF transmission shall constitute effective execution and delivery of this First Supplemental Indenture as to the parties hereto and may be used in lieu of the original First Supplemental Indenture for all purposes.  Signatures of the parties hereto transmitted by facsimile or PDF shall be deemed to be their original signatures for all purposes.

 



 

6.                                       EFFECT OF HEADINGS.  The Section headings herein are for convenience only and shall not effect the construction thereof.

 

[Signature page follows]

 

2



 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused this First Supplemental Indenture to be duly executed as of the date first above written.

 

 

NEW GUARANTORS :

 

 

 

 

 

AECOM INTERNATIONAL DEVELOPMENT, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

AECOM NATIONAL SECURITY PROGRAMS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ KEENAN DRISCOLL

 

 

Name:  Keenan Driscoll

 

Title:    Authorized Signatory

 

Signature Page to Supplemental Indenture

 



 

NEW GUARANTORS :

 

AMAN ENVIRONMENTAL

CONSTRUCTION, INC.

 

URS GLOBAL HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

URS GROUP, INC.

B.P. BARBER & ASSOCIATES, INC.

 

 

 

 

URS HOLDINGS, INC.

CLEVELAND WRECKING COMPANY

 

 

 

 

URS INTERNATIONAL, INC.

E.C. DRIVER & ASSOCIATES, INC.

 

 

 

 

URS INTERNATIONAL PROJECTS, INC.

EG&G DEFENSE MATERIALS, INC.

 

 

 

 

URS NUCLEAR LLC

FORERUNNER CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

URS OPERATING SERVICES, INC.

 

 

 

LEAR SIEGLER LOGISTICS INTERNATIONAL, INC.

 

URS PROFESSIONAL SOLUTIONS LLC

 

 

 

RUST CONSTRUCTORS INC.

 

URS RESOURCES, LLC

 

 

 

URS ALASKA, LLC

 

WASHINGTON DEMILITARIZATION COMPANY, LLC

 

 

 

URS CONSTRUCTION SERVICES, INC.

 

WASHINGTON GOV’T ENVIRONMENTAL SERVICES COMPANY LLC

 

 

 

AECOM GLOBAL II, LLC

 

WGI GLOBAL INC.

 

 

 

URS CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ KEENAN DRISCOLL

URS CORPORATION GREAT LAKES

 

Name:

Keenan Driscoll

 

 

Title:

Assistant Treasurer

URS CORPORATION SOUTHERN

 

 

 

 

 

URS CORPORATION-NEW YORK

 

 

 

 

 

URS CORPORATION-NORTH CAROLINA

 

 

 

 

 

URS CORPORATION-OHIO

 

 

 

 

 

URS E&C HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

URS ENERGY & CONSTRUCTION, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

URS FS COMMERCIAL OPERATIONS, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

URS FEDERAL SERVICES, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

URS FEDERAL SERVICES INTERNATIONAL, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

URS FOX US LP

 

 

 

Signature Page to Supplemental Indenture

 



 

 

AECOM TECHNOLOGY CORPORATION

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ KEENAN DRISCOLL

 

 

Name: Keenan Driscoll

 

 

Title: Assistant Treasurer

 

Signature Page to Supplemental Indenture

 



 

 

U.S. BANK NATIONAL ASSOCIATION, as Trustee

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ BRADLEY E. SCARBROUGH

 

 

Name: Bradley E. Scarbrough

 

 

Title:   Vice President

 

Signature Page to Supplemental Indenture

 



 

Schedule I

 

AECOM GOVERNMENT SERVICES, INC.

AECOM TECHNICAL SERVICES, INC.

TISHMAN CONSTRUCTION CORPORATION

 




EXHIBIT 10.45

 

URS FEDERAL SERVICES, INC.

 

EMPLOYEES RETIREMENT PLAN

 



 

URS FEDERAL SERVICES, INC.

 

EMPLOYEES RETIREMENT PLAN

 

Restated as of January 4, 2014

 



 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

ARTICLE I DEFINITIONS

1

 

 

ARTICLE II PARTICIPATION

12

 

 

ARTICLE III SERVICE

14

 

 

ARTICLE IV ELIGIBILITY FOR AND AMOUNT OF PENSION

20

 

 

ARTICLE V PAYMENT OF RETIREMENT INCOME

41

 

 

ARTICLE VI CONTRIBUTIONS

52

 

 

ARTICLE VII ADMINISTRATION OF PLAN

54

 

 

ARTICLE VIII MANAGEMENT OF FUNDS

62

 

 

ARTICLE IX TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

64

 

 

ARTICLE X RETIREE HEALTH PLAN ACCOUNT

68

 

 

ARTICLE XI AMENDMENT, MERGER AND TERMINATION

73

 

 

ARTICLE XII MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

76

 

 

APPENDIX A

79

 



 

URS FEDERAL SERVICES, INC.

 

EMPLOYEES RETIREMENT PLAN

 

INTRODUCTION

 

Effective as of August 20, 1999, EG&G Technical Services, Inc. adopts the EG&G Technical Services, Inc. Employees Retirement Plan as a program for providing retirement income and other benefits for the benefit of certain of its employees and their beneficiaries.

 

It is intended that this Plan and the trust used to provide benefits hereunder shall at all times be qualified and tax-exempt within the meaning of Sections 401(a) and 501(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as now in effect or hereafter amended, and any other applicable provisions of law.

 

The Plan is a successor to the EG&G, Inc. Employees Retirement Plan, as it related to employees and former employees of the Technical Services Division of EG&G, Inc. (the “Prior Plan”).

 

Except as specified herein, the provisions of the Plan as contained herein shall apply only to those persons who are in the service of the Employer (as defined herein) on or after August 20, 1999 or who were participants in the Prior Plan immediately prior thereto.

 

This Plan is amended and restated as of January 4, 2014.

 

Effective January 7, 2010, EG&G Technical Services, Inc. changed its name to “URS Federal Technical Services, Inc.”  As a result, the name of the Plan was changed to “URS Federal Technical Services, Inc. Employees Retirement Plan.”

 

Effective January 4, 2014, URS Federal Technical Services, Inc. was merged into URS Federal Services, Inc., which became a successor employer under the Plan.  At this time the name of the Plan was changed to “URS Federal Services, Inc. Employees Retirement Plan.”

 



 

ARTICLE I
DEFINITIONS

 

1.1                                “Accrued Benefit” means, as of any date of determination, the normal Retirement Income computed under Section 4.1.

 

1.2                                “Annuity Starting Date” means the first day of the month for which Retirement Income benefits are paid as an annuity or in any other form.  For the purposes of Section 1.24, the definition of Annuity Starting Date shall be the definition set forth in Code section 417(f)(2).

 

1.3                                “Average Earnings” means with respect to periods of Credited Service the average annual Earnings of a Participant during the five consecutive years of his Credited Service in the last 10 years of his Credited Service immediately preceding or ending with his Separation from Service affording the highest such average, or during the actual period of his Credited Service if less than five consecutive years; provided, however, Credited Service after December 31, 2003 shall not be taken into account for this purpose.  A Participant’s Earnings shall be annualized for any Computation Period in which he receives credit for some portion, but less than a full year, of Credited Service.”

 

1.4                                “Beneficiary” means the person or persons named by a Participant by written designation filed with the Plan Administrator to receive payments after the Participant’s death.

 

1.5                                “Board” shall mean the Board of Directors of URS Corporation (Delaware), or the Compensation Committee, or any other committee or individual acting pursuant to delegated power and authority from the Board of Directors of the URS Corporation (Delaware).

 

1.6                                “Board of Directors” means the board of directors of the Company.

 

1


 

1.7                                “Break in Service” means a Computation Period in which a Participant completes no more than 500 Hours of Service.  Hours of Service shall be recognized for a “permitted leave of absence” or a “maternity or paternity leave of absence” solely for purposes of determining whether an Employee has incurred a Break in Service.

 

A “permitted leave of absence” means an unpaid, temporary cessation from active employment with the Employer pursuant to a nondiscriminatory policy established by the Plan Administrator.

 

A “maternity or paternity leave of absence” means an absence from work for any period by reason of the Employee’s pregnancy, birth of the Employee’s child, placement of a child with the Employee in connection with the adoption of such child, or any absence for the purpose of caring for such child for a period immediately following such birth or placement.  The Hours of Service credited for a “maternity or paternity leave of absence” shall be those that would normally have been credited but for such absence, or, in any case in which the Plan Administrator is unable to determine such hours normally credited, eight Hours of Service per day.  For this purpose, Hours of Service shall be credited for the 12-month period in which the absence from work begins if such credit is necessary to prevent the Employee from incurring a Break in Service, or in the immediately following 12-month period.

 

1.8                                “Code” means the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as now in effect or hereafter amended.

 

1.9                                “Committee” shall mean either the Human Resources Committee or the Retirement Plans Committee, as required by the context.

 

1.10                         “Committees” shall mean both the Human Resources Committee and the Retirement Plans Committee that were authorized by the Compensation Committee of URS Corporation (Delaware).

 

1.11                         “Company” means URS Federal Services, Inc. and any successor thereto.

 

1.12                         “Computation Period”, except as provided below, means the calendar year.  The “Computation Period” for determining eligibility under Section 2.1(b) means the 12-

 

2



 

month period beginning on an Employee’s Employment Commencement Date or Reemployment Commencement Date, if applicable, and anniversaries thereof.

 

1.13                         “Corporation” shall mean URS Corporation (Delaware).

 

1.14                         “Covered Contract” means a contract that the Employer enters directly into with, or a subcontract by which the Employer enters indirectly into a contract with, the federal government or an agency or instrumentality thereof, the latter through another entity that has entered directly into such contract.

 

1.15                         “Covered Contract Employee” means an Employee whose service with the Employer, at the relevant time, is primarily devoted to work under a Covered Contract and who works at a location listed below.

 

Effective Date

 

Location

 

Bargaining Representative or Employer Unit

 

 

Huntsville, Alabama

 

International Brotherhood of Electrical Workers Local No. 558

 

 

San Antonio, Texas

 

MSSA (KDC)

 

 

Bloomington, Indiana

 

Crane, Indiana

09/01/2001

 

Wallops Island, Virginia

 

Wallops Island

09/18/2000

 

Johnston Atoll

 

Johnston Island

09/01/2000

 

Warner Robins, Georgia

 

Warner Robins

08/13/2000

 

Barstow, California

 

Barstow

02/01/2000

 

San Antonio, Texas

 

Randolph Air Force Base

08/20/1999

 

Huntsville, Alabama

 

Bricklayers & Allied Craftworkers Local 15

 

1.16                         “Credited Service” means service recognized for purposes of computing the amount of any benefit, determined as provided in Section 3.2.

 

1.17                         “Disability” means a Participant’s physical or mental condition, as determined by the Social Security Administration, that renders him eligible to receive disability benefits under Title II of the Social Security Act, as amended from time to time.  The Plan

 

3



 

Administrator will apply the provisions of this Section 1.17 in a nondiscriminatory, consistent and uniform manner.

 

1.18                         “Earnings” means a Participant’s regular base salary or wages from the Employer, including salary deferrals under any salary reduction agreement under Section 125, 402(g)(3) or 457 or, effective January 1, 2001, Section 132(f)(4) of the Code, commissions and severance pay, but excluding any bonuses, overtime payments, incentive pay, reimbursements or other expense allowances or other adjustments, fringe benefits and any other type of special or nonrecurring pay.

 

Effective January 1, 2002, the annual Earnings of each Participant taken into account for all Plan purposes shall not exceed $200,000, as adjusted by the Secretary of the Treasury for increases in the cost of living in accordance with Code Section 401(a)(17)(B).  The cost-of-living adjustment in effect for a calendar year applies to any period, not exceeding 12 months, over which Earnings are determined (the “determination period”) beginning in such calendar year.  If a determination period consists of fewer than 12 months, the limit referred to above will be multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of months in the determination period and the denominator of which is 12.

 

For purposes of determining a Participant’s benefit accruals in a Plan Year beginning after December 31, 2001, Earnings for a determination period beginning prior to January 1, 2002 shall not exceed $200,000.

 

1.19                         “Effective Date” means August 20, 1999.

 

1.20                         “Eligible Employee” means an Employee of the Employer who is in one of the E7 pay groups, excluding any person who is (a) a Covered Contract Employee or (b) included in a unit of employees covered by an agreement recognized for purposes of collective bargaining with the Employer, provided retirement benefits have been the subject of good faith bargaining and such bargaining does not provide for coverage under this Plan.

 

1.21                         “Employee” means any person employed by the Employer, other than an independent contractor, who receives stated remuneration other than a pension, severance pay, retainer

 

4



 

or fee under contract.  Employees shall also include leased employees within the meaning of Code Section 414(n)(2) unless such leased employees are covered by a money purchase pension plan requiring a 10 percent contribution and such leased employees do not constitute more than 20 percent of the recipient’s nonhighly compensated workforce, as defined in Section 414(n)(5)(C)(ii) of the Code.  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan, the term “Employee” shall not include any employee, independent contractor, leased employee or other individual unless such individual is contemporaneously treated by an Employer as an employee for purposes of this Plan (without regard to any subsequent recharacterization or inconsistent determination made by any person or entity or by any court, agency or other authority with respect to such individual).

 

1.22                         “Employer” means the Company and any subsidiary or affiliated organization of the Company that, with the approval of the Board of Directors and subject to such considerations as the Board of Directors may impose, adopts this Plan.

 

Employer shall also mean JT3, LLC for purposes of determining a Participant’s Earnings under Section 1.18, Credited Service under Section 3.2, Service and Vesting Service under Section 3.1 and in determining whether a Participant has incurred a Separation from Service under Section 1.40.

 

In determining a Participant’s Hours of Service for purposes of eligibility for participation and entitlement to benefits under Section 1.26, in determining whether an election to change the Limitation Year has been made in accordance with Section 1.27, in determining whether an Employee has incurred a Separation from Service under Section 1.40, in determining the limitations on annual benefits under Section 4.7 and the limitation in case of dual plans under Section 4.8 and in determining whether the Plan is Top-Heavy under Article IX, the term “Employer” shall include any other corporation or business entity that must be aggregated with the Employer under Section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, but only for such periods of time when the Employer and such other corporation or business entity must be aggregated as aforesaid.  For purposes of Sections

 

5



 

4.6 and 4.7, such definition of “Employer” shall be modified by Section 415(h) of the Code.

 

Employer shall also mean Washington Group International, Inc., solely with respect to those employees who transferred from the Energy & Environment business unit of the Company headquartered in Morgantown, West Virginia to Washington Group International, Inc., effective December 26, 2009, and who were Participants in the Plan on or prior to that date.

 

1.23                         “Employment Commencement Date” means the date on which an Employee first performs an Hour of Service.

 

1.24                         “Equivalent Actuarial Value” means:

 

(a)                                  Equivalent value computed on the basis of interest at 7% per annum and the 1971 Group Annuity Mortality Table with no loading and projected by Scale E, with a one-year age setback for the Participant and a five-year age setback for any Beneficiary.

 

(b)                                  Except as provided in Section 4.7, Actuarial equivalence for purposes of Section 4.7 shall be computed on the basis of interest at 5% per annum and the 1983 Group Annuity Mortality Table (Unisex).

 

(c)                                   Actuarial equivalence for purposes of Section 5.1(c) and Option 4 and Option 5 of Section 5.2 shall be computed on the basis of:

 

(i)                                      Interest Rate:

 

(A)                                For Plan Years beginning prior to January 1, 2008, the annual rate of interest on 30-year Treasury securities for the second calendar month preceding the first day of the Plan Year that contains the Annuity Starting Date; and

 

(B)                                For Plan Years beginning after December 31, 2007, the “applicable interest rate” is generally defined as the adjusted first, second and

 

6



 

third segment rates applied under rules similar to the rule of section 430(h)(2)(C) of the Code for the month before the date of distribution.

 

(ii)                                   Mortality Table:

 

(A)                                For distributions with Annuity Starting Dates prior to December 31, 2002 the mortality table prescribed by the Secretary of the Treasury that is based on the prevailing commissioners’ standard table, described in Section 807(d)(5)(A) of the Code, that is used to determine reserves for group annuity contracts issued on the date as of which present value is being determined, without regard to any other subparagraph of Section 807(d)(5), as published in Revenue Ruling 95-6 or any governmental ruling or publication superseding that Ruling.

 

(B)                                For distributions with Annuity Starting Dates on or after December 31, 2002, but before January 1, 2008, on the basis of the Mortality Table set forth in Rev. Rul. 2001-62.

 

(C)                                For distributions with Annuity Starting Dates on or after January 1, 2008, on the basis of the “applicable mortality table” described in section 417(e)(3) of the Code.

 

1.25                         “ERISA” means the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as now in effect or as hereafter amended.

 

1.26                         With respect to any applicable Computation Period in determining Vesting Service in accordance with Section 3.1 and in determining Credited Service in accordance with Section 3.2(b), “Hour of Service” means as follows:

 

(a)                                  each hour for which the Employee is paid or entitled to payment for the performance of duties for the Employer,

 

7



 

(b)                                  each hour for which an Employee is paid or entitled to payment by the Employer on account of a period during which no duties are performed, whether or not the employment relationship has terminated, but not more than 501 hours for any single continuous period, and

 

(c)                                   each hour for which back pay, irrespective of mitigation of damages, is either awarded or agreed to by the Employer, excluding any hour credited under (a) or (b).

 

(d)                                  For purposes of determining Vesting Service in accordance with Section 3.1, Hours of Service shall be determined by crediting an Employee with 190 Hours of Service for each month in which at least one Hour of Service was credited under subparagraphs (a), (b) or (c) above.  Hours of Service under this Section 1.26(d) shall be credited in accordance with the equivalence rules of Section 2530.200b-3 of the Department of Labor regulations.

 

For purposes of this Section 1.26, performance of duties (i) for EG&G, Inc. prior to the Effective Date or (ii) for EG&G Mound Technologies, Inc. in accordance with Appendix K to the Prior Plan, shall constitute performance of duties for the Employer.

 

No hours shall be credited on account of any period during which the Employee performs no duties and receives payment solely for the purpose of reimbursement for medical or medically related expenses incurred by the Employee for the purpose of complying with unemployment compensation, worker’s compensation or disability insurance laws.  The Hours of Service credited shall be determined by Section 2530.200b-2(b) and (c) of the Department of Labor regulations.

 

8



 

1.27                         “Human Resources Committee” shall mean the Human Resources Committee of URS Corporation (Delaware) as described in Article VII of the Plan.

 

1.28                         “Limitation Year” means the calendar year, unless otherwise selected by the Employer in a manner consistent with that described in Section 1.415-2(b)(2) of the Treasury Regulations.

 

1.29                         “Normal Retirement Age” means the age determined in accordance with the following table:

 

Year of Birth

 

Age

 

 

 

1937 and earlier

 

65

1938—1942

 

65 plus 2 months per year

1943—1954

 

66

1955—1959

 

66 plus 2 months per year

1960 and later

 

67

 

1.30                         “Normal Retirement Date” means the first day of the month next following the month in which the Participant attains his Normal Retirement Age.

 

1.31                         “Participant” means any Eligible Employee participating in the Plan, as provided in Article II, or any former Employee whose participation has not ceased pursuant to Section 2.2.

 

1.32                         “Plan” means the URS Federal Services, Inc. Employees Retirement Plan, as set forth herein and as amended from time to time.

 

1.33                         “Plan Administrator” shall mean the Human Resources Committee.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, in the absence of a Human Resources Committee for any reason, the Corporation shall be the Plan Administrator.

 

1.34                         “Plan Year” means (a) the period commencing on the Effective Date and ending on the next following December 31 and (b) the 12-month period commencing on each January 1 thereafter and ending on the next following December 31.

 

1.35                         “Prior Plan” means the EG&G, Inc. Employees Retirement Plan.

 

9



 

1.36                         “Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity” means Retirement Income described in Section 5.1(b).

 

1.37                         “Reemployment Commencement Date” means the first date following an Employee’s Break in Service on which the Employee again performs an Hour of Service.

 

1.38                         “Retirement Income” means monthly payments under the Plan as provided in Article V.

 

1.39                         “Retirement Plans Committee” shall mean the Retirement Plans Committee of URS Corporation (Delaware) as described in Article VII of the Plan.

 

1.40                         “Separation from Service” means an Employee’s death, resignation or discharge from Service with the Employer.

 

1.41                         “Service” means service with an Employer or predecessor employer recognized for purposes of determining eligibility for participation in the Plan and entitlement to certain benefits under the Plan, determined as provided in Sections 1.49 and 3.1.  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, Service credit with respect to qualified military service will be provided in accordance with Section 414(u) of the Code.

 

1.42                         “Social Security Retirement Age” means the age used as the retirement age under Section 216(l) of the Social Security Act, applied without regard to the age increase factor and as if the early retirement age under Section 216(l)(2) of such Act were 62.

 

1.43                         “Social Security Tax Base” means the average (without indexing) of the Social Security.  Wage Bases in effect for each calendar year during the 35-year period ending with the last day of the calendar year in which the Participant attains (or will attain) Normal Retirement Age.  In determining a Participant’s Social Security Tax Base for a Plan Year, the Social Security Wage Base for all calendar years beginning after the first day of the Plan Year is assumed to be the same as the Social Security Wage Base in effect as of the beginning of the Plan Year.  A Participant’s Social Security Tax Base for a Plan Year after the 35-year period described in this Section shall be the Participant’s Social Security Tax Base for the Plan Year during which the 35-year period ends.  A Participant’s Social

 

10



 

Security Tax Base for a Plan Year prior to the 35-year period described in this Section shall be the Social Security Wage Base in effect at the beginning of the Plan Year.  A Participant’s Social Security Tax Base shall be automatically adjusted each Plan Year to reflect changes in the Social Security Wage Base.

 

1.44                         “Social Security Wage Base” means the contribution and benefit base taken into account under Section 230 of the Social Security Act.

 

1.45                         “Spouse” means the lawful spouse to whom the Participant was married on the date Retirement Income payments commence under the Plan, or if Retirement Income payments had not commenced, the lawful spouse to whom the Participant was married on the Participant’s date of death.

 

1.46                         “Trust Agreement” means the agreement, as amended from time to time, entered into between the Company and the Trustee to carry out the purposes of the Plan.

 

1.47                         “Trust Fund” means the cash or other property held by the Trustee in accordance with the provisions of the Trust Agreement and the Plan.

 

1.48                         “Trustee” means the trustee or trustees appointed by the Retirement Plans Committee and acting in accordance with Article X.

 

1.49                         “Year of Service” means a Computation Period during which an individual completes at least 1,000 Hours of Service.

 

1.50                         “Year of Vesting Service” means a Computation Period during which Service is recognized for purposes of determining entitlement to certain benefits under the Plan, determined as provided in Section 3.1.

 

Whenever used herein, the masculine gender includes the feminine and the plural shall include the singular unless the context clearly requires otherwise.

 

11


 

ARTICLE II
PARTICIPATION

 

2.1                                Participation Requirements

 

(a)                                  Every Eligible Employee on the Effective Date who was a participant in the Prior Plan immediately prior to the Effective Date shall become a Participant in the Plan as of the Effective Date.

 

(b)                                  Every other Eligible Employee who is not already a Participant pursuant to paragraph (a) above shall become a Participant immediately after his completion of one Year of Service.

 

(c)                                   In order to become a Participant, an Eligible Employee must complete an enrollment form prescribed by the Plan Administrator.

 

2.2                                Events Affecting Participation

 

(a)                                  An Employee’s participation in the Plan shall end when he is no longer employed by the Employer if he is not entitled to either an immediate or a deferred Retirement Income under the Plan.  Participation shall continue and Service shall continue to be granted while a Participant is on authorized leave of absence or during a period while he is not an Eligible Employee but remains in the employ of the Employer, but no Credited Service shall be counted for that period, except as specifically provided in Article Ill and Section 4.9.  Any Earnings of such a Participant while his status is other than that of an Eligible Employee shall be disregarded for all Plan purposes.

 

(b)                                  If an Employee transfers from an employment status with an Employer other than as an Eligible Employee and thereby becomes an Eligible Employee, he shall become a Participant immediately after the date on which he completes the requirements of Section 2.1.  No Credited Service shall be counted for the period of time prior to his becoming a Participant, except as specifically provided in Article Ill and Section 4.9.

 

12



 

2.3                                Participation upon Reemployment

 

If an Employee’s participation in the Plan ends and he again becomes an Eligible Employee, he shall again become a Participant as of his Reemployment Commencement Date provided he has not incurred a Break in Service.

 

2.4                                Plan Closed to New Participants

 

No individual who first becomes an Eligible Employee of, is first offered employment with or who first executes an employment agreement with the Employer for a position as an Eligible Employee after June 30, 2003 shall be considered or become a Participant.

 

2.5                                Participation Upon Reemployment or Transfer to an Eligible Unit After June 30, 2003

 

Notwithstanding Section 2.4, if the participation of an Eligible Employee who was a Participant in the Plan ends or has ended and he again becomes an Eligible Employee on or after July 1, 2003, he shall again become a Participant as of his Reemployment Commencement Date provided he has not incurred a Break in Service.  However, if an Eligible Employee ceases or has ceased to be an Eligible Employee prior to becoming a Participant, whether as a result of termination of employment with the Employer or transfer to an ineligible unit, and he then again on or after July 1, 2003 becomes an Employee or transfers back to an eligible unit, such individual shall not be eligible to become a Participant in the Plan.

 

13



 

ARTICLE III
SERVICE

 

3.1                                Service and Vesting Service

 

(a)                                  Except as otherwise provided in this Plan, all service with the Employer rendered by an Employee counts as Service.  A Computation Period described in Section 1.49 counts as a full Year of Service.  A Computation Period in which an Employee completes at least 1,000 Hours of Service counts as a full Year of Vesting Service.  Except as provided in paragraph (b) below, no Vesting Service is counted for any Computation Period in which an Employee completes less than 1,000 Hours of Service.  If an Employee who has not become 100 percent vested in accordance with Section 4.4 has a Break in Service in which the number of consecutive one-year Breaks in Service equals or exceeds five, excluding any Years of Vesting Service disregarded under this sentence by reason of any earlier Break in Service, the service rendered before the Break in Service shall be excluded from his Vesting Service.

 

(b)                                  A period during which an Employee is on a leave of absence approved by the Employer shall not be considered as a Break in Service.  Under rules uniformly applicable to all Employees similarly situated, the Employer shall credit Vesting Service for any portion of that period of leave that is not counted as Vesting Service under paragraph (a) of this Section, provided that the Employee returns to Service at or before the end of such leave of absence.  An Employee who fails to return to Service at or before the end of such a leave of absence will be considered to have incurred a Separation from Service as of the later of (i) the last day of Service with an Employer or (ii) the date on which the Employee’s failure to return was due to his death, Disability or retirement in accordance with Section 4.1 or 4.2.

 

A period during which an Employee is laid off due to a reduction in work force shall not be considered as a Break in Service.  Under rules uniformly applicable to all Employees similarly situated, the Employer shall credit Vesting Service for the period of layoff that

 

14



 

is not counted as Vesting Service under paragraph (a) of this Section, provided that the Employee returns to Service within the one-year period following the beginning of the layoff.  An Employee who fails to return to Service before the end of such one-year period will be considered to have incurred a Separation from Service as of the last day of Service with an Employer.

 

3.2                                Credited Service

 

(a)                                  A Participant who normally works the regular full-time work week for his Employer, whether or not considered a regular or temporary Employee by the Employer, shall be credited with a full year of Credited Service for each calendar year of his employment with an Employer, other than as a Covered Contract Employee.  If a Participant described in the previous sentence completes less than a full year of Credited Service for the calendar year in which his Employment Commencement Date or Separation from Service occurs, he shall be credited with one-twelfth (1/12) of a year of Credited Service for each month of employment with an Employer, rounded to the nearest month.  For the calendar month of a Participant’s Separation from Service, a Participant is credited with the month if his Separation from Service is on or after the 15 th  of the month.  For the calendar month of a Participant’s Employment Commencement Date, a Participant is credited with the month if his Employment Commencement Date is on or before the 15 th  of the month.  For the purpose of determining Credited Service under this Section 3.2(a), Service shall be measured under the elapsed time method as authorized under regulations promulgated by the Secretary of Labor.

 

(b)                                  A Participant who does not normally work the regular full-time work week for his Employer, whether or not considered a regular or temporary Employee by the Employer, shall be credited with one-twelfth (1/12) of a year of Credited Service for each 173-1/3 Hours of Service completed as an Employee during a Computation Period, other than a Covered Contract Employee, described in this paragraph (b).

 

15



 

(c)                                   A Participant shall be credited with Credited Service for any period during which he is on an approved leave of absence for medical or military reasons that is counted as Vesting Service as provided in Section 3.1(b).  The Earnings for a period of absence that is counted as Credited Service shall be the Participant’s rate of Earnings in effect immediately before the period of absence.

 

(d)                                  A Participant who goes from normally working the regular full-time work week for his Employer to not normally working the regular full-time work week for his Employer and vice versa shall be credited with Credited Service for the month depending on his or her employment status of the 15 th  day of the month.

 

3.3                                Restoration of Retired Participant or Other Former Employee to Service

 

(a)                                  If a Participant in receipt of a Retirement Income is restored to service as an Eligible Employee on or after his Normal Retirement Date, the following shall apply:

 

(i)                                      His Retirement Income shall be suspended for each month during the period of restoration that constitutes a “month of suspension service” and.  he shall be granted Credited Service with respect to such periods of restoration as otherwise provided by Section 3.2.  A month of suspension service is a month in which the Participant completes at least 40 Hours of Service with the Employer.

 

(ii)                                   If the Participant’s death occurs during the period of restoration, any Retirement Income to which he would have been entitled had he retired immediately prior to his date of death, based on the benefit formula then in effect and his Earnings and Credited Service before and after the period when he was not in the service of the Employer, reduced by an amount of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the benefits he received before the date of his restoration to service, shall be payable to his surviving Spouse or,

 

16



 

alternatively, any payments under an optional benefit, if one has been elected and become effective, shall begin.

 

(iii)                                Upon later retirement, payment of the Participant’s Retirement Income, based on the benefit formula then in effect and his Earnings and Credited Service before and after the period when he was not in the service of the Employer, reduced by an amount of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the benefits he received before the date of his restoration to service, shall begin no later than the third month after the month in which the Participant ceases to be employed in suspension service and shall be adjusted, if necessary, to recover Retirement Income payments erroneously made after his restoration to service, in compliance with Title 29 of the Code of Federal Regulations, Section 2530.203-3 in a consistent and nondiscriminatory manner.

 

(b)                                  If a Participant in receipt of Retirement Income is restored to service with the Employer before his Normal Retirement Date, the following shall apply:

 

(i)                                      His Retirement Income shall cease and any election of an optional benefit in effect shall be void.

 

(ii)                                   Any Vesting Service and Credited Service to which he was entitled at the time of his Separation from Service shall be restored to him as of his Reemployment Commencement Date.

 

(iii)                                Upon later retirement or termination his Retirement Income shall be based on the benefit formula then in effect and his Earnings and Credited Service before and after the period when he was not in the service of the Employer, reduced by an amount of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the benefits he received before the date of his restoration to service.

 

(iv)                               The part of the Participant’s Retirement Income upon later retirement payable with respect to Credited Service rendered before his previous Separation from Service shall never be less than the amount of his

 

17



 

previous Retirement Income modified to reflect any option in effect on his later retirement.

 

(c)                                   If a Participant not in receipt of a Retirement Income or a former Participant is restored to service without having had a Break in Service, his Vesting Service and Credited Service shall be determined as provided in Sections 3.1, and 3.2, and, if applicable, he shall again become a Participant as of his Reemployment Commencement Date.

 

(d)                                  If a Participant not in receipt of a Retirement Income or a former Participant who received a single-sum settlement in lieu of his Retirement Income is restored to service with the Employer after having had a Break in Service, the following shall apply:

 

(i)                                      The Vesting Service to which he was previously entitled shall be restored to him, and, if applicable, he shall again become a Participant as of his.  Reemployment Commencement Date.

 

(ii)                                   Any Credited Service to which the Participant was entitled at the time of his Separation from Service that is included in the Vesting Service so restored shall not be restored to him.

 

(iii)                                Upon later termination or retirement of a Participant whose previous Vesting Service has been restored under this paragraph (d), his Retirement Income shall be based on the benefit formula then in effect and his Earnings and Credited Service after the period when he was not in the service of the Employer.

 

(e)                                   If any other former Participant is restored to service with the Employer after having had a Break in Service, the following shall apply:

 

(i)                                      He shall again become a Participant as of his Reemployment Commencement Date.

 

18



 

(ii)                                   The Vesting Service to which he was previously entitled shall be restored to him, except that with respect to a former Participant who had not completed five Years of Vesting Service, such Vesting Service shall be restored to him if the total number of consecutive one-year Breaks in Service does not equal or exceed five.

 

(iii)                                Any Credited Service to which the Participant was entitled at the time of his Separation from Service that is included in the Vesting Service so restored shall be restored to him.

 

(iv)                               If a Participant’s Credited Service has been restored under this paragraph (e), his Retirement Income, if any, shall be based on the benefit formula then in effect and his Earnings and Credited Service before and after the.  period when he was not in the service of the Employer.

 

19



 

ARTICLE IV
ELIGIBILITY FOR AND AMOUNT OF PENSION

 

4.1                                Normal Retirement

 

(a)                                  The right of a Participant to his normal Retirement Income shall be nonforfeitable on attainment of his Normal Retirement Age.  A Participant may retire from service on a normal Retirement Income beginning on his Normal Retirement Date or he may postpone his retirement and remain in service after his Normal Retirement Date.

 

If the Participant postpones his retirement, he shall be retired from service on a normal Retirement Income beginning on the first day of the calendar month immediately after the Human Resources Committee receives his written application to retire.

 

If a Participant’s retirement is postponed beyond his Normal Retirement Date, then he shall be granted Credited Service, as otherwise provided in this Plan, with respect to all periods beginning on and after his Normal Retirement Date.  Such a Participant’s Retirement Income shall be determined on the basis of his Credited Service and Earnings both before and after his Normal Retirement Date.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, if the Participant was not given a notice of suspension of benefits in accordance with Section 411(a)(3)(B) of the Code, the Participant’s Accrued Benefit as of the end of each Plan Year following his Normal Retirement Date shall be the greater of the amount described in the preceding sentence or the Equivalent Actuarial Value of his Accrued Benefit, determined as of the later of his Normal Retirement Date or the end of the prior Plan Year.  If a Participant’s Accrued Benefit is actuarially increased under the preceding sentence, such actuarial increase shall be reduced by any actuarial increase of his Accrued Benefit under Section 5.4(b) because the Participant remains an Employee after attaining age 70½.

 

20


 

(b)                                  Effective January 1, 2004 and subject to the provisions of Section 5.1, the normal monthly Retirement Income payable upon retirement on or after Normal Retirement Date shall be equal to greater of (i) or (ii), where

 

(i)                                      Equals the sum of (A) and (B), where

 

(A)                                Equals the benefit accrued as of December 31, 2003 and determined as one-twelfth of the sum of (1) 0.85% of the Participant’s Average Earnings determined as of December 31, 2003, multiplied by the Participant’s Credited Service as of December 31, 2003, plus (2) an additional 0.75% of the Participant’s Average Earnings, determined as of December 31, 2003, in excess of the Social Security Tax Base determined as of December 31, 2003 multiplied by the Participant’s Credited Service as of December 31, 2003  (up to a maximum of 35 years),

 

and

 

(B)                                Equals for each individual one-twelfth of the sum of the following calculations for each calendar year beginning after December 31, 2003 that such individual is a Participant: (1) 0.65% of the individual’s Earnings while a Participant for such year, plus (2) an additional 0.65% of the individual’s Earnings while a Participant for such year in excess of 50% of the Social Security Wage Base for the applicable year, provided that for purposes of the calculation made pursuant to this Section 4.1(b)(i)(B)(2) no Earnings of an individual whether as a Participant or not shall be included once such individual has completed 35 years of Credited Service.

 

(ii)                                   Equals $70.83.

 

(c)                                   Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, the Accrued Benefit of a Participant as determined under Section 4.1(b) shall not be less

 

21



 

than the Accrued Benefit of such Participant on December 31, 2003 as calculated under the provisions of the Plan as in effect on December 31, 2003 prior to this Amendment.

 

Subject to the provisions of Section 5.1, the monthly normal Retirement Income payable upon retirement on or after Normal Retirement Date of a Participant who participated in the EG&G Mound Applied Technologies, Inc. Salaried Employees’ Pension Plan or the EG&G Mound Applied Technologies, Inc. Hourly Paid Employees’ Pension Plan (the “Mound Plans”) prior to participating in the Prior Plan prior to September 30, 1997 shall be equal to his Accrued Benefit, subject to adjustment as provided in this Section 4.1(c).  Such Accrued Benefit shall first be increased by adding thereto the Participant’s monthly accrued benefits under the Mound Plans, determined in accordance with the provisions thereof in effect on September 30, 1997.  Such adjusted Accrued Benefit shall then be offset by the Accrued Benefit attributable to service described in Section 1.26, based on Average Earnings as of the last date of such service.  The resulting adjustments shall be indicated in Appendix A hereto.  Any monthly accrued benefits payable under the Mound Plans shall be payable to the Participant pursuant and subject to the terms and conditions of the Mound Plans in effect as of September 30, 1997, including (but not limited to) the timing, form of benefit and “rule of 80” provisions of the Mound Plans.

 

(d)                                  Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Plan to the contrary, no further benefits shall accrue under the Plan for any period occurring after December 31, 2004 for any Participant who is employed at the National Radar Testing Facility and whose terms of employment are governed by a collective bargaining agreement between the International Association of Machinists Union and the Employer, except as otherwise may be required by Section 416 of the Code and other applicable laws and regulations.  For Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 2005, the benefits of any Participant described in the preceding sentence shall be calculated as set forth in Section 4.1(b)(i) of the Plan; provided, however, that the affected Participant’s Credited Service,

 

22



 

Earnings and Social Security Wage Base under Section 4.1(b)(i)(B) shall be calculated as of December 31, 2004.

 

4.2                                Early Retirement

 

(a)                                  A Participant who has not reached his Normal Retirement Date but who has reached (i) an age that is within 10 years of his Normal Retirement Age or (ii) his 55th birthday in the case of a Participant who was a participant in the Prior Plan as of December 31, 1988, and completed 10 Years of Vesting Service shall be retired from service on an early Retirement Income on the first day of the calendar month after the Plan Administrator receives his written application to retire.

 

(b)                                  The early Retirement Income shall be a deferred Retirement Income beginning on the Participant’s Normal Retirement Date and, subject to the provisions of Section 5.1, shall be equal to his Accrued Benefit.  However, subject to the provisions of Section 4.2(a) the Participant may elect to receive an early Retirement Income beginning on the first day of any calendar month before his Normal Retirement Date.  In that case, the Participant’s Retirement Income that otherwise would have commenced on his Normal Retirement Date shall be as follows:

 

(i)                                      With respect to that portion of the Participant Retirement Income accrued on or prior to December 31, 2003 as set forth in Section 4.1(b)(i)(A) of the Plan, the Participant’s Retirement Income that otherwise would have commenced on his Normal Retirement Date shall be reduced for early commencement by 1/15 th  for each of the first five full years, 1/30 th  for each of the next five years and 5% for each of the next two years by which the Annuity Starting Date precedes the Participant’s Normal Retirement Date, except that in the case of a Participant who has completed at least 30 Years of Vesting Service, the reduction applicable to the portion of the benefit determined under Section 4.1(b)(i)(A)(1) of the Plan or the amount of the benefit determined under Section 4.1(b)(ii) of the Plan shall be none

 

23



 

for the first three full years, 8.4% for each of the next two years and 4.2% for each of the next seven years by which the Annuity Starting Date precedes the Participant’s Normal Retirement Date.  Any reduction described in the preceding sentence shall be applied proportionately to each monthly interval.

 

(ii)                                   With respect to that portion of the Participant’s Retirement Income accrued on or after January 1, 2004 as set forth in Section 4.1(b)(i)(B) of the Plan, the Participant’s Retirement Income that otherwise would have commenced on his Normal Retirement Date shall be reduced for early commencement by 1/15 th  for each of the first five full years, 1/30 th  for each of the next five years and 5% for each of the next two years by which the Annuity Starting Date precedes the Participant’s Normal Retirement Date.  Any reduction described in the preceding sentence shall be applied proportionately to each monthly interval.

 

4.3                                In-Service Withdrawal after Attainment of Age 62

 

(a)                                  Not withstanding any provision in Section 3.3(b) to the contrary, a Participant may elect at any time after attainment of age 62 to begin receiving his or her vested Retirement Income while still in the employ of the Company.  The Participant shall begin receiving benefits on the first day of the calendar month after the Plan Administrator receives his written application to receive benefits.  In-Service Withdrawals provided under this Section 4.3 shall be subject to the following restrictions:

 

(i)                                      The Participant must have a reduced work schedule, which provides for the completion of less than 40 Hours of Service with the Employer in any month.

 

(ii)                                   If the Participant actually completes more than 40 Hours of Service in any month, that month shall be treated as a month of suspension service under

 

24



 

Section 3.3, and the Participant’s Retirement Income shall be suspended for that month.

 

(b)                                  The Participant shall continue to earn Credited Service as provided above in Section 3.2(b) for a Participant who does not normally work the regular full-time work week for his Employer.

 

(c)                                   The Participant shall continue to accrue benefits at the rate provided above in Section 4.1(b) until the Participant’s retirement, subject to the exclusions set forth in Sections 4.1(c) and (d).

 

(d)                                  The Participant’s Retirement Income that otherwise would have commenced on his Normal Retirement Date shall be calculated in the same manner as the early Retirement Income calculated pursuant to Sections 4.2(b)(i) and (ii), above.

 

4.4                                Vesting

 

(a)                                  A Participant shall have a 100 percent vested nonforfeitable right to his Accrued Benefit upon the earlier to occur of the completion of five Years of Vesting Service or the attainment of age forty-five while in the employ of the Company.  If the Participant’s employment with the Employer is subsequently terminated for reasons other than retirement or death, he shall be eligible for a vested Retirement Income after the Plan Administrator receives his written application for the Retirement Income.

 

If an Employee dies while on an approved leave of absence on account of military service that is otherwise protected by applicable Federal Veterans Reemployment Rights laws then, for the purposes of this Section 4.4(a), that Employee shall be treated as if he or she had returned to Service and then died, but only if the individual’s death occurs after December 31, 2006 and within the period the individual’s reemployment rights are protected by such laws.

 

(b)                                  The vested Retirement Income shall begin on the Participant’s Normal Retirement Date and, subject to the provisions of Section 5.1, shall be equal to

 

25



 

his Accrued Benefit as of his date of Separation from Service.  However, a Participant who has completed 10 Years of Vesting Service may elect to have his vested Retirement Income begin on the first day of any calendar month after his attainment of the age described in Section 4.2(a) and before his Normal Retirement Date.  In that event, the Participant’s Retirement Income that otherwise would have commenced on his Normal Retirement Date shall be reduced for early commencement in accordance with the provisions of Section 4.2(b).

 

4.5                                Disability Retirement

 

(a)                                  A Participant who has not reached his Normal Retirement Date but who has completed at least 10 Years of Vesting Service and incurred a Disability shall be eligible to receive a Disability Retirement Income commencing on his Normal Retirement Date or on the first day of any month on or after his eligibility for early retirement pursuant to Section 4.2(a).

 

(b)                                  The Disability Retirement Income of a Participant commencing on his Normal Retirement Date shall be his normal Retirement Income determined in accordance with Section 4.1, except that (i) the Participant’s Average Earnings shall be determined by assuming that his Earnings continued during the period of his Disability at the same rate as in effect on the date of his Separation from Service, (ii) Credited Service shall continue to be granted during the period of his Disability in accordance with the Participant’s normal work schedule and (iii) the Participant’s long-term disability payments under an Employer-sponsored plan will be reduced by the amount of his normal Retirement Income payable under this Plan.

 

(c)                                   The Disability Retirement Income of a Participant commencing on or after his eligibility for early retirement shall be his early Retirement Income determined in accordance with Section 4.2(b), except that (i) the Participant’s Average Earnings shall be determined by assuming that his Earnings continued during the period of his Disability at the same rate as in effect on the date of his

 

26



 

Separation from Service, (ii) Credited Service shall continue to be granted during the period of his Disability in accordance with the Participant’s normal work schedule and (iii) the Participant’s long-term disability payments under an Employer-sponsored plan will be reduced by the amount of his early Retirement Income payable under this Plan.

 

4.6                                Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income

 

(a)                                  A Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income is payable to the surviving Spouse of a Participant who at the time of his death had a nonforfeitable vested right to his Accrued Benefit.  Such surviving Spouse shall receive a Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income, which is of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the form of benefit described in Section 5.1(a) that would begin on the Participant’s Normal Retirement Date, calculated in accordance with (i) or (ii) as follows, whichever is applicable:

 

(i)                                      If the Participant’s date of death occurred prior to the earliest date on which he could have elected to receive Retirement Income pursuant to Section 4.2, 4.3, 4.4 or 4.5 (“earliest retirement age”), such Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income shall be calculated as if the Participant had terminated employment on his date of death or on his date of termination of employment, if earlier, had survived to his earliest retirement age, had elected to retire at that time and have payments commence immediately in the form of a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the Retirement Income that otherwise would be payable pursuant to Section 5.1(a) and had died on the day after his earliest retirement age.  Benefits may commence as early as the date on which the Participant would have attained his earliest retirement age, subject to the provisions of Section 5.3.  Benefits commencing after the date on which the Participant would have attained his earliest retirement age shall be of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the

 

27



 

benefit the surviving Spouse would have been entitled to if payments had commenced immediately in accordance with this paragraph (a)(i).

 

(ii)                                   If the Participant’s date of death occurred on or after his earliest retirement age, such Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income shall be calculated as if the Participant had retired on the day before his death or on his date of termination of employment, if earlier, with payments commencing immediately in the form of a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the Retirement Income that otherwise would be payable pursuant to Section 5.1(a) and had died on the day after his retirement.  The surviving Spouse may elect to commence payment under such annuity within a reasonable period after the Participant’s death.  Benefits that commence later than those that would have been paid to the surviving Spouse under a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity shall be actuarially adjusted to reflect the delayed payment.

 

(b)                                  The Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income shall be paid in monthly installments to, and during the life of, the Participant’s surviving Spouse.  The earliest period for which the surviving Spouse may receive a Spouse’s benefit shall be the month in which the Participant would have attained his earliest retirement age.

 

(c)                                   The Participant’s surviving Spouse may elect to receive the Qualified Pre-Retirement Spouse’s Retirement Income in the form of Option 5 of Section 5.2.  The Plan Administrator will provide a notification to the surviving Spouse that shall include a general description of the material features, and an explanation of the relative values of, the optional forms of benefit available under the Plan in a manner that would satisfy the notice requirements of IRC 417(a)(3) and Treas. Reg. 1.417(a)(3)-1.

 

28



 

4.7                                Maximum Benefits

 

(a)                                  Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan to the contrary, the total annual amount of a Participant’s Retirement Income derived from Employer contributions under this Plan and under all other defined benefit plans of an Employer shall not exceed the Maximum Permissible Benefit pursuant to Section 415(b)(1) of the Code.  Benefit increases resulting from the increase in the Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation shall be provided to all Employees participating in the Plan who have one Hour of Service on or after December 31, 2001.  For purposes of determining the Maximum Permissible Benefit, the “Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation” is $160,000, as adjusted, effective January 1 of each year, under Code Section 415(d) in such manner as the Secretary shall prescribe, and payable in the form of a straight life annuity.  This limitation as adjusted will apply to limitation years ending with or within the calendar year for which the adjustment applies.  For purposes of determining the Maximum Permissible Benefit, the “Defined Benefit Compensation Limitation” is 100% of the Participant’s average compensation for the three consecutive years of service, determined in accordance with Treasury Regulation Section 1.415(b)-1(a)(5), in which he received the highest aggregate compensation from the Employer, adjusted as provided below.  For purposes of applying the limitations of Code Section 415, compensation shall be determined in accordance with the provisions of Treasury Regulation Sections 1.415(c)-2(b)and (c), including compensation described in Treasury Regulation Sections 1.415(c)-2(e)(3)(i), (ii) and (iii) and (e)(4) (to the extent any such compensation is paid by the Employer).  For purposes of this Section 4.7, and applying the limitations of Code Section 415, compensation shall include any amount which is contributed or deferred by the Employer on behalf of and at the election of a Participant and which is not includible in gross income by reason of Code Section 125, 402(e)(3) or 457 or, effective January 1, 2001, Code Section 132(f)(4).

 

29


 

(b)                                  The “Maximum Permissible Benefit” is the lesser of the Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation or the Defined Benefit Compensation Limitation (both adjusted where required, as provided in (i) below and if applicable (ii) or (iii) below).

 

(i)                                      If the Participant has fewer than 10 years of participation in the Plan, the Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation shall be multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of years (or part thereof) of participation in the Plan and the denominator of which is 10.  In the case of a Participant who has fewer than 10 Years of Service with the Employer, the Defined Benefit Compensation Limitation shall be multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of Years (or part thereof) of Service with the Employer and the denominator of which is 10.

 

(ii)                                   Adjustment of Limitation for Commencement prior to Attaining Age 62.  The Dollar Limitation applicable to the Participant at such earlier age is an annual benefit payable in the form of a straight life annuity beginning at the earlier age that is the Actuarial Equivalent of the Dollar Limitation applicable to the Participant at age 62 (as adjusted under (i) above, if required).

 

(A)                                For Benefits Commencing in Limitation Years Beginning before July 1, 2007.  The Dollar Limitation applicable at an age prior to age 62 is determined as the lesser of:

 

(I)                                    the Actuarial Equivalent (at such age) of the Dollar Limitation computed using the interest rate and mortality table (or other tabular factor) specified in Section 1.24(b) of the Plan; and

 

(II)                               the Actuarial Equivalent (at such age) of the Dollar Limitation computed using a 5% interest rate and the

 

30



 

Applicable Mortality Table as defined in Section 1.24 (c)(ii)(C) of the Plan.

 

Any decrease in the Dollar Limitation determined in accordance with this paragraph (ii) shall not reflect a mortality decrement to the extent that benefits are not forfeited upon the death of the Participant.

 

(B)                                For Benefits Commencing in Limitation Years Beginning on or after July 1, 2007.

 

(I)                                    If the Plan does not have an immediate commencing straight life annuity payable both at age 62 and the age of benefit commencement, the Dollar Limitation applicable at an age prior to age 62 is determined using 5% interest rate and the Applicable Mortality Table as defined in Section 1.24(c)(ii)(C) of the Plan (and expressing the participant’s age based on completed calendar months as of the Annuity Starting Date).

 

(II)                               If the plan has an immediate commencing straight life annuity payable both at age 62 and the age of benefit commencement, the Dollar Limitation applicable at an age prior to age 62 is determined as the lesser of:

 

a)                                      the Dollar Limitation calculated under subparagraph (B)(I), above; and

 

b)                                      the Dollar Limitation set forth in paragraph (a), above, multiplied by the ratio of 1) to 2), where:

 

1)                                      is equal to annual amount of the immediately commencing straight life

 

31



 

annuity under the Plan at the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date ; and

 

2)                                      is equal to the annual amount of the immediately commencing straight life annuity under the Plan at age 62.

 

The annual amounts under both subsections 1) and 2) above are determined without applying the limitations under Code Section 415.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, all adjustments of the Dollar Limitation for benefits commencing in Limitation Years beginning on or after July 1, 2007 shall be made in accordance with Treasury Regulations Section 1.415(b)-1, and all adjustments of the Dollar Limitation for benefits commencing in Limitation Years beginning before July 1, 2007 shall be made in accordance with the provisions of Code Section 415 and the Treasury Regulations thereunder as in effect at the time distribution of benefits commenced.

 

(iii)                                Adjustment of Limitation for Commencement after Age 65.  The Dollar Limitation applicable to the Participant is the annual benefit payable in the form of a straight life annuity beginning at the later age that is Actuarially Equivalent to the Dollar Limitation applicable to the Participant at age 65 (as adjusted under (i) above, if required).

 

(A)                                For Benefits Commencing in Limitation Years Beginning before July 1, 2007.  The Actuarial  Equivalent of the Dollar Limitation applicable at an age after age 65 is determined as the lesser of:

 

(I)                                    the Actuarial Equivalent (at such age) of the Dollar Limitation computed using the interest rate and mortality table (or other tabular factor) specified in Section 1.24(b) of the Plan; and

 

32



 

(II)                               the Actuarial Equivalent (at such age) of the Dollar Limitation computed using a 5% interest rate assumption and the Applicable Mortality Table as defined in Section 1.24 (c)(ii)(C) of the Plan.

 

For these purposes, mortality between age 65 and the age at which benefits commence shall be ignored , to the extent that benefits are not forfeited upon death of the Participant.

 

(B)                                For Benefits Commencing in Limitation Years Beginning on or after July 1, 2007.

 

(I)                                    If the Plan does not have an immediate commencing straight life annuity payable both at age 65 and the age of benefit commencement, the increase in the Dollar Limitation applicable at the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date  is determined using 5% interest rate and the Applicable Mortality Table as defined in Section 1.24(c)(ii)(C) of the Plan (and expressing the participant’s age based on completed calendar months as of the Annuity Starting Date ).

 

(II)                               If the Plan has an immediate commencing straight life annuity payable both at age 65 and the age of benefit commencement, the Dollar Limitation applicable at an age subsequent to age 65 is determined as the lesser of:

 

a)                                      the Dollar Limitation calculated under subparagraph (B)(I), above; and

 

b)                                      the Dollar Limitation set forth in paragraph (a), above, multiplied by the ratio of 1) to 2), where:

 

33



 

1)                                      is equal to the annual amount of the immediately commencing straight life annuity under the Plan at the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date (computed disregarding the Participant’s accruals after age 65 but including actuarial adjustments even if those actuarial adjustments are applied to offset accruals); and

 

2)                                      is equal to the annual amount of the immediately commencing straight life annuity under the Plan at age 65 (the annual amount of such annuity that would be payable under the plan to a hypothetical participant who is age 65 and has the same accrued benefit as the participant.).

 

The annual amounts under both subsections 1) and 2) above are determined without applying the limitations under Code Section 415.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, all adjustments of the Dollar Limitation for benefits commencing in Limitation Years beginning on or after July 1, 2007 shall be made in accordance with Treasury Regulations Section 1.415(b)-1, and all adjustments of the Dollar Limitation for benefits commencing in Limitation Years beginning before July 1, 2007 shall be made in accordance with the provisions of Code Section 415 and the Treasury Regulations thereunder as in effect at the time distribution of benefits commenced.

 

(c)                                   For distributions that commenced prior to January 1, 2002, for purposes of determining whether the limitation contained in the first sentence of paragraph (a) has been satisfied, in the case of any benefit that may commence prior to a

 

34



 

Participant’s Social Security Retirement Age but on or after the Participant’s attainment of age 62, the dollar limitation of Code Section 415(b)(1)(A) shall be reduced by 5/9 of 1% for each of the first 36 months and 5/12 of 1% for each of the next 24 months (if applicable) by which benefits commence before the month in which the Participant attains Social Security Retirement Age.  Effective January 1, 2002, this paragraph (c) shall no longer apply and shall have no effect under the terms of the Plan.

 

(d)                                  For purposes of determining whether the limitation contained in the first sentence of paragraph (a) has been satisfied for any benefit that may commence in a form other than a straight life annuity, the Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation shall be adjusted (in accordance with the regulations prescribed by the Secretary) so that it is of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the limitation for a benefit payable as a straight life annuity as follows:

 

(i)                                      Benefit Forms Not Subject to Code Section 417(e)(3).

 

(A)                                For Limitation Years beginning before July 1, 2007, the Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation shall be adjusted using whichever of the following produces the greater applicable limitation:  (I) the interest rate and mortality table specified in Section 1.24(b) or (II) the interest rate and mortality table specified of Section 1.24(c)(ii) (with respect to a benefit payable in a form other than a straight life annuity) after adjustment, if necessary, for a benefit commencing prior to age 62 or after age 65.

 

(B)                                For Limitation Years beginning on or after July 1, 2007, the adjusted Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation is the greater of:  (I) the annual amount of the straight life annuity (if any) payable to the Participant under the Plan commencing at the same annuity starting date as the form of benefit payable to the Participant or (II) the annual amount of the straight life annuity commencing at the same Annuity Starting Date that has the same actuarial present

 

35



 

value as the form of benefit payable to the Participant, computed using a 5 percent interest assumption and the mortality table described in Section 1.24(c)(ii) for that Annuity Starting Date.

 

(ii)                                   Benefit Forms Subject to Code Section 417(e)(3).  The Defined Benefit Dollar limitation shall be adjusted using the following assumptions:

 

(A)                                For distributions with Annuity Starting Dates prior to January 1, 2004, the mortality table described in Section 1.24(b) and interest at 5% per annum.

 

(B)                                For distributions with Annuity Starting Dates on or after January 1, 2004, but before January 1, 2006, whichever of the following produces the greater limitation: (I) the mortality table and interest rate described in Section 1.24(b), above, or (II) the mortality table described in Section 1.24(c)(ii), above, and interest at the rate of 5.5% per annum.  If the Annuity Starting Date is on or after the first day of the Plan Year beginning in 2004 and before December 31, 2004, and the Plan applies the transition rule in section 101(d)(3) of Pension Funding Equity Act of 2004 in lieu of the rule set forth in the first sentence of this Subsection (B), the annual amount of the straight life annuity commencing at the same Annuity Starting Date that has the same actuarial present value as the Participant’s form of benefit, determined in accordance with Notice 2004-78.

 

(C)                                For distributions with Annuity Starting Dates on or after January 1, 2006, whichever of the following produces the lower limitation:

 

(I)                                    the mortality table described in Section 1.24(c)(ii) and interest at the rate of 5.5% per annum;

 

(II)                               the mortality table described in Section 1.24(c)(ii) and interest at the rate that provides a benefit of not more than

 

36



 

105% of the benefit that would be provided if the applicable interest rate (as described in section 417(e)(3)) were the interest rate assumption; or

 

(III)                          the mortality table and interest rate set forth in Section 1.24(b), above.

 

(e)                                   For purposes of this Section and Section 4.7, references to annual amounts of benefits or contributions shall be for a Limitation Year.

 

4.8                                Limitation in Case of Dual Plans

 

If a Participant is also participating in one or more defined contribution plans of an Employer, the annual additions (as defined in Code Section 415(c)(2)) to such defined contribution plans shall be limited (or reduced, if applicable) so that a “combined benefit factor” in excess of 1.0 shall not result, pursuant to Code Section 415(e).  The provisions of this Section 4.7 will cease to apply on and after any Limitation Year beginning after December 31, 1999.

 

4.9                                Transfers and Employment

 

(a)                                  If an Employee becomes employed by the Employer in any capacity other than as an Eligible Employee, he shall retain any Credited Service he has under this Plan and future Service with the Employer shall count as Years of Vesting Service under the Plan.  Upon his later retirement or termination of employment with the Employer, any benefits to which he is entitled under the Plan shall be determined under the Plan provisions in effect on the date he ceases to be an Eligible Employee and only on.  the basis of his Credited Service accrued while he was an Eligible Employee.

 

(b)                                  Subject to the Break in Service provisions of Article III, if a person who is originally employed by the Employer in any capacity other than as an Eligible Employee becomes an Eligible Employee, his period of Service with the Employer before becoming an Eligible Employee shall count as Vesting

 

37



 

Service under the Plan.  Upon his later retirement or termination of employment, the benefits payable under the Plan shall be computed under the Plan provisions in effect at that time and only on the basis of the Credited Service accrued while he is an Eligible Employee.

 

4.10                         Funding-Based Limits.

 

To the extent required by Code section 436, the following funding-based limits on benefits and benefit accruals are effective January 1, 2008:

 

(a)                                  Funding-Based Limitation on Unpredictable Contingent Event Benefits .  An Unpredictable Contingent Event Benefit payable with respect to an event occurring in a Plan Year may not be provided if the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage for such Plan Year is less than 60% or would be less than 60% taking into account such occurrence.  The limitation of this Subsection 4.10(a) shall not apply if a contribution is made in accordance with Code section 436(b)(2).

 

(b)                                  Limitation on Plan Amendments Increasing Liability for Benefits .  An amendment that has the effect of increasing liabilities of the Plan by reason of increases in benefits, establishment of new benefits, changing the rate of benefit accrual or changing the rate at which benefits become nonforfeitable may not take effect for a Plan Year if the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage for such Plan Year is less than 80% or would be less than 80% taking into account such amendment.  The limitation of this Subsection 4.10(b) shall not apply if a contribution is made in accordance with Code section 436(c)(2) or, to the extent provided in Code section 436(c)(3), the increase is not based on a Participant’s compensation.

 

(c)                                   Limitation on Accelerated Benefit Distributions.

 

(i)                                      If the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage for a Plan Year is less than 60%, the Plan may not pay any Prohibited Payment after the valuation date for such Plan Year.

 

38


 

(ii)                                   During any period in which the Company is a debtor under Title 11, United Stated Code, or similar Federal or State law, the Plan may not pay any Prohibited Payment.  This Subsection 4.10(c)(ii) shall not apply on or after the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage is certified to be not less than 100%.

 

(iii)                                If the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage for a Plan Year is 60% or greater but less than 80%, the Plan may not pay any Prohibited Payment after the valuation date for such Plan Year in an amount that exceeds the lesser of (A) 50% of the amount of the payment which could be made without regard to this Subsection 4.10(c)(iii) or (B) the present value (determined under guidance prescribed by the PBGC using the Code section 417(e) interest and mortality rates) of the maximum guarantee with respect to the Participant under ERISA section 4022.  Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, only one (1) Prohibited Payment under this Subsection 4.10(c)(iii) may be made with respect to any Participant during any period of consecutive Plan Years in which the limitations of Subsection 4.10(c)(i) or 4.9(c)(ii) apply.  For these purposes, a Participant and Beneficiary, including an Alternate Payee, shall be treated as one (1) Participant.

 

(iv)                               This Subsection 4.10(c) shall not apply to involuntary cash-outs under Code section 411(a)(11) to the extent such distribution is provided for in the Plan.

 

(d)                                  Limitation on Benefit Accruals On Account of Severe Funding Shortfall .  Benefit accruals under the Plan shall cease as of the valuation date for a Plan Year if the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage for such Plan Year is less than 60%.  The limitation of this Subsection 4.10(d) shall not apply with respect to any Plan Year, effective as of the first of the Plan Year, if a contribution is made in accordance with Code section 436(e)(2).  For the 2009 Plan Year, the Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage for the 2008

 

39



 

Plan Year may be used in determining whether the restriction of this Subsection 4.10(d) applies.

 

(e)                                   Treatment of Plan as of Close of Restriction Period .  Payments and accruals will resume effective as of the close of the period for which any limitation of payment or benefit accrual described in this Section 4.10 applies.

 

(f)                                    Definitions .  The following definitions apply for purposes of this Section 4.10.

 

(i)                                      Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage .  The term “Adjusted Funding Target Attainment Percentage” has the meaning given by Code section 436(j)(2).

 

(ii)                                   Unpredictable Contingent Event Benefits .  The term “Unpredictable Contingent Event Benefit” means a benefit payable solely by reason of (A) a plant shutdown (or similar event as determined by the Secretary) or (B) an event other than the attainment of any age, performance of any service, receipt or derivation of any compensation, or occurrence of death or disability.

 

(iii)                                Prohibited Payment .  The term “Prohibited Payment” means (A) any payment, in excess of the monthly amount paid under a single life annuity (plus any Social Security supplements described in Code section 411(a)(9)), to a Participant or Beneficiary whose Benefit Starting Date occurs during any period a limitation under Subsection 4.10(c)(i) is in effect, (B) any payment for the purchase of an irrevocable commitment from an insurer to pay benefits.

 

40



 

ARTICLE V
PAYMENT OF RETIREMENT INCOME

 

5.1                                Automatic Form of Payment

 

(a)                                  If a Participant does not have a Spouse on his Annuity Starting Date, and if he has not elected an optional benefit as provided in Section 5.2, his Retirement Income shall be payable in monthly installments ending with the last monthly payment before death.

 

(b)                                  If a Participant has a Spouse on his Annuity Starting Date, and if he has not.  elected an optional form of payment as provided in Section 5.2, his Retirement Income shall be a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  The Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity provides Retirement Income to the Participant for his life in an amount that is of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the Retirement Income otherwise payable pursuant to Section 5.1(a).  Upon the Participant’s death on or after his Annuity Starting Date, 50 per cent of the initial amount of monthly Retirement Income payable to the Participant will be paid to, and during the life of, the surviving Spouse.

 

(c)                                   A single sum payment of Equivalent Actuarial Value shall be made in lieu of all benefits if the present value of a Participant’s Retirement Income at the time of any Separation from Service does not exceed $1,000.  The single sum payment will be made as soon as practicable following the Participant’s Separation from Service.  If a Participant’s vested Retirement Income is zero, a single sum payment of Equivalent Actuarial Value shall be deemed to have been paid and the entire Accrued Benefit shall be treated as a forfeiture and applied as provided in Section 6.1.  If such Participant again becomes a Participant before incurring five consecutive one-year Breaks in Service, his Accrued Benefit will be restored to the amount of such Accrued Benefit on the date of the deemed distribution.

 

41



 

5.2                                Optional Forms of Payment

 

Any Participant may, by written notice received by the Plan Administrator during the election period specified in Section 5.3, elect to convert the Retirement Income otherwise payable to him into an optional benefit of Equivalent Actuarial Value, as provided in one of the options named below.  However, if the Beneficiary selected is not the Participant’s Spouse or if the option selected is not a joint and survivor form of benefit, the amount of the monthly benefit payable to the Beneficiary pursuant to the option shall not exceed the applicable percentage of the Retirement Income payable to the Participant during his lifetime determined under Treasury Regulation §1.401(a)(9)-6 Q&A-2.

 

Option 1.                                        Retirement Income payable pursuant to Section 5.1(a), even if the Participant has a Spouse.

 

Option 2.                                        A modified Retirement Income payable during the Participant’s life and after his death payable at the rate of 50, 75 or 100 per cent of his modified Retirement Income, as the Participant elects, during the life of and to the Beneficiary named by him when he elected the option.

 

Option 3.                                        A modified Retirement Income payable in monthly installments ending with the last monthly payment before death, unless the Participant has not received 120 monthly payments (the “period certain”), in which case payments shall continue to be made to his Beneficiary until all guaranteed payments have been made.  If the Beneficiary also dies before the expiration of the period certain, a single sum payment of Equivalent Actuarial Value to the remaining guaranteed payments shall be paid to the estate of the last to survive of the Participant and his Beneficiary.  In no event, however, shall payments under this Option 3 extend beyond the joint and last survivor expectancy of the Participant and his Beneficiary.

 

Option 4.                                        Retirement Income payable in monthly installments during the Participant’s life, beginning only on an Annuity Starting Date that is prior to the first day on which the Participant would otherwise be entitled (upon proper

 

42



 

application) to receive his old age Social Security benefit, whether or not on a reduced basis because of early commencement of such old age benefit.  Retirement Income payments on or after such first day shall be adjusted to provide, insofar as practicable, that the total of such Retirement Income and the estimated primary old age Social Security benefit payable on such first day shall equal the monthly amount of Retirement Income payments prior to such first day.

 

Option 5.                                        A single sum payment of Equivalent Actuarial Value provided the present value of the Participant’s Retirement Income exceeds $1,000 but does not exceed $5,000.  A Participant may elect to receive such single sum payment without regard to the spousal consent requirements in Section 5.3(c).

 

5.3                                Election of Options

 

(a)                                  The Plan Administrator, no less than 30 days and no more than 90 days prior to the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date, shall furnish each Participant a written explanation in nontechnical language of (i) the terms and conditions of the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity provided by Section 5.1(b), (ii) the financial effect upon the Participant’s Retirement Income if he instead elects payment under one of the optional forms described in Section 5.2, (iii) in the case of a married Participant the rights of the Participant’s Spouse to consent or not to consent to the Participant’s election of an optional form of payment and (iv) the right of the Participant to make, and to revoke, an election under Section 5.2.  An election under Section 5.2 may be made at any time after that information is furnished to the Participant and before the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date; provided that the period during which the election may be made shall be the 90-day period ending on the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date.

 

The Plan Administrator will provide a notification to the Participant that shall include a general description of the material features, and an explanation of the relative values of, the optional forms of benefit available under the Plan in a

 

43



 

manner that would satisfy the notice requirements of IRC 417(a)(3) and Treas. Reg. 1.417(a)(3)-1.

 

An election of an option under Section 5.2 may be revoked on a form supplied by the Plan Administrator, and a new election may be made at any time and any number of times during the applicable election period.

 

(b)                                  An election of an option under Section 5.2 shall be made by written notice received by the Plan Administrator prior to the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date.  The election shall become effective on the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date.  The Participant may revoke his option by written notice to the Plan Administrator prior to that date.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, a Participant’s Annuity Starting Date may be before the date the election is made, provided that the Participant may revoke his option within the 7-day period beginning on the day after the Participant receives the explanation described in paragraph (a) above and that distribution.  under the option does not begin until the expiration of that 7-day period.  A Participant’s Annuity Starting Date may also be less than 30 days after receipt of the written explanation described in paragraph (a) above, provided that the Participant may revoke his option and distributions may not begin until the later of the Annuity Starting Date or the expiration of the 7-day period referred to in the preceding sentence.

 

An election of Option 2 shall be deemed to be revoked in the event the Beneficiary named under the option shall die prior to the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date and the Participant may thereafter make another election, subject to the conditions required therefor.  If a Participant who has elected an option shall die prior to the effective date of his election, the option shall not become operative and the provisions of Section 4.6 shall apply.  A Participant may change the Beneficiary named in his election at any time prior to the later of the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date or the date distribution under the option actually commences, or, in the case of Option 3, at any time prior to the expiration of the period certain.

 

44



 

(c)                                   If the Participant has an eligible Spouse and if the Participant desires to waive the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity form of Retirement Income, his eligible Spouse must consent to such waiver (within the 90-day election period) in a written instrument received by the Plan Administrator.  The eligible Spouse’s consent must acknowledge the financial effect of the waiver.  The waiver must either (i) designate the Beneficiary (if any) and form of Retirement Income payment or (ii) expressly permit the Participant to designate any Beneficiary and the form of payment without further consent by the eligible Spouse, and must (iii) further acknowledge that the eligible Spouse has the right to limit the consent to a specific Beneficiary and form of payment and state that any relinquishment of such right is voluntary by the eligible Spouse.  The eligible Spouse’s written consent and acknowledgment must be witnessed by a Plan representative or a notary public.  The Participant may revoke the election at any time and any number of times before his Retirement Income payments begin.

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, spousal consent to a Participant’s designation shall not be required if:

 

(i)                                      the eligible Spouse is designated as the primary beneficiary or contingent annuitant by the Participant and the method of payment chosen for the eligible Spouse by the Participant conforms with the definition of a qualified joint and survivor annuity under the Code, or

 

(ii)                                   it is established to the satisfaction of the Plan Administrator that spousal consent cannot be obtained because there is no eligible Spouse, because the eligible Spouse cannot be located or because of such other circumstances as may be prescribed in regulations issued by the Secretary of the Treasury.

 

45



 

5.4                                Required Commencement Dates

 

(a)                                  Unless a Participant otherwise elects, the payment of benefits under the Plan to the Participant will begin not later than the 60th day after the close of the Plan Year in which the later of the following events occurs:

 

(i)                                      The Participant attains his Normal Retirement Age, or

 

(ii)                                   The Participant’s Separation from Service with the Employer.

 

(b)                                  Notwithstanding any provision herein to the contrary, a Participant’s benefit payments shall commence not later than the April 1 of the calendar year following the later of the calendar year in which he attains age 70½ or in which his Separation from Service occurs, except that benefit payments to a Participant who is a Five Percent Owner, as defined in Section 11.7(b), shall commence not later than the April 1 of the calendar year following the calendar year in which he attains age 70½.  In the case of a Participant other than a Five Percent Owner who has a Separation from Service in a calendar year after the calendar year in which he attains age 70-1/2, his Accrued Benefit shall be actuarially increased to take into account the period after age 70-1/2 in which the Participant was not receiving any benefits under the Plan, to the extent required under Code Section 401(a)(9)(C)(iii).

 

Distributions to a Participant must be made over the life of the Participant (or the lives of the Participant and his Spouse or Beneficiary) or over a period not exceeding the life expectancy of the Participant (or the life expectancies of the Participant and his Spouse or Beneficiary).

 

Notwithstanding the foregoing, all distributions required under this Article V shall be determined and made in accordance with the Treasury Regulations §§ 1.401(a)(9)-2 through 1.401(a)(9)-9, and the incidental benefit requirements of Code Section 401(a)(9)(G).

 

46



 

5.5                                Direct Rollovers

 

(a)                                  In General

 

Notwithstanding any provision of the Plan to the contrary that would otherwise limit a Distributee’s election under this Section 5.5, a Distributee may elect, at the time and in the manner prescribed by the Plan Administrator, to have any portion of an Eligible Rollover Distribution paid directly to an Eligible Retirement Plan specified by the Distributee in a Direct Rollover.

 

(b)                                  Eligible Rollover Distribution

 

An Eligible Rollover Distribution is any distribution of all or any portion of the balance to the credit of the Distributee, except that an Eligible Rollover Distribution does not include:  any distribution that is one of a series of substantially equal periodic payments (no less frequently than annually) made for the life (or life expectancy) of the Distributee or the joint lives (or joint life expectancies) of the Distributee and the Distributee’s designated beneficiary, or for a specified period of ten years or more; any distribution to the extent such distribution is required under Section 401(a)(9) of the Code; and the portion of any distribution that is not includible in gross income.

 

(c)                                   Eligible Retirement Plan

 

An Eligible Retirement Plan is an individual retirement account described in Section 408(a) of the Code, an individual retirement annuity described in Section 408(b) of the Code, an annuity plan described in Section 403(a) of the Code, an annuity contract described in Section 403(b) of the Code, a qualified trust described in Section 401(a) of the Code, or an eligible plan under Section 457(b) of the Code which is maintained by a state, political subdivision of a state, or any agency or instrumentality of a state or political subdivision of a state which agrees to separately account for amounts transferred into such plan from the Plan, that accepts the Distributee’s Eligible Rollover Distribution.  With respect to a Distributee who is a non-spouse Beneficiary, only an individual retirement plan as

 

47



 

provided for under section 402(c)(11) of the Code will qualify as an Eligible Retirement Plan.  Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan to the contrary, and subject to the provisions of Section 408A(e) of the Code, distributions from this Plan may paid directly to a Roth IRA specified by a Distributee.

 

(d)                                  “Distributee”

 

A Distributee includes:

 

(i)                                      an Eligible Employee or former Eligible Employee;

 

(ii)                                   an Eligible Employee or former Eligible Employee’s surviving spouse;

 

(iii)                                an Eligible Employee or former Eligible Employee’s spouse or former spouse who is the alternate payee under a qualified domestic relations order (as defined in Section 414(p) of the Code) with regard to the interest of that spouse or former spouse; and

 

(iv)                               subject to the limitations set forth in subsection (c) above, an Eligible Employee or former Eligible Employee’s non-spouse Beneficiary.

 

(e)                                   Direct Rollover

 

A Direct Rollover is a payment by the Plan to the Eligible Retirement Plan specified by the Distributee.

 

5.6                                Retroactive Annuity Starting Date.

 

(a)                                  Retroactive Annuity Starting Date .  In the event a general notice of distribution regarding a Participant’s optional forms of payment is required and provided after the Participant’s annuity starting date as defined in Q&A-l0(b) of Section 1.401(a)-20 of the Treasury Regulations solely due to an administrative delay in providing such notice, the Participant’s Annuity Starting Date shall be deemed a “retroactive annuity starting date.”  In such event, the following shall apply:

 

48


 

(i)                                      The date the first payment is actually made to the Participant (the ‘current annuity starting date’) shall occur no later than 90 days after the date the general notice of distribution is provided to the Participant (unless any delay beyond the 90 days is attributable to administrative delay in the payment of benefits).

 

(ii)                                   The general notice of distribution shall include the Participant’s right to elect either a retroactive annuity starting date or a current annuity starting date.

 

(iii)                                The information included in the general notice of distribution shall include information based on both the Participant’s retroactive annuity starting date and current annuity starting date.

 

(iv)                               The Participant shall have the opportunity to elect in writing either:

 

(A)                                A benefit determined based on the retroactive annuity starting date, or

 

(B)                                A benefit determined based on the current annuity starting date.

 

(v)                                  In the event that:

 

(A)                                A Participant elects to receive his benefit determined as of a retroactive annuity starting date, and

 

(B)                                Under the form of payment elected by such Participant the benefit payable to the Participant’s Spouse upon the Participant’s death would be less than the benefit payable to such Spouse if the Participant had elected to receive a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity with his Spouse as Beneficiary determined and payable as of the current annuity starting date, then the Participant’s Spouse must consent in writing to the Participant’s election of such retroactive annuity starting date.

 

49



 

(vi)                               Except in the case where payment of the Participant’s benefit (other than a form of payment that is subject to Section 417(e) of the Code) commences no more than 12 months after the retroactive annuity starting date, the Participant’s benefit determined based on the retroactive annuity starting date (including any interest adjustments) shall satisfy the requirements of Section 415 of the Code if the current annuity starting date were to be substituted for the retroactive annuity starting date for all purposes of determining the limits under Section 415 of the Code, including for purposes of determining the applicable interest rate and the applicable mortality table used to adjust such limits.

 

(vii)                            If the Participant’s benefit is payable in a form of payment which would have been subject to Section 417(e) of the Code if payment had commenced as of the retroactive annuity starting date, then the amount of payment as of the current annuity starting date shall be no less than the amount of payment produced by applying the applicable interest rate and the applicable mortality table (as defined in Section 1.24 of the Plan), determined as of such date to the annuity form that was used to determine the amount of payment as of the Participant’s retroactive annuity starting date.

 

(viii)                         In the event that a Participant elects (with Spousal consent, if applicable) to receive his benefit determined as of a retroactive annuity starting date, the Participant shall receive a make-up payment to reflect any missed payment or payments for the period from the retroactive annuity starting date to the date of the actual make-up payment, with an appropriate adjustment for interest from the date the missed payment or payments would have been made (including, if applicable, a payment of the single-sum value of the Participant’s retirement income) to the date of the actual make-up payment.  If the Participant’s benefit is paid in a form other than a single-sum payment, the benefit payments, other than any required make-up payment, shall be in an amount that is equal to the amount which

 

50



 

would have been paid to the Participant had payments actually commenced on his retroactive annuity starting date.

 

(ix)                               For purposes of the foregoing, references to a Participant’s Spouse shall include an alternate payee who, under the terms of a qualified domestic relations order, is required to be treated as a surviving Spouse in the event of the Participant’s death.

 

(x)                                  Notwithstanding the foregoing, a benefit shall not be determined based on a retroactive annuity starting date to the extent not permitted under applicable law (including regulations and other administrative guidance under the Code).

 

51



 

ARTICLE VI
CONTRIBUTIONS

 

6.1                                Employer’s Contributions

 

It is the intention of the Employer to continue the Plan and make the contributions that are necessary to maintain the Plan on a sound actuarial basis and to meet the minimum funding standards prescribed by law.  However, should the Board of Directors terminate the Plan in accordance with the provisions of Article X, the Employer shall discontinue its contributions.  Any forfeitures shall be used to reduce the Employer’s contributions otherwise payable.

 

6.2                                Return of Contributions

 

(a)                                  If all or part of the Employer’s contributions hereunder are conditioned upon their deductibility under Section 404 of the Code and the deduction for all or any part of such contributions to the Plan is disallowed by the Internal Revenue Service, the portion of the contributions to which that disallowance applies shall be returned to the Employer without interest, but reduced by any investment loss attributable to those contributions.  The return shall be made within one year after the date of the disallowance of deduction.  All Employer contributions to the Plan are conditioned upon their deductibility.

 

(b)                                  If an Employer contribution is made due to a mistake in fact, the Employer may require the Trustee to return the contribution, without interest but reduced by any investment loss allocable to the contribution.  The return shall be made as soon as practicable within one year after the date the contribution was made.

 

(c)                                   If an Employer contribution hereunder is conditioned on initial qualification of the Plan under Section 401(a) of the Code and if the Plan receives an adverse determination letter with respect to its initial qualification, such contribution shall be returned to the Employer within one year after the date the initial qualification is denied, but only if the application for determination is made by the time prescribed by law for filing the Employer’s return for the taxable year

 

52



 

in which the Plan is adopted, or such later date as the Secretary of the Treasury may prescribe.  All Employer contributions hereunder are conditioned upon the initial qualification of the Plan.

 

53



 

ARTICLE VII
COMMITTEES

 

7.1                                Appointment of Committees

 

The Committees shall be appointed by the Compensation Committee and they shall have the power, authority, discretion and responsibility as specified, respectively, in Article VIII.  Any member of a Committee may resign by delivering his or her written resignation to the Committee chairperson at least 30 days before the effective date of such resignation.  The Compensation Committee may remove any member of a Committee at any time with or without advance written notice.  Vacancies on a Committee arising by resignation, removal, death or otherwise shall be filled by the Compensation Committee.  Any person or group of persons may serve in more than one fiduciary capacity with respect to the Plan.

 

7.2                                Structure of Committees

 

The chairperson of each Committee shall be appointed by the Compensation Committee, or its delegatee, and the chairperson shall appoint a secretary who need not be a member of the respective Committee.  The Committees may appoint any person or persons to have such duties in connection with the administration or investments of the Plan as the Committees may from time to time provide in writing.  The Committees may appoint from their number such subcommittees with such powers as the Committees shall determine, and may authorize one or more of their number, any person or persons having duties in connection with the administration or investments of the Plan or any agent to execute or deliver any instrument or make any payment on their behalf, except that a request for funds from or a direction for, the payment or application of funds by the Insurance Company shall be signed by at least one member of the Retirement Plans Committee.  The Committees may retain such legal counsel and accountants, who may or may not be in the employ of the Company, actuaries and other administrative or investment service providers as they may deem necessary and appropriate in carrying out the provisions of the Plan.

 

54



 

7.3                                Meetings

 

The Committees shall hold meetings, either in person or by telephone, upon such notice, at such time or times, and at such place or places as they may determine.  A majority of the members of the respective Committee at the time in office shall constitute a quorum for the transaction of business at all meetings.  All resolutions or other actions taken by a Committee shall be by a vote of a majority of the members, if they act without a meeting.

 

7.4                                Limitation of Liability

 

Except to the extent otherwise required by ERISA, the members of the Committees shall be free from all liability, joint or several, for their acts as members of the Committees.

 

7.5                                Compensation, Costs and Expenses

 

The members of the Committees shall serve without compensation for their services hereunder.  All reasonable and necessary costs, expenses and liabilities incurred by the Committees in the supervision of the administration or investments of the Plan shall be paid by the Corporation separate and apart from the contributions to the Plan.

 

7.6                                Indemnification

 

The Corporation shall indemnify and hold harmless the named fiduciaries, each Committee (and the members thereof) and any officers or Employees of the Corporation to whom responsibilities with respect to the Plan have been delegated, from and against any and all liabilities, claims, demands, costs and expenses, including reasonable attorney’s fees and costs, which may arise out of an alleged breach in the performance of their duties under the Plan and under ERISA, other than such liabilities, claims, demands, costs and expenses as may result from the willful misconduct of such persons.  The Corporation shall have the right, but not the obligation, to conduct the defense of such persons in any proceeding to which this paragraph applies.  The Corporation may satisfy its obligation under this paragraph, in whole or in part, through the purchase of a policy or policies of insurance.

 

55



 

ARTICLE VIII
ALLOCATION OF RESPONSIBILITIES

 

8.1                                Administrative Responsibilities

 

The Committees are the named fiduciaries of the Plan and have the exclusive power, authority and discretion with respect to the Plan as granted herein.  The Committees, respectively, are granted the following authority.

 

(a)                                  The Human Resources Committee is the named fiduciary which has the exclusive power, authority and discretion to:

 

(i)             manage and oversee the administration and operation of the Plan in accordance with its terms, including interpreting the Plan and determining eligibility for participation and benefits, deciding any matters arising in the administration and operation of the Plan and reviewing the performance of persons to whom administrative duties with respect to the Plan have been assigned;

 

(ii)            provide a report of its activities to the Compensation Committee at least annually and at such other times as may be directed by the Compensation Committee; and

 

(iii)           perform such other functions as may be provided for in the Plan or as may be assigned to it from time to time by the Compensation Committee, or another responsible committee of the Board.

 

The Human Resources Committee shall make such rules, regulations, interpretations, and shall have the authority and discretion to take such other actions to administer the Plan as the Human Resources Committee may deem appropriate.

 

(b)                                  The Retirement Plans Committee is the named fiduciary which has the exclusive power, authority and discretion to:

 

(i)             appoint the trustee and other custodians for the assets of the Plan;

 

56



 

(ii)            determine the investment policies and funding methods for the Plan based on the professional advice of investment consultants, actuaries and such other advisors as the Retirement Plans Committee deems appropriate;

 

(iii)           manage, oversee and make determinations with respect to the investment of the assets of the Plan, including the selection and appointment of investment managers, the selection of investment alternatives and asset allocations and the authorization of persons to effect the same, including the execution of documents in connection therewith;

 

(iv)           provide a report of its activities to the Compensation Committee at least annually and at such other times as may be directed by the Compensation Committee; and

 

(v)            perform such other functions as may be provided for in the Plan or as may be assigned to it from time to time by the Compensation Committee or another responsible committee of the Board.

 

The Retirement Plans Committee shall make such rules, regulations, interpretations, and shall have the authority and discretion to take such other actions to manage the investments of the Plan as the Retirement Plans Committee may deem appropriate.

 

8.2                                Delegation of Fiduciary Responsibilities

 

Except as otherwise expressly stated herein, the Corporation shall not allocate or delegate to any other person any of its duties and responsibilities hereunder.  The duties and responsibilities of the Corporation shall be carried out by the Board, the Committees and the Corporation’s officers and employees, acting on behalf of and in the name of the Corporation in their capacities as such, and not as individual fiduciaries.

 

57


 

ARTICLE IX
ADMINISTRATION OF PLAN

 

9.1                                Records and Notices

 

The Plan Administrator shall keep a record of all its proceedings and acts with respect to its administration of the Plan and shall maintain all such books of accounts, records and other data as may be necessary for the proper administration of the Plan.  The Plan Administrator shall notify the Trustees of any action taken by the Plan Administrator affecting the Trustees and its obligations or rights regarding the Plan and, when required, shall notify any other interested person or persons.

 

9.2                                Powers and Duties

 

The Plan Administrator shall have the responsibility for the general administration of the Plan and for carrying out the provisions of the Plan.  The Plan Administrator shall administer the Plan in accordance with its terms and shall discharge its duties with care, skill, prudence and diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent man acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims.  The Plan Administrator shall have such powers as may be necessary to discharge its duties in managing and controlling the operations and administration of the Plan.  The Plan Administrator shall have full and complete authority and control with respect to the operations and administration of the Plan unless the Plan Administrator allocates and delegates such authority or control pursuant to the procedures stated in Section 9.2(b) or (c)  Decisions of the Plan Administrator shall be subject to court review only to determine whether such decisions of the Plan Administrator are an abuse of the Plan Administrator’s discretion hereunder.  The Plan Administrator shall not receive any compensation from the Plan for his services as such.  The powers of the Plan Administrator shall include, but shall not be limited to, the following:

 

(a)                                  To employ such accountants, counsel or other persons as it deems necessary or desirable in connection with the administration of the Plan and to employ one

 

58



 

or more persons to render advice with regard to any administrative responsibility pursuant to the Plan.  The Trust Fund shall bear the costs of such services and other administrative expenses unless paid by the Employer.

 

(b)                                  To designate in writing persons who are to perform any of its powers and duties hereunder including, but not limited to, fiduciary responsibilities (other than any responsibility to manage or control the assets of the Plan) pursuant to the Plan.

 

(c)                                   To allocate in writing any of its powers and duties hereunder, including but not limited to fiduciary responsibilities (other than any responsibility to manage or control the assets of the Plan) among those persons who have been designated to perform fiduciary responsibilities pursuant to the Plan.

 

(d)                                  To construe and interpret the Plan.

 

(e)                                   Subject to Section 9.4, to resolve all questions arising in the administration, interpretation and application of the Plan, including, but not limited to, questions as to the eligibility or the right of any person to a benefit.

 

(f)                                    To adopt such by-laws, rules, regulations, forms and procedures from time to time as it deems advisable and appropriate in the proper administration of the Plan.

 

(g)                                   To receive from Participants such information as shall be necessary for the proper administration of the Plan.

 

(h)                                  To furnish, upon request, such annual reports with respect to the administration of the Plan as are reasonable and appropriate.

 

(i)                                      To receive from the Trustees and review reports of the financial condition and receipts and disbursements of the Trust Fund.

 

(j)                                     To prescribe procedures to be followed by any person in applying for distributions pursuant to the Plan and to designate the forms or documents,

 

59



 

evidence and such other information as the Plan Administrator may reasonably deem necessary, desirable or convenient to support an application for such distribution.

 

(k)                                  To issue directions to the Trustees and thereby bind the Trustees concerning all benefits to be paid pursuant to the Plan.

 

(l)                                      To apply consistently and uniformly the rules, regulations and determinations to all Participants and Beneficiaries in similar circumstances.

 

9.3                                Actuary

 

As an aid to the Retirement Plans Committee in adopting tables and in fixing the rate of contributions payable to the Plan, the actuary designated by the Retirement Plans Committee shall make annual actuarial valuations of the contingent assets and liabilities of the Plan and shall certify to the Retirement Plans Committee the tables and rates of contribution that he would recommend for use by the Plan.

 

9.4                                Claims Procedure

 

A Participant or Beneficiary who believes he is entitled to payments other than those awarded by the Plan Administrator may file a claim in writing with the Plan Administrator stating the nature of his claim, the facts supporting his claim, the amount claimed and his name and current address.  The Plan Administrator shall investigate, consider and render a written decision regarding any claim filed pursuant to this Section 9.4.  If the Plan Administrator denies such claim, it shall render a written decision within 90 days of receipt of the claim describing the reasons for denial, specifically referring to pertinent Plan provisions, informing the claimant that he or his duly authorized representative may review pertinent documents and may submit issues and comments in writing and advising the claimant of the procedure for appealing such denial.

 

Within 60 days after notice that a claim is denied, the claimant may file a written appeal to the Plan Administrator, including any comments, statements or documents he may wish to provide.  The Plan Administrator shall, within a reasonable time after the

 

60



 

submission of a written appeal by a claimant, entertain any oral presentation the claimant or his duly authorized representative wishes to make.  Within 60 days (120 days if special circumstances require an extension of time for processing) after the later of the submission of the written appeal or the oral presentation by the claimant or his personal representative, the Plan Administrator shall render a determination on the appeal of the claim in a written statement including the reasons therefor.  The determination so rendered by the Plan Administrator shall be binding upon all parties.

 

61



 

ARTICLE X
MANAGEMENT OF FUNDS

 

10.1                         Trustee

 

The Retirement Plans Committee shall appoint one or more Trustees to receive and hold in trust all contributions paid into the Trust Fund.  Such Trustee or Trustees shall serve at the pleasure of the Retirement Plans Committee and shall have such rights, powers and duties as the Retirement Plans Committee shall from time to time determine.  The Employers shall have no liability for the payment of benefits under the Plan or for the administration of the funds paid over to the Trustee.

 

10.2                         Exclusive Benefit Rule

 

Except as otherwise provided in the Plan, no part of the corpus or income of the funds of the Plan shall be used for, or diverted to, purposes other than for the exclusive benefit of Participants and other persons entitled to benefits under the Plan before the satisfaction of all liabilities with respect to them.  No person shall have any interest in or right to any part of the earnings of the funds of the Plan, or any right in, or to, any part of the assets held under the Plan, except as and to the extent expressly provided in the Plan.

 

10.3                         Investment Managers

 

Any Investment Manager, as defined in Section 3(38) of ERISA, may be appointed by the Retirement Plans Committee to manage (including the power to acquire and dispose of) all or any part of the Trust Fund.  In the event of any such appointment, the Retirement Plans Committee shall establish the portion of the assets of the Trust that shall be subject to the management of the Investment Manager and shall so notify the Trustee in writing.  With respect to such assets over which an Investment Manager has investment responsibility, the Investment Manager shall possess all of the investment powers and responsibilities granted to the Trustee under the Trust Agreement, and the Trustee shall invest and reinvest such assets pursuant to the written directions of the Investment Manager.  If the Retirement Plans Committee so directs, an Investment

 

62



 

Manager shall have the power to acquire and dispose of assets in the name of the Trust Fund.

 

63



 

ARTICLE XI
TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

 

11.1                         When Applicable

 

If this Plan is determined to be “Top-Heavy”, as defined in Section 11.5, for any Plan Year, the provisions of this Article shall supersede any conflicting provisions in the Plan.

 

11.2                         Minimum Accrual

 

For each Plan Year that this Plan is Top-Heavy, each Participant who is not a Key Employee must accrue a nonintegrated benefit that, when expressed as an annual benefit payable as a single life annuity commencing at Normal Retirement Age, is not less than two percent of the Participant’s Average Earnings multiplied by his years of Credited Service.  Average Earnings are averaged over the five consecutive years (disregarding years during which the Plan is not Top-Heavy) for which the Participant had the highest Earnings.  However, a Participant’s minimum benefit is not required to exceed 20 percent of his Average Earnings.  This minimum accrual shall be made even though, under other Plan provisions, the Participant would not otherwise be entitled to receive an accrual or would have received a lesser accrual for the year because of (i) the Participant’s failure to be employed on a specified date such as the last day of the Plan Year, (ii) the Participant’s failure to make mandatory contributions, if any, to the Plan, or (iii) the Participant’s Earnings being less than a stated amount.  To the extent that the Participant does not receive the minimum accrual under this Plan but is covered under the URS Corporation 401(k) Retirement Plan or the URS Corporation 401(k) Retirement Plan for Specified Contract Employees, the requirements of this Section shall be satisfied if the minimum benefit or minimum allocation requirements applicable to Top-Heavy plans are met in the URS Corporation 401(k) Retirement Plan or the URS Corporation 401(k) Retirement Plan for Specified Contract Employees.  For purposes of determining Credited Service with the Employer under this Section 11.2, any service with the Employer shall be disregarded to the extent that such service occurs during a Plan Year when the Plan benefits (within the meaning of Section 410(b) of the Code) no Key Employee or former Key Employee.

 

64



 

11.3                         Vesting Rules

 

For any Plan Year in which this Plan is Top-Heavy, the minimum vesting schedule as described in Section 11.4 will automatically apply to the Plan in lieu of the schedule provided in Article IV.  The minimum vesting schedule applies to all accrued benefits within the meaning of Code Section 411(a)(7) (except those attributable to Participant contributions, if any), including benefits accrued before the Plan became Top-Heavy.  Further, no reduction in vested benefits may occur in the event the Plan’s status as Top-Heavy changes for any Plan Year.  However, this Section does not apply to the Accrued Benefit of any Employee who does not complete any Vesting Service regarding any period after the Plan has initially become Top-Heavy and such Employee’s Accrued Benefit will be determined without regard to this Section.

 

11.4                         Vesting Schedule

 

In the event the minimum vesting schedule shall apply, the nonforfeitable interest of each Participant in his Accrued Benefit attributable to Employer contributions shall be determined on the basis of the following:

 

NUMBER OF YEARS OF SERVICE

 

VESTED INTEREST

 

 

 

 

 

Less than 2 Years

 

0

%

 

 

 

 

2 Years but less than 3

 

20

%

 

 

 

 

3 Years but less than 4

 

40

%

 

 

 

 

4 Years but less than 5

 

60

%

 

 

 

 

5 Years or more

 

100

%

 

11.5                         Top-Heavy Determination

 

A Top-Heavy Plan is a Plan in which, as of the Valuation Date, the ratio of the present value of the accrued benefits for Key Employees to the present value of the accrued benefits for all Employees exceeds 60 percent.  For purposes of determining the present value of the accrued benefit of any Employee or the amount of an account of any Employee, distributions made with respect to such Employee under the Plan (and any plan aggregated with the Plan under Section 416(g)(2) of the Code) during the one-year

 

65



 

period ending on the Determination Date must be included.  The preceding sentence shall apply to distributions under a terminated plan which, had it not been terminated, would have been aggregated with the Plan under Section 416(g)(2)(A)(i) of the Code.  In the case of a distribution made for a reason other than severance from employment, death or disability, this provision shall be applied by substituting five-year period for one-year period.  The accrued benefits and accounts of an individual who has not performed services for the Employer during the one-year period ending on the Determination Date shall not be taken into account.

 

The Determination Date is the last day of the preceding Plan Year.  The Valuation Date is the day during the Plan Year in which the Determination Date occurs that is used in computing Plan costs for minimum funding.

 

Present value shall be based on the interest rate and mortality table described in the second sentence of Section 1.24.  If this Plan is required to be or is permissively aggregated with any other plan or plans as provided in Section 11.6, the same mortality and interest assumptions shall apply to all plans that are aggregated.

 

The present value of accrued benefits of any Employee other than a Key Employee under any defined benefit plan used in testing whether the Plan is Top-Heavy shall be determined as if such benefits accrued not more rapidly than the slowest accrual rate permitted under Code Section 411(b)(1)(C) unless the same accrual method uniformly applies for all defined benefit plans maintained by the Employer.

 

11.6                         Aggregation Groups

 

The required aggregation group consists of each plan of the Employer in which a Key Employee is a participant and each other plan of the Employer that enables any plan of such Employer to meet the qualification requirements of Code Section 401(a)(4) or the minimum participation standards of Code Section 410.  The Employer may permit any plan not required to be included in an aggregation group as being part of such group if such group would continue to meet the qualification requirements of Code Section 401(a)(4) and the minimum participation standards of Code Section 410.

 

66


 

Each plan of the Employer required to be included in an aggregation group shall be treated as a Top-Heavy plan if such group is a Top-Heavy group.  A required aggregation group will be considered a Top-Heavy group if the sum of the present value of the cumulative accrued benefits for Key Employees under all defined benefit plans included in such group and the aggregate of the account balances of Key Employees under all defined contribution plans included in such groups increased by the aggregate distributions made in the five-year period ending on the Determination Date exceeds 60 percent of a similar sum determined for all Employees.

 

11.7                         Key Employee Defined

 

(a)                                  A Key Employee is any Employee or former Employee (including any deceased Employee) who at any time during the Plan Year that includes the Determination Date was (i) an officer of the Employer having annual compensation greater than $130,000 (as adjusted under Section 416(i)(1) of the Code for Plan Years beginning after December 31, 2002), (ii) a Five Percent Owner of the Employer or (iii) is a One Percent Owner and has annual compensation from the Employer of more than $150,000.

 

For purposes of determining if an officer is a Key Employee, annual compensation means compensation within the meaning of Section 415(c)(3) of the Code.  The determination of who is a Key Employee will be made in accordance with Section 416(l)(1) of the Code and the applicable regulations and other guidance of general applicability thereunder.

 

(b)                                  A Five Percent Owner is any Employee who owns more than five percent of the outstanding stock of the corporation or stock possessing more than five percent of the total combined voting power of all stock of the corporation.

 

(c)                                   A One Percent Owner is any Employee who owns more than one percent of the outstanding stock of the corporation or stock possessing more than one percent of the total combined voting power of all stock of the corporation.

 

67



 

ARTICLE XII
RETIREE HEALTH PLAN ACCOUNT

 

12.1                         Establishment of Retiree Health Plan

 

(a)                                  There is created, established and maintained under this Plan a separate account known as the Retiree Health Plan Account.  The Trustee and Plan Administrator agree to hold and administer the Retiree Health Plan Account, and to receive contributions hereto, for the purpose of providing for the payment of certain medical expenses, pursuant to Section 401(h) of the Code, for Covered Retirees and their Covered Dependents (as such terms are defined below).  The separate account shall be for record keeping purposes only.  Funds contributed to the Retiree Health Plan Account may be invested without identification of which investments are allocable to the Retiree Health Plan Account.

 

(b)                                  (i)                        No part of the income or corpus of the Retiree Health Plan Account shall be (either within the taxable year of contribution or thereafter) used for, or diverted to, any purpose (including the provision of any retirement benefits provided under the Plan) other than the provision of Medical Benefits, at any time prior to the satisfaction of all liabilities under this Plan with regard to the payment of Medical Benefits in accordance with this Article X.  Notwithstanding the above, the payment of any necessary or appropriate expenses attributable to the administration of the Retiree Health Plan Account may be made from the income or corpus of such account.

 

(ii)                                   Notwithstanding any other termination provisions herein, any amounts in the Retiree Health Plan Account which remain in such account following satisfaction of all liabilities for the payment of Medical Benefits arising under this Article X shall be returned to the Employer.

 

68



 

(c)                                   Notwithstanding the foregoing, no Medical Benefits shall be payable to any person who is, or ever has been, a Key Employee, as defined in Section 11.7, or his Covered Dependents.

 

12.2                         Definitions

 

For purposes of this Article X, the following terms shall have the meaning set forth below unless otherwise clearly required by the context:

 

(a)                                  “Covered Dependent” shall mean a Covered Retiree’s dependent who meets the conditions for coverage under the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan.  In no event will the term Covered Dependent include any person who is an eligible Covered Retiree himself or any person who is employed full-time with the Employer.  If both parents of any Covered Dependent child are eligible Covered Retirees, then the Covered Dependent child shall be considered as a Covered Dependent of only one of the Covered Retirees.

 

(b)                                  “Covered Retiree” shall mean a Retired Participant who has completed at least ten (10) Years of Vesting Service on his Normal Retirement Date or date of eligibility for early retirement.  In no event shall a Covered Retiree include a person not covered under the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan, or a person who is or ever was a Key Employee.

 

(c)                                   “Medical Benefits” shall mean,

 

(i)                                      with respect to a Covered Retiree who became a Covered Retiree prior to January 1, 2013, a percentage of the Per Capita Retiree Health Cost, such percentage being equal to $3,400 (as indexed from time to time) divided by the Per Capita Retiree Health Cost, but in no event in excess of 100% of such cost.

 

(ii)                                   with respect to a Covered Retiree who becomes a Covered Retiree on or after January 1, 2013, a percentage of the Per Capita Retiree Health Cost, such percentage being equal to:

 

69



 

(A)                                $3,400 (as indexed from time to time) divided by the Per Capita Retiree Health Cost, but in no event in excess of 100% of such cost, through the date immediately preceding the date the Covered Retiree attains age 65; and

 

(B)                                $1,100 (as indexed from time to time) divided by the Per Capita Retiree Health Cost, but in no event in excess of 100% of such cost, on and after the date the Covered Retiree attains age 65.

 

(d)                                  “Per Capita Retiree Health Cost” for any year means the total annual Employer cost of claims under the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan, divided by the number of retired employees covered under that plan at any time during that year.

 

(e)                                   “URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan” shall mean the URS Federal Services, Inc. (formerly URS Federal Technical Services, Inc.) VEBA Trust Welfare Benefits Plan and the URS Federal Services, Inc. (formerly URS Federal Technical Services, Inc.) Non-VEBA Trust Welfare Benefits Plan, as they relate to retired persons, as they shall be amended from time to time, and the provisions of such Plans shall be incorporated by reference herein.

 

(f)                                    “Retired Participant” means an individual who was an active Participant under this Plan until his retirement date and who retires from employment with the Employer and is thereupon immediately eligible to receive retirement benefits hereunder.

 

12.3                         Election to Continue Coverage

 

In the event a Covered Dependent loses coverage as a result of the death or divorce of a Covered Retiree, such Covered Dependent shall have coverage continuation rights as shall be provided under the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan, and the provisions of such continuation coverage shall be incorporated by reference with respect to benefits under the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan Account created hereunder.  Because such continuation coverage shall be provided under the URS Federal

 

70



 

Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan at the Covered Dependent’s expense, no further benefits will be paid from the Retiree Health Plan Account with respect to such Covered Dependents.

 

12.4                         Funding Method and Policy

 

All contributions to fund benefits provided under this Section shall be made by the Employer, except those relating to continuation coverage described in Section 12.3.  Subject to the restrictions of this Section, the Employer shall contribute to the Retiree Health Plan Account annually an amount that is reasonably estimated to cover the total cost of the benefits to be provided hereunder and that satisfies the general requirements applicable to deductions allowable under Code Section 404 (as set forth in Treasury Regulations Section 1.404(a)-3(f)).  The total cost of providing Medical Benefits shall be determined in accordance with any generally accepted actuarial method that is reasonable in view of the provisions and coverage of the Plan, the funding medium, and other applicable considerations.

 

12.5                         Subordination to Retirement Benefits

 

It is intended that the Medical Benefits provided under this Article X be subordinate at all times to the retirement benefits provided under the Plan.  Therefore, the aggregate of contributions to the Retiree Health Plan Account shall at no time exceed 25 percent of the aggregate of contributions for all purposes of this Plan, other than contributions to fund past service credits.  For this purpose contributions to this plan for benefits other than Medical Benefits shall not be deemed to be less than the cost of such benefits determined under the projected unit credit method (other than the cost of past service credits).

 

12.6                         Benefits Provision

 

The benefits payable pursuant to this Section shall be limited to the payment of Medical Benefits for Covered Retirees and their Covered Dependents.  The Medical Benefits provided under this Section and the Employer contributions to fund said Benefits shall not discriminate in favor of the highly compensated employees of the Employer within the meaning of Code Section 414(q).

 

71



 

12.7                         Coordination with URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan

 

Benefits under this plan shall be provided by reimbursing annually the Employer or other paying agent under the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan for the percentage of the Per Capita Retiree Health Cost for each Covered Retiree.

 

12.8                         Reservation of the Right to Terminate Benefits

 

The Employer reserves the right to amend or terminate the Medical Benefits provided hereunder or the URS Federal Services, Inc. Retiree Health Plan at any time.  In such event assets in the Medical Benefit Account shall be used to provide the Medical Benefits provided hereunder, both to Covered Retirees and those Participants who at the date of termination subsequently become Covered Retirees, but only to the extent assets remain in such account.  After the satisfaction of all such liabilities, any assets remaining shall revert to the Employer.

 

12.9                         Disallowance of Deduction

 

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained herein, the provisions of Section 6.2(a) and (c) shall apply with respect to all contributions made to the Retiree Health Plan Account.

 

72



 

ARTICLE XIII
AMENDMENT, MERGER AND TERMINATION

 

13.1                         Amendment of Plan

 

The Board of Directors reserves the right at any time and from time to time, and, to the extent permitted by the Code or Treasury Regulations, retroactively if deemed necessary or appropriate, to amend in whole or in part any or all of the provisions of the Plan.  However, no amendment shall make it possible for any part of the funds of the Plan to be used for, or diverted to, purposes other than for the exclusive benefit of persons entitled to benefits under the Plan before the satisfaction of all liabilities with respect to them.  No amendment shall be made that has the effect of decreasing the Accrued Benefit of any Participant or of reducing the nonforfeitable percentage of the Accrued Benefit of a Participant below the nonforfeitable percentage computed under the Plan as in effect on the date on which the amendment is adopted or, if later, the date on which the amendment becomes effective.  For purposes of the preceding sentence, an amendment that has the effect of (i) eliminating or reducing an early retirement benefit or a retirement-type subsidy, or (ii) eliminating an optional form of benefit, with respect to benefits attributable to service before the amendment shall be treated as reducing Accrued Benefits.  In the case of a retirement-type subsidy, the preceding sentence shall apply only with respect to a Participant who satisfies (either before or after the amendment) the preamendment conditions for the subsidy.  If the Plan is amended in any way that directly or indirectly affects the computation of a Participant’s nonforfeitable percentage, each Participant with at least three Years of Vesting Service may elect, within a reasonable period after the adoption of the amendment, to have his nonforfeitable percentage computed without regard to such amendment.

 

No amendment which has the effect of increasing Plan liabilities by reason of increases in benefits, establishment of new benefits, changing the rate of benefit accrual, or changing the rate at which benefits become nonforfeitable may take effect during any Plan Year if the Plan’s AFTAP (as defined in Section 4.10(d)(i)) for such Plan Year is less than 80% (or would be less than 80% taking into account such amendment); provided that this

 

73



 

Section shall cease to apply to any Plan Year, effective as of the first day of such Plan Year, upon payment by the Employer of a contribution (in addition to any minimum required contribution under Code Section 430) equal to the amount of the increase in the Plan’s funding target under Code Section 430 for the Plan Year attributable to the amendment (or sufficient to result in an AFTAP of 80%).  This paragraph of Section 13.1 shall not apply to any amendment which provides for an increase in benefits under a formula which is not based on a Participant’s compensation, but only if the rate of such increase is not in excess of the contemporaneous rate of increase in average wages of Participants covered by the amendment.

 

13.2                         Merger or Consolidation

 

The Plan may not be merged or consolidated with, and its assets or liabilities may not be transferred to, any other plan unless each person entitled to benefits under the Plan would, if the resulting plan were then terminated, receive a benefit immediately after the merger, consolidation, or transfer that is equal to or greater than the benefit he would have been entitled to receive immediately before the merger, consolidation, or transfer if the Plan had then terminated.

 

13.3                         Additional Participating Employers

 

(a)                                  If any company is or becomes a subsidiary of or associated with the Company, the Board of Directors may include the employees of that subsidiary or associated company in the participation of the Plan upon appropriate action by that company necessary to adopt the Plan.  In that event, or if any persons become Employees of an Employer as the result of merger or consolidation or acquisition of all or part of the assets or business of another company or for purposes of a specific assignment at a specific location, the Board of Directors shall determine to what extent, if any, previous service with the subsidiary, associated or other company or at the specific location shall be recognized under the Plan, but subject to the continued qualification and tax-exempt status of the Plan and trust, respectively, under the Code.

 

74



 

(b)                                  Any Employer may terminate its participation in and withdraw from the Plan upon appropriate action by its board of directors, in which event the funds of the Plan held on account of Participants in the employ of that Employer shall be determined by the Plan Administrator and shall be applied as provided in Section 13.4 if the Plan should be terminated, or shall be segregated by the Trustee as a separate trust, pursuant to certification to the Trustee by the Plan Administrator, continuing the Plan as a separate plan for the employees of that Employer under which the board of directors of that Employer shall succeed to all the powers and duties of the Board of Directors, including the appointment of a plan administrator.  Except as required by applicable law, the withdrawal of an Employer from the Plan shall not constitute a partial or complete termination of the Plan as thereafter in effect with respect to any other Employer.

 

13.4                         Termination of Plan

 

The Employer intends to continue the Plan indefinitely.  However, the Board of Directors may terminate the Plan for any reason at any time.  In case of termination of the Plan, the rights of Participants to the benefits accrued under the Plan to the date of the termination, to the extent then funded or guaranteed by the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation, if greater, shall be nonforfeitable.  The funds of the Plan shall be used for the exclusive benefit of persons entitled to benefits under the Plan as of the date of termination, except as provided in Section 6.2.  However, any funds not required to satisfy all liabilities of the Plan for benefits because of erroneous actuarial computation shall be returned to the Employer.  The Plan Administrator shall determine on the basis of actuarial valuation the share of the funds of the Plan allocable to each person entitled to benefits under the Plan in accordance with Section 4044 of ERISA or corresponding provision of any applicable law in effect at the time.  In the event of a partial termination of the Plan, the provisions of this Section shall be applicable to the Participants affected by that partial termination.

 

75


 

ARTICLE XIV
MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

 

14.1                         Compliance with ERISA

 

Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, nothing above or any other provision contained elsewhere in the Plan shall relieve a fiduciary or other person of any responsibility or liability for any responsibility, obligation or duty imposed upon him pursuant to Title I, Part 4 of ERISA.  Furthermore, anything in this Plan to the contrary notwithstanding, if any provision of this Plan is voided by ERISA Sections 410 and 411, such provision shall be of no force and effect only to the extent that it is voided by such Section.

 

14.2                         Nonalienation of Benefits

 

Except with respect to any indebtedness owing to the Trust Fund created hereunder or payments required pursuant to a “Qualified Domestic Relations Order,” as defined by the Code, benefits payable under the Plan shall not be subject in any manner to anticipation, alienation, sale, transfer, assignment, pledge, encumbrance, charge, garnishment, execution or levy of any kind, either voluntary or involuntary, including any such liability which is for alimony or other payment for the support of a spouse or former spouse, or any relative of a Participant prior to actually being received by the person entitled to the benefit pursuant to the terms of the Plan.  Any attempt to anticipate, alienate, sell, transfer, assign, pledge, encumber, charge or otherwise dispose of any right to amounts payable hereunder shall be void.  Furthermore, no benefit under the Plan shall in any manner be liable for or subject to the debts, contracts, liabilities, engagements or torts of the person entitled to such benefit.  If the terms of this Section 14.4 are contrary to the law governing in a particular circumstance, then, only as to that circumstance, or any such payment shall be exempt to the maximum extent permitted by such law.

 

14.3                         Employment Not Guaranteed By Plan

 

Neither the establishment of the Plan nor its amendment nor the granting of a benefit pursuant to the Plan shall be construed as giving any Participant the right to continue as

 

76



 

an employee of an Employer, as limiting the rights of such Employer to dismiss or impose penalties upon the Participant or as modifying in any other way the terms of employment of any Participant.

 

14.4                         Form of Communication

 

Any election, application, claim, notice or other communication required or permitted to be made by or to a Participant, the Plan Administrator, the Company, or an Employer in writing shall be made in such form as the Plan Administrator shall prescribe.  Such communication shall be effective upon mailing if sent first class, postage prepaid and addressed to the addressee at its principal office, or to the Participant at his last known address, or upon personal delivery, if delivered to an officer of the addressee or to the Participant, as the case may be.

 

14.5                         Facility of Payment

 

In the event that the Participant entitled to receive payments hereunder is unable to care for his affairs because of illness, accident or disability, and a duly qualified guardian or legal representative is appointed for such Participant, the Plan Administrator shall direct the Trustees to pay any amount to which the Participant is entitled to such duly.  qualified guardian or legal representative upon claim of such guardian or legal representative.  If a duly qualified guardian or legal representative is not appointed for such Participant, the Plan Administrator shall direct the Trustees to pay any amount to which the Participant is entitled to such person’s Spouse, child, grandchild, parent, brother or sister or to a person deemed by the Plan Administrator to have incurred expense for such person entitled to payment.  Any payment made pursuant to this Section 14.7 in good faith shall be a payment for the account of the Participant and shall be a complete discharge from any liability of the Trust Fund or the Trustees therefor.

 

14.6                         Service in More Than One Fiduciary Capacity

 

Any individual, entity or group of persons may serve in more than one fiduciary capacity with respect to the Plan, the Trust Fund or both.

 

77



 

14.7                         Binding Effect of Company’s Actions

 

Each Employer shall be bound by any all decisions and actions taken by the Company hereunder.

 

14.8                         Governing Law

 

Except to the extent inconsistent with and preempted by ERISA or other applicable Federal law, the Plan and all matters arising thereunder shall be governed by the laws of the State of Maryland.

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, and as evidence of the adoption of the Plan, the undersigned officer duly authorized has appended his signature this        day of                  , 20          .

 

 

 

URS FEDERAL SERVICES, INC.

 

 

 

 

 

By:

 

 

78



 

APPENDIX A

 

ADJUSTMENTS FOR PARTICIPANTS DESCRIBED IN SECTION 4.1(c)

 

SSN

 

Name

 

Monthly
Accrued Benefit
Under the
Mound Plans

 

Offset
Attributable to
Mound Plan
Service

 

Net Adjustment
to Plan Accrued
Benefit

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

79




QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


EXHIBIT 21.1

AECOM Global, Inc., a Delaware Corporation
AECOM, Inc., a Delaware Corporation
AECOM Technical Services, Inc., a California Corporation
AECOM USA, Inc., a New York Corporation
National Security Programs, Inc., a Virginia Corporation
Tishman Construction Corporation, a Delaware Corporation




QuickLinks


QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


EXHIBIT 23.1

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

        We consent to the incorporation by reference in the following Registration Statements:

of our reports dated November 17, 2014, with respect to the consolidated financial statements and schedule of AECOM Technology Corporation and the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in this Annual Report (Form 10-K) of AECOM Technology Corporation for the year ended September 30, 2014.

/s/ ERNST & YOUNG LLP

Los Angeles, California
November 17, 2014




QuickLinks

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


EXHIBIT 31.1

Certification Pursuant to
Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a)

I, Michael S. Burke, certify that:

1.
I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of AECOM Technology Corporation;

2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4.
The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

(b)
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and

5.
The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.

Dated: November 17, 2014

    /s/ MICHAEL S. BURKE

Michael S. Burke
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)



QuickLinks

Certification Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a)

QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


EXHIBIT 31.2

Certification Pursuant to
Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a)

I, Stephen M. Kadenacy, certify that:

1.
I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of AECOM Technology Corporation;

2.
Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

3.
Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

4.
The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have:

(a)
Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

(b)
Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

(c)
Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant's disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

(d)
Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant's most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant's fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant's internal control over financial reporting; and

5.
The registrant's other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant's auditors and the audit committee of the registrant's board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

(a)
All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant's ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

(b)
Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant's internal control over financial reporting.

Dated: November 17, 2014

    /s/ STEPHEN M. KADENACY

Stephen M. Kadenacy
President and Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)



QuickLinks

Certification Pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a)/15d-14(a)

QuickLinks -- Click here to rapidly navigate through this document


Exhibit 32

Certification Pursuant to
18 U.S.C. Section 1350

        In connection with the Annual Report of AECOM Technology Corporation (the "Company") on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended September 30, 2014 as filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on the date hereof (the "Report"), we, Michael S. Burke, Chief Executive Officer of the Company, and Stephen M. Kadenacy, Chief Financial Officer of the Company, hereby certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that, to our knowledge:

/s/ MICHAEL S. BURKE

Michael S. Burke
Chief Executive Officer
November 17, 2014
   

/s/ STEPHEN M. KADENACY

Stephen M. Kadenacy
President and Chief Financial Officer
November 17, 2014

 

 



QuickLinks

Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350